STAAD Technical Reference 2005
STAAD Technical Reference 2005
STAAD Technical Reference 2005
Pro 2005
STAAD.Pro 2005 is a suite of proprietary computer programs of Research Engineers, International (REI), a Bentley Solutions Center. Although every effort has been made to ensure the correctness of these programs, REI will not accept responsibility for any mistake, error or misrepresentation in or as a result of the usage of these programs.
RELEASE 2005 Copyright Research Engineers, International A Bentley Solutions Center Published February, 2006
About STAAD.Pro
STAAD.Pro is a general purpose structural analysis and design program with applications primarily in the building industry - commercial buildings, bridges and highway structures, industrial structures, chemical plant structures, dams, retaining walls, turbine foundations, culverts and other embedded structures, etc. The program hence consists of the following facilities to enable this task. 1. Graphical model generation utilities as well as text editor based commands for creating the mathematical model. Beam and column members are represented using lines. Walls, slabs and panel type entities are represented using triangular and quadrilateral finite elements. Solid blocks are represented using brick elements. These utilities allow the user to create the geometry, assign properties, orient cross sections as desired, assign materials like steel, concrete, timber, aluminum, specify supports, apply loads explicitly as well as have the program generate loads, design parameters etc. Analysis engines for performing linear elastic and pdelta analysis, finite element analysis, frequency extraction, and dynamic response (spectrum, time history, steady state, etc.). Design engines for code checking and optimization of steel, aluminum and timber members. Reinforcement calculations for concrete beams, columns, slabs and shear walls. Design of shear and moment connections for steel members. Result viewing, result verification and report generation tools for examining displacement diagrams, bending moment and shear force diagrams, beam, plate and solid stress contours, etc. Peripheral tools for activities like import and export of data from and to other widely accepted formats, links with other popular softwares for niche areas like reinforced and prestressed concrete slab design, footing design, steel connection design, etc. A library of exposed functions called OpenSTAAD which allows users to access STAAD.Pros internal functions and routines as well as its graphical commands to tap into STAADs database and link input and output data to third-party software written using languages like C, C++, VB, VBA, FORTRAN, Java, Delphi, etc. Thus, OpenSTAAD allows users to link in-house or third-party applications with STAAD.Pro.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Table of Contents
STAAD.PRO Technical Reference Manual
Section 1 General Description
1.1 1.2 1.3 1.4 1.5 Introduction Input Generation Types of Structures Unit Systems Structure Geometry and Coordinate Systems 1.5.1 Global Coordinate System 1.5.2 Local Coordinate System 1.5.3 Relationship Between Global & Local Coordinates 1.6 Finite Element Information 1.6.1 Plate/Shell Element 1.6.2 Solid Element 1.6.3 Surface Element 1.7 Member Properties 1.7.1 Prismatic Properties 1.7.2 Built-In Steel Section Library 1.7.3 User Provided Steel Table 1.7.4 Tapered Sections 1.7.5 Assign Command 1.7.6 Steel Joist and Joist Girders 1.7.7 Composite Beams and Composite Decks 1.7.8 Curved Members 1.8 Member/Element Release 1.9 Truss/Tension/Compression - Only Members 1.10 Tension/Compression - Only Springs 1.11 Cable Members 1.11.1 Linearized Cable Members 1.11.2 Non Linear Cable & Truss Members 1.12 Member Offsets 1.13 Material Constants 1.14 Supports 1.15 Master/Slave Joints 1.16 Loads 1.16.1 Joint Load 1.16.2 Member Load 1.16.3 Area Load / Oneway Load / Floor Load 1.16.4 Fixed End Member Load 1.16.5 Prestress and Poststress Member Load
11-1 2 2 3 4 4 7 11 18 18 31 35 37 39 41 42 42 42 43 47 48 48 49 49 50 50 53 54 55 56 56 57 57 57 59 61 1 61
1.17
1.18
1.19
1.16.6 Temperature/Strain Load 1 - 64 1.16.7 Support Displacement Load 64 1.16.8 Loading on Elements 64 Load Generator 66 1.17.1 Moving Load Generator 66 1.17.2 Seismic Load Generator based on UBC, IBC and other codes 67 1.17.3 Wind Load Generator 67 Analysis Facilities 69 1.18.1 Stiffness Analysis 69 1.18.2 Second Order Analysis 74 1.18.2.1 P-Delta Analysis 74 1.18.2.2 Imperfection Analysis 75 1.18.2.3 Non Linear Analysis (removed) 76 1.18.2.4 Multi-Linear Springs 76 1.18.2.5 Tension / Compression Only Analysis 76 1.18.2.6 Nonlinear Cable/Truss Analysis 77 1.18.3 Dynamic Analysis 80 1.18.3.1 Solution of the Eigenproblem 80 1.18.3.2 Mass Modeling 80 1.18.3.3 Damping Modeling 82 1.18.3.4 Response Spectrum Analysis 82 1.18.3.5 Response Time History Analysis 83 Member End Forces 85 1.19.1 Secondary Analysis 90 1.19.2 Member Forces at Intermediate Sections 90 1.19.3 Member Displacements at Intermediate Sections 90 1.19.4 Member Stresses at Specified Sections 91 1.19.5 Force Envelopes 91 Multiple Analyses 92 Steel/Concrete/Timber Design 93 Footing Design 93 Printing Facilities 93 Plotting Facilities 93 Miscellaneous Facilities 94 Post Processing Facilities 1 - 94
Section 2
22-1 2 2 7 7 7 7 7 9 2-9
2.3.7 Torsion per Publication T114 2.3.8 Design of Web Tapered Sections 2.3.9 Slender compression elements 2.4 Design Parameters 2.5 Code Checking 2.6 Member Selection 2.6.1 Member Selection by Optimization 2.6.2 Deflection Check With Steel Design 2.7 Truss Members 2.8 Unsymmetric Sections 2.9 Composite Beam Design as per AISC-ASD 2.10 Plate Girders 2.11 Tabulated Results of Steel Design 2.12 Weld Design 2.13 Steel Design per AASHTO Specifications 2.14 Steel Design per AISC/LRFD Specification 2.14.1 General Comments 2.14.2 LRFD Fundamentals 2.14.3 Analysis Requirements 2.14.4 Section Classification 2.14.5 Axial Tension 2.14.6 Axial Compression 2.14.7 Flexural Design Strength 2.14.8 Combined Axial Force And Bending 2.14.9 Design for Shear 2.14.10 Design Parameters 2.14.11 Code Checking and Member Selection 2.14.12 Tabulated Results of Steel Design 2.14.13 Composite Beam Design per the American LRFD 3rd edition code 2.15 Design per American Cold Formed Steel Code 2.16 Castellated Beams
2-9 11 11 11 18 19 20 20 20 21 21 23 23 26 29 56 56 57 58 59 59 60 61 61 61 62 64 65 66 73 2 - 82
Section 3
33-1 2 2 3 6 7 7 8 8 9 12 3 - 13
3.8 Designing elements, shear walls, slabs 3.8.1 Element Design 3.8.2 Shear Wall Design 3.8.3 Slabs and RC Designer 3.8.4 Design of I-shaped beams per ACI-318
3 - 18 18 20 28 3 - 35
Section 4
Timber Design
4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 4.6 Timber Design Design Operations Input Specification Code Checking Orientation of Lamination Member Selection
44-1 13 16 17 18 4 - 18
Section 5
55-2 3 5 8 10 12 14 15 19 20 21 22 23 24 29 33 34 36 38 42 49 51 54 55 57 66
70 assigning properties from Steel Tables 5.20.2 Prismatic Property Specification 74 5.20.2.1 Prismatic Tapered Tube Property Specification 76 5.20.3 Tapered Member Specification 5 - 78
5.21
5.22
5.23
5.27
5.31
5.20.4 Property Specification from User Provided Table 5 - 79 5.20.5 Assign Profile Specification 80 5.20.6 Examples of Member Property Specification 81 5.20.7 Composite Decks 83 5.20.8 Curved Member Specification 87 5.20.9 Applying Fireproofing on members 99 Element/Surface Property Specification 104 5.21.1 Element Property Specification 105 5.21.2 Surface Property Specification 106 Member/Element Releases 107 5.22.1 Member Release Specification 108 5.22.2 Element Release Specification 111 5.22.3 Element Ignore Stiffness 113 Member Truss/Cable/Tension/Compression Specification 114 5.23.1 Member Truss Specification 115 5.23.2 Member Cable Specification 117 5.23.3 Member Tension/Compression Specification 119 Element Plane Stress and Inplane Rotation Specification 124 Member Offset Specification 126 Specifying and Assigning Material Constants 128 5.26.1 The Define Material Command 130 5.26.2 Specifying CONSTANTS for members, plate elements and solid elements 132 5.26.3 Surface Constants Specification 139 5.26.4 Modal Damping Information 141 5.26.5 Composite Damping for Springs 144 5.26.6 Member Imperfection Information 145 Support Specifications 146 5.27.1 Global Support Specification 147 5.27.2 Inclined Support Specification 151 5.27.3 Automatic Spring Support Generator for Foundations 154 5.27.4 Multi-linear Spring Support Specification 160 5.27.5 Spring Tension/Compression Specification 163 Master/Slave Specification 168 Draw Specifications 171 Miscellaneous Settings for Dynamic Analysis 172 5.30.1 Cut-Off Frequency, Mode Shapes or Time 173 5.30.2 Mode Selection 175 Definition of Load Systems 177 5.31.1 Definition of Moving Load System 178 5.31.2 Definitions for Static Force Procedures for Seismic Analysis 183 5.31.2.1 UBC 1997 Load Definition 184 5.31.2.2 UBC 1994 or 1985 Load Definition 189 5.31.2.3 Colombian Seismic Load 194 5.31.2.4 Japanese Seismic Load 197 5.31.2.5 Definition of Lateral Seismic Load per IS:1893 200 5.31.2.6 IBC 2000/2003 Load Definition 5 - 203
5.31.2.7 CFE (Comision Federal De Electricidad) Seismic Load 5 - 210 5.31.2.8 NTC (Normas Tcnicas Complementarias) Seismic Load 214 5.31.2.9 RPA (Algerian) Seismic Load 219 5.31.2.10 Canadian (NRC 1995) Seismic Load 223 5.31.3 Definition of Wind Load 236 5.31.4 Definition of Time History Load 240 5.31.5 Definition of Snow Load 246 5.32 Loading Specifications 247 5.32.1 Joint Load Specification 249 5.32.2 Member Load Specification 250 5.32.3 Element Load Specifications 253 5.32.3.1 Element Load Specification - Plates 254 5.32.3.2 Element Load Specification - Solids 258 5.32.3.3 Element Load Specification - Joints 260 5.32.3.4 Surface Loads Specification 263 5.32.4 Area Load/One Way Load/Floor Load Specification 266 5.32.5 Prestress Load Specification 280 5.32.6 Temperature Load Specification 287 5.32.7 Fixed-End Load Specification 289 5.32.8 Support Joint Displacement Specification 290 5.32.9 Selfweight Load Specification 293 5.32.10 Dynamic Loading Specification 294 5.32.10.1 Response Spectrum Specification 295 5.32.10.1.1 Response Spectrum Specification in Conjunction with the Indian IS: 1893 (Part 1)-2002 Code for Dynamic Analysis 301 5.32.10.1.2 Response Spectrum Specification per Eurocode 8 306 5.32.10.2 Application of Time Varying Load for Response History Analysis 312 5.32.11 Repeat Load Specification 315 5.32.12 Generation of Loads 318 5.32.13 Generation of Snow Loads 332 5.33 Rayleigh Frequency Calculation 333 5.34 Modal Calculation Command 335 5.35 Load Combination Specification 336 5.37 Analysis Specification 341 5.37.1 Steady State/Harmonic Analysis 342 5.38 Change Specification 348 5.39 Load List Specification 351 5.40 Section Specification 353 5.41 Print Specifications (includes CG and Story Drift) 355 5.42 Stress/Force output printing for Surface Entities 362 5.43 Print Section Displacement 364 5.44 Printing the Force Envelope 366 5.45 Post Analysis Printer Plot Specifications 368 5.46 Size Specification 5 - 369
5.47 Steel and Aluminum Design Specifications 5.47.1 Parameter Specifications 5.47.2 Code Checking Specification 5.47.3 Member Selection Specification 5.47.4 Member Selection by Optimization 5.47.5 Weld Selection Specification 5.48 Group Specification 5.49 Steel Take Off Specification 5.50 Timber Design Specifications 5.50.1 Timber Design Parameter Specifications 5.50.2 Code Checking Specification 5.50.3 Member Selection Specification 5.51 Concrete Design Specifications 5.51.1 Design Initiation 5.51.2 Concrete Design-Parameter Specification 5.51.3 Concrete Design Command 5.51.4 Concrete Take Off Command 5.51.5 Concrete Design Terminator 5.52 Footing Design Specifications 5.52.1 Design Initiation 5.52.2 Footing Design Parameter Specification 5.52.3 Footing Design Command 5.52.4 Footing Design Terminator 5.53 Shear Wall Design 5.53.1 Definition of Wall Panels for Shear Wall Design 5.53.2 Shear Wall Design Initiation 5.54 End Run Specification
5 - 371 372 375 376 378 379 380 383 384 385 386 387 388 389 390 392 393 394 395 398 399 400 402 403 405 406 5 - 408
Index
1-1
General Description
The STAAD.Pro 2005 Graphical User Interface (GUI) is normally used to create all input specifications and all output reports and displays (See the Graphical Environment manual). These structural modeling and analysis input specifications are stored in a text file with extension .STD. When the GUI does a File Open to start a session with an existing model, it gets all of its information from the STD file. A user may edit/create this STD file and have the GUI and the analysis engine both reflect the changes. The STD file is processed by the STAAD analysis engine to produce results that are stored in several files with extensions such as ANL, BMD, TMH, etc. The ANL text file contains the printable output as created by the specifications in this manual. The other files contain the results (displacements, member/element forces, mode shapes, section forces/moments/displacements, etc.) that are used by the GUI in post processing mode. This section of the manual contains a general description of the analysis and design facilities available in the STAAD engine. Specific information on steel, concrete, and timber design is available in Sections 2, 3, and 4 of this manual, respectively. Detailed STAAD engine STD file command formats and other specific user information is presented in Section 5. The objective of this section is to familiarize the user with the basic principles involved in the implementation of the various analysis/design facilities offered by the STAAD engine. As a general rule, the sequence in
General Description
1-2
Section 1
which the facilities are discussed follows the recommended sequence of their usage in the STD input file.
Section 1
1-3
Specification of the correct structure type reduces the number of equations to be solved during the analysis. This results in a faster and more economic solution for the user. The degrees of freedom associated with frame elements of different types of structures is illustrated in Figure 1.1.
Structure Types
Figure 1.1
The user is allowed to input data and request output in almost all commonly used engineering unit systems including MKS, SI and FPS. In the input file, the user may change units as many times as required. Mix and match between length and force units from different unit systems is also allowed. The input-unit for angles (or rotations) is degrees. However, in JOINT DISPLACEMENT output, the rotations are provided in radians. For all output, the units are clearly specified by the program.
General Description
1-4
Section 1
Section 1
1-5
directions. The translational degrees of freedom are denoted by u 1 , u 2 , u 3 and the rotational degrees of freedom are denoted by u 4 , u5 & u6. B. Cylindrical Coordinate System: In this coordinate system, (Fig. 1.3) the X and Y coordinates of the conventional cartesian system are replaced by R (radius) and (angle in degrees). The Z coordinate is identical to the Z coordinate of the cartesian system and its positive direction is determined by the right hand rule. Reverse Cylindrical Coordinate System: This is a cylindrical type coordinate system (Fig. 1.4) where the R- plane corresponds to the X-Z plane of the cartesian system. The right hand rule is followed to determine the positive direction of the Y axis.
C.
General Description
1-6
Section 1
Section 1
1-7
General Description
1-8
Section 1
Figure 1.5a
Figure 1.5b
Section 1
1-9
Figure 1.6a - Local axis system for various cross sections when global Y axis is vertical.
NOTE: The local x-axis of the above sections is going into the paper
General Description
1-10
Section 1
Figure 1.6b - Local axis system for various cross sections when global Z axis is vertical (SET Z UP is specified).
Section 1
1-11
Beta Angle
For input, see section 5.26
When the local x-axis is parallel to the global Y-axis, as in the case of a column in a structure, the beta angle is the angle through which the local z-axis has been rotated about the local x-axis from a position of being parallel and in the same positive direction of the global Z-axis. When the local x-axis is not parallel to the global Y-axis, the beta angle is the angle through which the local coordinate system has been rotated about the local x-axis from a position of having the local z-axis parallel to the global X-Z plane and the local y-axis in the same positive direction as the global Y-axis. Figure 1.7 details the positions for beta equals 0 degrees or 90 degrees. When providing member loads in the local member axis, it is helpful to refer to this figure for a quick determination of the local axis system.
Reference Point
An alternative to providing the member orientation is to input the coordinates (or a joint number) which will be a reference point located in the member x-y plane but not on the axis of the member. From the location of the reference point, the program automatically calculates the orientation of the member x-y plane.
General Description
1-12
Section 1
Y
x x
y z y z x x x y y y x z z x x x z z y x y z
y y z x z y
X
x
z y
Section 1
1-13
Figure 1.8
General Description
1-14
Section 1
Figure 1.9
Section 1
1-15
Figure 1.10
General Description
1-16
Section 1
Figure 1.11
Section 1
1-17
Figure 1.12
General Description
1-18
Section 1
STAAD is equipped with a plate/shell finite element, solid finite element and an entity called the surface element. The features of each is explained below.
Section 1
1-19
General Description
1-20
Section 1
Correct numbering
Figure 1.8
Figure 1.9
Good Elements
Bad Elements
Figure 1.10
Figure 1.11
Figure 1.13
Theoretical Basis
The STAAD plate finite element is based on hybrid finite element formulations. A complete quadratic stress distribution is assumed. For plane stress action, the assumed stress distribution is as follows.
y yx x xy yx y
Figure 1.14
xy
Section 1
1-21
The following quadratic stress distribution is assumed for plate bending action:
Q M xy Z Y My X M
yx
Qy
x
M yx
My Qx Mx
Mx
M xy
Qy
Figure 1.15
General Description
1-22
Section 1
The distinguishing features of this finite element are: 1) Displacement compatibility between the plane stress component of one element and the plate bending component of an adjacent element which is at an angle to the first (see Fig. below) is achieved by the elements. This compatibility requirement is usually ignored in most flat shell/plate elements.
Figure 1.16
2) The out of plane rotational stiffness from the plane stress portion of each element is usefully incorporated and not treated as a dummy as is usually done in most commonly available commercial software. 3) Despite the incorporation of the rotational stiffness mentioned previously, the elements satisfy the patch test absolutely. 4) These elements are available as triangles and quadrilaterals, with corner nodes only, with each node having six degrees of freedom. 5) These elements are the simplest forms of flat shell/plate elements possible with corner nodes only and six degrees of freedom per node. Yet solutions to sample problems converge rapidly to accurate answers even with a large mesh size. 6) These elements may be connected to plane/space frame members with full displacement compatibility. No additional restraints/releases are required. 7) Out of plane shear strain energy is incorporated in the formulation of the plate bending component. As a result, the elements respond to Poisson boundary conditions which are considered to be more accurate than the customary Kirchoff boundary conditions
Section 1
1-23
8) The plate bending portion can handle thick and thin plates, thus extending the usefulness of the plate elements into a multiplicity of problems. In addition, the thickness of the plate is taken into consideration in calculating the out of plane shear. 9) The plane stress triangle behaves almost on par with the well known linear stress triangle. The triangles of most similar flat shell elements incorporate the constant stress triangle which has slow rates of convergence. Thus the triangular shell element is useful in problems with double curvature where the quadrilateral element may not be suitable. 10) Stress retrieval at nodes and at any point within the element.
Figure 1.17
General Description
1-24
Section 1
Section 1
1-25
Notes: 1. All element stress output is in the local coordinate system. The direction and sense of the element stresses are explained in Fig. 1.13. 2. To obtain element stresses at a specified point within the element, the user must provide the location (local X, local Y) in the coordinate system for the element. The origin of the local coordinate system coincides with the center of the element. 3. The 2 nonzero Principal stresses at the surface (SMAX & SMIN), the maximum 2D shear stress (TMAX), the 2D orientation of the principal plane (ANGLE), the 3D Von Mises stress (VONT & VONB), and the 3D Tresca stress (TRESCAT & TRESCAB) are also printed for the top and bottom surfaces of the elements. The top and the bottom surfaces are determined on the basis of the direction of the local z-axis. 4. The third principal stress is assumed to be zero at the surfaces for use in Von Mises and Tresca stress calculations. However, the TMAX and ANGLE are based only on the 2D inplane stresses (SMAX & SMIN) at the surface. The 3D maximum shear stress at the surface is not calculated but would be equal to the 3D Tresca stress divided by 2.0.
General Description
1-26
Section 1
Figure 1.18
Figure 1.19
Section 1
1-27
Figure 1.20
Figure 1.21
General Description
1-28
Section 1
Figure 1.22
Figure 1.23
Section 1
1-29
Figure 1.24
Figure 1.25
General Description
1-30
Section 1
Please note the following few restrictions in using the finite element portion of STAAD: 1) Members, plate elements, solid elements and surface elements can all be part of a single STAAD model. The MEMBER INCIDENCES input must precede the INCIDENCE input for plates, solids or surfaces. All INCIDENCES must precede other input such as properties, constants, releases, loads, etc. 2) The selfweight of the finite elements is converted to joint loads at the connected nodes and is not used as an element pressure load. 3) Element stresses are printed at the centroid and joints, but not along any edge. 4) In addition to the stresses shown in Fig 1.18, the Von Mises stresses at the top and bottom surface of the element are also printed.
Section 1
1-31
However the user has to decide between adopting a numbering system which reduces the computation time versus a numbering system which increases the ease of defining the structure geometry.
1 5
2 6
3 7
4 8
Figure 1.26
General Description
1-32
Section 1
Theoretical Basis
The solid element used in STAAD is of eight noded isoparametric type. These elements have three translational degrees-of-freedom per node.
Figure 1.27
By collapsing various nodes together, an eight noded solid element can be degenerated to the following forms with four to seven nodes. Joints 1, 2, and 3 must be retained as a triangle.
Figure 1.28
The stiffness matrix of the solid element is evaluated by numerical integration with eight Gauss-Legendre points. To facilitate the numerical integration, the geometry of the element is expressed by interpolating functions using natural coordinate system, (r,s,t) of the element with its origin at the center of gravity. The interpolating functions are shown below:
Section 1
1-33
x = hixi ,
i =1
y = hiyi ,
i =1
z = hizi
i =1
where x, y and z are the coordinates of any point in the element and x i , y i , z i , i=1,..,8 are the coordinates of nodes defined in the global coordinate system. The interpolation functions, h i are defined in the natural coordinate system, (r,s,t). Each of r, s and t varies between -1 and +1. The fundamental property of the unknown interpolation functions h i is that their values in natural coordinate system is unity at node, i, and zero at all other nodes of the element. The element displacements are also interpreted the same way as the geometry. For completeness, the functions are given below: u = hiui , v = hivi , w = hiwi
i=1 i=1 i=1 8 8 8
where u, v and w are displacements at any point in the element and u i ,v i , w i , i=1,8 are corresponding nodal displacements in the coordinate system used to describe the geometry. Three additional displacement bubble functions which have zero displacements at the surfaces are added in each direction for improved shear performance to form a 33x33 matrix. Static condensation is used to reduce this matrix to a 24x24 matrix at the corner joints.
General Description
1-34
Section 1
Figure 1.29
Section 1
1-35
General Description
1-36
Section 1
The attributes associated with surfaces, and the sections of this manual where the information may be obtained, are listed below: Attributes Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output printing Shear Wall Design Related Sections 5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
c. d.
Section 1
1-37
The diagram below shows directions and sign convention of local axes and forces.
Figure 1.30
Shear Area for members refers to the shear stiffness effective area. Shear stiffness effective area is used to calculate shear stiffness for the member stiffness matrix. As an example: for a rectangular cross section, the shear stiffness effective area is usually taken as 0.83 (Roark) to 0.85 (Cowper) times the cross sectional area. A shear area of less than the cross sectional area will reduce the stiffness. A typical shearing stiffness term is
General Description
1-38
Section 1
(12EI/L 3 )/(1+) where = (12 EI) / (GA s L 2 ) and A s is the shear stiffness effective area. PHI ()is usually ignored in basic beam theory. STAAD will include the PHI term unless the SET SHEAR command is entered. Shear stress effective area is a different quantity that is used to calculate shear stress and in code checking. For a rectangular cross section, the shear stress effective area is usually taken as 2/3 rds of the cross sectional area. Shear stress in STAAD may be from one of 3 methods. 1. (Shear Force)/(Shear stress effective area) This is the case where STAAD computes the area based on the cross section parameters. 2. (Shear Force)/(Shear stiffness effective area) This is the case where STAAD uses the shear area entered. 3. (V Q)/(I t) In some codes and for some cross sections, STAAD uses this method.
Section 1
1-39
AX IX IY IZ
= = = =
Cross sectional area Torsional constant Moment of inertia about y-axis. Moment of inertia about z-axis.
In addition, the user may choose to specify the following properties: AY AZ YD ZD = = = = Effective shear area for shear force parallel to local y-axis. Effective shear area for shear force parallel to local z-axis. Depth of section parallel to local y-axis. Depth of section parallel to local z-axis.
For T-beams, YD, ZD, YB & ZB must be specified. These terms, which are shown in the next figure are : YD = Total depth of section (top fiber of flange to bottom fiber of web) ZD = Width of flange YB = Depth of stem ZB = Width of stem For Trapezoidal beams, YD, ZD & ZB must be specified. These terms, which too are shown in the next figure are : YD = Total depth of section ZD = Width of section at top fiber ZB = Width of section at bottom fiber Top & bottom are defined as positive side of the local Z axis, and negative side of the local Z axis respectively.
General Description
1-40
Section 1
STAAD automatically considers the additional deflection of members due to pure shear (in addition to deflection due to ordinary bending theory). To ignore the shear deflection, enter a SET SHEAR command before the joint coordinates. This will bring results close to textbook results. The depths in the two major directions (YD and ZD) are used in the program to calculate the section moduli. These are needed only to calculate member stresses or to perform concrete design. The user can omit the YD & ZD values if stresses or design of these members are of no interest. The default value is 253.75 mm (9.99 inches) for YD and ZD. All the prismatic properties are input in the local member coordinates.
ZD ZD
YD
YB
YD
ZB
ZB
Figure 1.31
To define a concrete member, the user must not provide AX, but instead, provide YD and ZD for a rectangular section and just YD for a circular section. If no moment of inertia or shear areas are provided, the program will automatically calculate these from YD and ZD. Table 1.1 is offered to assist the user in specifying the necessary section values. It lists, by structural type, the required section properties for any analysis. For the PLANE or FLOOR type analyses, the choice of the required moment of inertia depends upon the beta angle. If BETA equals zero, the required property is IZ.
Section 1
1-41
Table 1.1 Required properties Structural Type TRUSS structure PLANE structure FLOOR structure SPACE structure Required Properties AX AX, IZ or IY IX, IZ or IY AX, IX, IY, IZ
This feature of the program allows the user to specify section names of standard steel shapes manufactured in different countries. Information pertaining to the American steel shapes is available in section 2. For information on steel shapes for other countries, please refer to the International Codes manual. STAAD.Pro comes with the non-composite castellated beam tables supplied by the steel products manufacturer SMI Steel Products. Details of the manufacture and design of these sections may be found at http://www.smisteelproducts.com/English/About/design.html
Figure 1.32
Since the shear areas of the sections are built into the tables, shear deformation is always considered for these sections.
General Description
1-42
Section 1
The user can provide a customized steel table with designated names and proper corresponding properties. The program can then find member properties from those tables. Member selection may also be performed with the program selecting members from the provided tables only. These tables can be provided as a part of a STAAD input or as separately created files from which the program can read the properties. The user who does not use standard rolled shapes or who uses a limited number of specific shapes may create permanent member property files. Analysis and design can be limited to the sections in these files.
Properties of tapered I-sections and several types of tapered tubes may be provided through MEMBER PROPERTY specifications. Given key section dimensions, the program is capable of calculating cross-sectional properties which are subsequently used in analysis. Specification of TAPERED sections is described in Section 5 of this manual.
Section 1
1-43
For the keyword COLUMN also, the program will assign an Ishaped beam section (Wide Flange for AISC, UC section for British). If steel design-member selection is requested, a similar type section will be selected. See section 5.20.5 for the command syntax and description of the ASSIGN Command.
General Description
1-44
Section 1
The designation for the G series Joist Girders is as shown in page 73 of the Steel Joist Institute publication. STAAD.Pro incorporates the span length also in the name, as shown in the next figure.
Figure 1.33
Modeling the joist - Theoretical basis Steel joists are prefabricated, welded steel trusses used at closely spaced intervals to support floor or roof decking. Thus, from an analysis standpoint, a joist is not a single member in the same sense as beams and columns of portal frames that one is familiar with. Instead, it is a truss assembly of members. In general, individual manufacturers of the joists decide on the cross section details of the members used for the top and bottom chords, and webs of the joists. So, joist tables rarely contain any information on the cross-section properties of the individual components of a joist girder. The manufacturers responsibility is to guarantee that, no matter what the cross section details of the members are, the joist simply has to ensure that it provides the capacity corresponding to its rating. The absence of the section details makes it difficult to incorporate the true truss configuration of the joist in the analysis model of the overall structure. The problem is hence simplified by treating the joist as a simply supported beam. That means that any load applied on the joist is transferred to its end nodes through simply supported action. It also means that the stiffness of the joist makes no contribution to the stiffness of the overall structure because the connection between the joist and the rest of the structure is treated as pinned.
Section 1
1-45
As a result of the above assumption, the following points must be noted with respect to modeling joists: 1) The entire joist is represented in the STAAD input file by a single member. Graphically it will be drawn using a single line. 2) After creating the member, the properties should be assigned from the joist database. 3) The 3D Rendering feature of the program will display those members using a representative Warren type truss. 4) The intermediate span-point displacements of the joist cannot be determined.
Figure 1.34
General Description
1-46
Section 1
Assigning the joists The procedure for assigning the joists is explained in the Graphical User Interface manual. The STAAD joists database includes the weight per length of the joists. So, for selfweight computations in the model, the weight of the joist is automatically considered. An example of a structure with joist (command file input data) is shown below. STAAD SPACE EXAMPLE FOR JOIST GIRDER UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 10 0 3 30 10 0; 4 30 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4; MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 3 TABLE ST W21x50 MEMBER PROPERTY SJIJOIST 2 TABLE ST 22K6 CONSTANTS E STEEL ALL DENSITY STEEL ALL POISSON STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 4 FIXED UNIT POUND FEET LOAD 1 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 LOAD 2 MEMBER LOAD 2 UNI GY -250
Section 1
1-47
LOAD COMB 3 1121 PERF ANALY PRINT STAT CHECK PRINT SUPP REAC FINISH
General Description
1-48
Section 1
b) The composite deck generation method The laboriousness of the previous procedure can be alleviated to some extent by using the programs composite deck definition facilities. The program then internally converts the deck into individual composite members (calculating attributes like effective width in the process) during the analysis and design phase. The deck is defined best using the graphical tools of the program since a database of deck data from different manufacturers is accessible from easy-to-use dialog boxes. Since all the members which make up the deck are identified as part of a single object, load assignment and alterations to the deck can be done to just the deck object, and not the individual members of the deck. The graphical procedure for creating the deck can be found in section AD.2004.22.2 of the Software Release Report for STAAD.Pro 2004s second edition. The command input is described in section 5.20.7 of this manual.
Members can be defined as being curved. Tapered sections are not permitted. The cross section should be uniform throughout the length.
Section 1
1-49
Only one of the attributes described in sections 1.8 and 1.9 can be assigned to a given member. The last one entered will be used. In other words, a MEMBER RELEASE should not be applied on a member which is declared TRUSS, TENSION ONLY or COMPRESSION ONLY.
For analyses which involve members that carry axial loads only, i.e. truss members, there are two methods for specifying this condition. When all the members in the structure are truss members, the type of structure is declared as TRUSS whereas, when only some of the members are truss members (e.g. bracings of a building), the MEMBER TRUSS command can be used where those members will be identified separately. In STAAD, the MEMBER TENSION or MEMBER COMPRESSION command can be used to limit the axial load type the member may carry. Refer to Section 5.23.3 for details on this facility.
General Description
1-50
Section 1
Cable members may be specified by using the MEMBER CABLE command. While specifying cable members, the initial tension in the cable must be provided. The following paragraph explains how cable stiffness is calculated. The increase in length of a loaded cable is a combination of two effects. The first component is the elastic stretch, and is governed by the familiar spring relationship:
F = Kx where Kelastic = EA L
The second component of the lengthening is due to a change in geometry (as a cable is pulled taut, sag is reduced). This relationship can be described by
12T
w L
2 3
( 1.0 / cos 2 )
w = weight per unit length of cable T = tension in cable = angle that the axis of the cable makes with a horizontal plane (= 0, cable is horizontal; = 90, cable is vertical).
Therefore, the "stiffness" of a cable depends on the initial installed tension (or sag). These two effects may be combined as follows
Section 1
1-51
K comb = (EA/L) / [1+w 2 L 2 EA(cos 2 )/12T 3 ] Note: When T = infinity, K comb = EA/L When T = 0, K comb = 0
It may be noticed that as the tension increases (sag decreases) the combined stiffness approaches that of the pure elastic situation. The following points need to be considered when using the linear cable member in STAAD : 1) The linear cable member is only a truss member whose properties accommodate the sag factor and initial tension. The behavior of this cable member is identical to that of the truss member. It can carry axial loads only. As a result, the fundamental rules involved in modeling truss members have to be followed when modeling cable members. For example, when two cable members meet at a common joint, if there isn't a support or a 3rd member connected to that joint, it is a point of potential instability. 2) Due to the reasons specified in 1) above, applying a transverse load on a cable member is not advisable. The load will be converted to two concentrated loads at the 2 ends of the cable and the true deflection pattern of the cable will never be realized. 3) A tension only cable member offers no resistance to a compressive force applied at its ends. When the end joints of the member are subjected to a compressive force, they "give in" thereby causing the cable to sag. Under these circumstances, the cable member has zero stiffness and this situation has to be accounted for in the stiffness matrix and the displacements have to be recalculated. But in STAAD, merely declaring the member to be a cable member does not guarantee that this behavior will be accounted for. It is also important
General Description
1-52
Section 1
that the user declare the member to be a tension only member by using the MEMBER TENSION command, after the CABLE command. This will ensure that the program will test the nature of the force in the member after the analysis and if it is compressive, the member is switched off and the stiffness matrix re-calculated. 4) Due to potential instability problems explained in item 1 above, users should also avoid modeling a catenary by breaking it down into a number of straight line segments. The linear cable member in STAAD cannot be used to simulate the behavior of a catenary. By catenary, we are referring to those structural components which have a curved profile and develop axial forces due to their self weight. This behavior is in reality a non-linear behavior where the axial force is caused because of either a change in the profile of the member or induced by large displacements, neither of which are valid assumptions in an elastic analysis. A typical example of a catenary is the main U shaped cable used in suspension bridges. 5) The increase of stiffness of the cable as the tension in it increases under applied loading is updated after each iteration if the cable members are also declared to be MEMBER TENSION. However, iteration stops when all tension members are in tension or slack; not when the cable tension converges.
Section 1
1-53
There are two cable types in the nonlinear PERFORM CABLE ANALYSIS procedure. One is the cable whose stiffness is described in the equations of section 1.11.1 above. However, in the nonlinear cable analysis, the cable may have large motions and the sag is checked on every load step and every equilibrium iteration. The second cable type is not available yet. It is a catenary shaped cable that is integrated along its length to determine its end forces on every load step and every equilibrium iteration. In addition there is a nonlinear truss which is specified in the Member Truss command. The nonlinear truss is simply any truss with pretension specified. It is essentially the same as a cable without sag but also takes compression. If all cables are taut for all load cases, then the nonlinear truss may be used to simulate cables. The reason for using this substitution is that the truss solution is more reliable. Points 1, 2, and 4 in the prior section above will not apply to nonlinear cable analysis if sufficient pretension is applied, so joints may be entered along the shape of a cable (in some cases a stabilizing stiffness may be required and entered for the first loadstep). Point 3 above: The Member Tension command is ignored for the nonlinear cable analysis. Point 5 above: The cable tensions are iterated to convergence in the nonlinear cable analysis; so do not enter multiple PERFORM ANALYSIS commands.
General Description
1-54
Section 1
WP refers to the location of the centroid of the starting or ending point of the member
7" WP n1 1 WP
6"
n2 9" 2 WP X
Section 1
1-55
General Description
1-56
Section 1
1.14 Supports
See section 5.27
STAAD allows specifications of supports that are parallel as well as inclined to the global axes. Supports are specified as PINNED, FIXED, or FIXED with different releases (known as FIXED BUT). A pinned support has restraints against all translational movement and none against rotational movement. In other words, a pinned support will have reactions for all forces but will resist no moments. A fixed support has restraints against all directions of movement. The restraints of a FIXED BUT support can be released in any desired direction as specified in section 5.27. Translational and rotational springs can also be specified. The springs are represented in terms of their spring constants. A translational spring constant is defined as the force to displace a support joint one length unit in the specified global direction. Similarly, a rotational spring constant is defined as the force to rotate the support joint one degree around the specified global direction. For static analysis, Multi-linear spring supports can be used to model the varying, non-linear resistance of a support (e.g. soil). See section 5.27 for descriptions of the elastic footing and elastic foundation mat facilities. The Support command is also used to specify joints and directions where support displacements will be enforced.
Section 1
1-57
displacements as the master joint. The user is also allowed the flexibility to choose the specific degrees of freedom for which the displacement constraints will be imposed on the slaved joints. If all degrees of freedom (Fx, Fy, Fz, Mx, My and Mz) are provided as constraints, the joints will be assumed to be rigidly connected.
1.16 Loads
Loads in a structure can be specified as joint load, member load, temperature load and fixed-end member load. STAAD can also generate the self-weight of the structure and use it as uniformly distributed member loads in analysis. Any fraction of this selfweight can also be applied in any desired direction.
Joint loads, both forces and moments, may be applied to any free joint of a structure. These loads act in the global coordinate system of the structure. Positive forces act in the positive coordinate directions. Any number of loads may be applied on a single joint, in which case the loads will be additive on that joint.
General Description
1-58
Section 1
Any number of loads may be specified to act upon a member in any independent loading condition. Member loads can be specified in the member coordinate system or the global coordinate system. Uniformly distributed member loads provided in the global coordinate system may be specified to act along the full or projected member length. Refer to Fig. 1.3 to find the relation of the member to the global coordinate systems for specifying member loads. Positive forces act in the positive coordinate directions, local or global, as the case may be.
Section 1
1-59
General Description
1-60
Section 1
Figure 1.37 shows a floor structure with area load specification of 0.1.
6m 4m 5m 5m X
10 4m
11 6m
12
13
Figure 1.37
Member 1 will have a linear load of 0.3 at one end and 0.2 at the other end. Members 2 and 4 will have a uniform load of 0.5 over the full length. Member 3 will have a linear load of 0.45 and 0.55 at respective ends. Member 5 will have a uniform load of 0.25. The rest of the members, 6 through 13, will have no contributory area load since the nearest parallel members are more than each of the member lengths apart. However, the reactions from the members to the girder will be considered. Only member loads are generated from the Area, Oneway and Floor load input. Thus, load types specific to plates, solids or surface are not generated. That is because, the basic assumption is that, a floor load or area load is used in situations where the basic entity (plate, solid or surface) which acts as the medium for application of that load, is not part of the structural model.
Section 1
1-61
y = ax2 + bx + c
where
General Description
1-62
Section 1
em = eccentricity of cable at middle of member (in local y-axis) ee = eccentricity of cable at end of member (in local y-axis) L = Length of member 2) The angle of inclination of the cable with respect to the local x-axis (a straight line joining the start and end joints of the member) at the start and end points is small which gives rise to the assumption that
sin = = dy / dx
Hence, if the axial force in the cable is P, the vertical component of the force at the ends is P(dy / dx) and the horizontal component of the cable force is,
P 1
dy dx
Users are advised to ensure that their cable profile meets this requirement. An angle under 5 degrees is recommended. 3) The member is analyzed for the prestressing/poststressing effects using the equivalent load method. This method is well documented in most reputed books on Analysis and Design of Prestressed concrete. The magnitude of the uniformly distributed load is calculated as
udl = 8Pe L2
where P = axial force in the cable (es + ee) e= em 2 L = length of the member 4) The force in the cable is assumed to be same throughout the member length. No reduction is made in the cable forces to account for friction or other losses.
Section 1
1-63
5) The term MEMBER PRESTRESS as used in STAAD signifies the following condition. The structure is constructed first. Then, the prestressing force is applied on the relevant members. As a result, the members deform and depending on their end conditions, forces are transmitted to other members in the structure. In other words, "PRE" refers to the time of placement of the member in the structure relative to the time of stressing. 6) The term MEMBER POSTSTRESS as used in STAAD signifies the following condition. The members on which such load is applied are first cast in the factory. Following this, the prestressing force is applied on them. Meanwhile, the rest of the structure is constructed at the construction site. Then, the prestressed members are brought and placed in position on the partially built structure. Due to this sequence, the effects of prestressing are "experienced" by only the prestressed members and not transmitted to the rest of the structure. In other words, "POST" refers to the time of placement of the member in the structure relative to the time of stressing. 7) As may be evident from Item (6) above, it is not possible to compute the displacements of the ends of the POSTSTRESSED members for the effects of POSTSTRESSing, and hence are assumed to be zero. As a result, displacements of intermediate sections (See SECTION DISPLACEMENT command) are measured relative to the straight line joining the start and end joints of the members as defined by their initial JOINT COORDINATES.
General Description
1-64
Section 1
Uniform temperature difference throughout members and elements may be specified. Temperature differences across both faces of members and through the thickness of plates may also be specified (uniform temperature only for solids).. The program calculates the axial strain (elongation and shrinkage) due to the temperature difference for members. From this it calculates the induced forces in the member and the analysis is done accordingly. The strain intervals of elongation and shrinkage can be input directly.
Section 1
1-65
of the element must be provided in order to facilitate computation of these effects. 4) The self-weight of the elements can be applied using the SELFWEIGHT loading condition. The density of the elements has to be provided in order to facilitate computation of the selfweight. On Solid elements , the loading types available are 1. The self-weight of the solid elements can be applied using the SELFWEIGHT loading condition. The density of the elements has to be provided in order to facilitate computation of the self-weight. Joint loads which are forces or moments that are applied at the joints in the direction of the global axes. Temperature loads which may be constant throughout the solid elements (causing only elongation / shortening). The coefficient of thermal expansion for the material of the element must be provided in order to facilitate computation of these effects. Pressure on the faces of solids.
2.
3.
4.
Only translational stiffness is supported in solid elements. Thus, at joints where there are only solid elements, moments may not be applied. For efficiency, rotational supports should be used at these joints.
General Description
1-66
Section 1
Section 1
1-67
1.17.2 Seismic Load Generator based on UBC, IBC and other codes
See sections 5.31.2 and 5.32.12
The STAAD seismic load generator follows the procedure of equivalent lateral load analysis explained in UBC, IBC and several other codes. It is assumed that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions and Y will be the direction of the gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward (all Y joint coordinates positive). The user is required to set up his model accordingly. Total lateral seismic force or base shear is automatically calculated by STAAD using the appropriate equation from the code. IBC 2003, IBC 2000, UBC 1997, 1994, or 1985, IS:1893, Japanese, or Colombian specifications may be used. For load generation per the codes, the user is required to provide seismic zone coefficients, importance factors, soil characteristic parameters, etc. See section 5.31.2 for the detailed input required for each code. Instead of using the approximate code based formulas to estimate the building period in a certain direction, the program calculates the period using Raleigh quotient technique. This period is then utilized to calculate seismic coefficient C. After the base shear is calculated from the appropriate equation, it is distributed among the various levels and roof per the specifications. The distributed base shears are subsequently applied as lateral loads on the structure. These loads may then be utilized as normal load cases for analysis and design.
The Wind Load Generator is a utility which takes as input wind pressure and height ranges over which these pressures act and generates nodal point and member loads.
General Description
1-68
Section 1
This facility is available for two types of structures. a) Panel type or Closed structures b) Open structures Closed structures are ones like office buildings where nonstructural entities like a glass faade, aluminum sheets, timber panels or non-load bearing walls act as an obstruction to the wind. If these entities are not included in the structural model, the load generated as a result of wind blowing against them needs to be computed. So, the steps involved in load generation for such structures are i) identify the panels regions circumscribed by members so that a polygonal closed area is formed. The area may also be formed between the ground level along one edge and members along the other. ii) Calculate the panel area and multiply it by the wind pressure. iii) Convert the resulting force into nodal point loads. Plates and solids are not considered in the calculation of the panel area. Openings within the panels may be modelled with the help of exposure factors. An exposure factor is associated with each joint of the panel and is a fractional number by which the area affecting a joint of the panel can be reduced or increased. Open structures are those like transmission towers, in which the region between members is open allowing the wind to blow through. The procedure for load generation for open structures is i) Calculate the exposed area of the individual members of the model. ii) Multiply that exposed area by the wind pressure to arrive at the force and apply the force on individual members as a uniformly distributed load. It is assumed that all members of the structure within the specified ranges are subjected to the pressure and hence, they will all receive the load. The concept of members on the windward side shielding the members in the inside regions of the structure does not exist for open structures. As a large structure may consist of hundreds of panels and members, a considerable amount of work in calculating the loads can be avoided by the user with the help of this facility.
Section 1
1-69
Salient features of each type of analysis are discussed in the following sections. Detailed theoretical treatments of these features are available in standard structural engineering textbooks.
General Description
1-70
Section 1
plane stress effects as well as the plate bending effects are taken into consideration in the analysis.
Section 1
1-71
Local coordinate axes are assigned to each individual element and are oriented such that computing effort for element stiffness matrices are generalized and minimized. Global coordinate axes are a common datum established for all idealized elements so that element forces and displacements may be related to a common frame of reference.
Basic Equation
The complete stiffness matrix of the structure is obtained by systematically summing the contributions of the various member and element stiffness. The external loads on the structure are represented as discrete concentrated loads acting only at the nodal points of the structure. The stiffness matrix relates these loads to the displacements of the nodes by the equation: Aj = aj + Sj x Dj This formulation includes all the joints of the structure, whether they are free to displace or are restrained by supports. Those components of joint displacements that are free to move are called degrees of freedom. The total number of degrees of freedom represent the number of unknowns in the analysis.
General Description
1-72
Section 1
Consideration of Bandwidth
The method of decomposition is particularly efficient when applied to a symmetrically banded matrix. For this type of matrix fewer calculations are required due to the fact that elements outside the band are all equal to zero. STAAD takes full advantage of this bandwidth during solution, as it is important to have the least bandwidth to obtain the most efficient solution. For this purpose, STAAD offers features by which the program can internally rearrange the joint numbers to provide a better bandwidth.
Structural Integrity
The integrity of the structure is an important requirement that must be satisfied by all models. Users must make sure that the model developed represents one single structure only, not two or more separate structures. An "integral" structure or "one" structure may be defined as a system in which proper "stiffness connections" exist between the members/elements. The entire model functions as a single integrated load resisting system. Two or more independent structures within one model results in erroneous mathematical formulation and therefore, generates numerical problems. STAAD checks structural integrity using a sophisticated algorithm and reports detection of multiple structures within the model.
There are a variety of modeling problems which can give rise to instability conditions. They can be classified into two groups.
Section 1
1-73
a) Local instability - A local instability is a condition where the fixity conditions at the end(s) of a member are such as to cause an instability in the member about one or more degrees of freedom. Examples of local instability are: (i) Member Release: Members released at both ends for any of the following degrees of freedom (FX, FY, FZ and MX) will be subjected to this problem. (ii) A framed structure with columns and beams where the columns are defined as "TRUSS" members. Such a column has no capacity to transfer shears or moments from the superstructure to the supports. b) Global Instability - These are caused when the supports of the structure are such that they cannot offer any resistance to sliding or overturning of the structure in one or more directions. For example, a 2D structure (frame in the XY plane) which is defined as a SPACE FRAME with pinned supports and subjected to a force in the Z direction will topple over about the X-axis. Another example is that of a space frame with all the supports released for FX, FY or FZ.
2) Math precision
A math precision error is caused when numerical instabilities occur in the matrix decomposition (inversion) process. One of the terms of the equilibrium equation takes the form 1/(1-A), where A=k1/(k1+k2); k1 and k2 being the stiffness coefficients of two adjacent members. When a very "stiff" member is adjacent to a very "flexible" member, viz., when k1>>k2, or k1+k2 k1, A=1 and hence, 1/(1-A) =1/0. Thus, huge variations in stiffnesses of adjacent members are not permitted. Artificially high E or I values should be reduced when this occurs. Math precision errors are also caused when the units of length and force are not defined correctly for member lengths, member properties, constants etc.
General Description
1-74
Section 1
Users should ensure that the model defined represents one single structure only, not two or more separate structures. For example, in an effort to model an expansion joint, the user may end up defining separate structures within the same input file. Unintended multiple structures defined in one input file can lead to grossly erroneous results.
Structures subjected to lateral loads often experience secondary forces due to the movement of the point of application of vertical loads. This secondary effect, commonly known as the P-Delta effect, plays an important role in the analysis of the structure. In STAAD, a unique procedure has been adopted to incorporate the P-Delta effect into the analysis. The procedure consists of the following steps: 1) First, the primary deflections are calculated based on the provided external loading. 2) Primary deflections are then combined with the originally applied loading to create the secondary loadings. The load vector is then revised to include the secondary effects. The lateral loading must be present concurrently with the vertical loading for proper consideration of the P-Delta effect. The REPEAT LOAD facility (see Section 5.32.11) has been created with this requirement in mind. This facility allows the user to combine previously defined primary load cases to create a new primary load case. 3) A new stiffness analysis is carried out based on the revised load vector to generate new deflections.
Section 1
1-75
4) Element/Member forces and support reactions are calculated based on the new deflections. This procedure yields reasonably accurate results with small displacement problems. STAAD allows the user to go through multiple iterations of the P-Delta procedure if necessary. The user is allowed to specify the number of iterations based on the requirement. To set the displacement convergence tolerance, enter a SET DISP f command before the Joint Coordinates. If the change in displacement norm from one iteration to the next is less than f then it is converged. The P-Delta analysis is recommended by several design codes such as ACI 318, LRFD, IS456-1978, etc. in lieu of the moment magnification method for the calculation of more realistic forces and moments. P-Delta effects are calculated for frame members and plate elements only. They are not calculated for solid elements. P-Delta and Nonlinear analysis is restricted to structures where members and plate elements carry the vertical load from one structure level to the next.
General Description
1-76
Section 1
3. The static analysis is now performed with the combined loading to obtain the final result.
Section 1
1-77
This is a simple method that may not work in some cases because members are removed on interim iterations that are needed for stability. If instability messages appear on the 2 nd and subsequent iterations that did not appear on the first cycle, then do not use the solution. If this occurs on cases where only springs are the tension/compression entities, then use multi-linear spring analysis. The load cases in a tension/compression analysis must be separated by the CHANGE command and PERFORM ANALYSIS command. The SET NL command must be provided to specify the total number of primary load cases. There may not be any Multi-linear springs, NONLINEAR, or dynamic cases.
General Description
1-78
Section 1
tension and compression but cables have a reduced E modulus if not fully taut. Pretension is the force necessary to stretch the cable/truss from its unstressed length to enable it to fit between the two end joints. Alternatively, you may enter the unstressed length for cables. The current nonlinear cable analysis procedure can, in some cases, result in compressive forces in the final cable results. The procedure was developed for structures, loadings, and pretensioning loads that will result in sufficient tension in every cable for all loading conditions. The possibility of compression was considered acceptable in the initial implementation because most design codes strongly recommend cables to be in tension to avoid the undesirable dynamic effects of a slack cable such as galloping, singing, or pounding. The engineer should specify initial preloading tensions which will ensure that all cable results are in tension. In addition this procedure is much more reliable and efficient than general nonlinear algorithms. To minimize the compression the SAGMIN input variable can be set to a small value such as 0.01, however that can lead to a failure to converge unless many more steps are specified and a higher equilibrium iteration limit is specified. SAGMIN values below 0.70 generally requires some adjustments of the other input parameters to get convergence. Currently the cable is not automatically loaded by selfweight, but the user should ensure that selfweight is applied in every load case. Do not enter component load cases such as wind only; every case must be realistic. Member loads will be lumped at the ends for cables and trusses. Temperature load may also be applied to the cables and trusses. It is OK to break up the cable/truss into several members and apply forces to the intermediate joints. Y-up is assumed and required. The member force printed for the cable is Fx and is along the chord line between the displaced positions of the end joints.
Section 1
1-79
The analysis sequence is as follows: 1. Compute the unstressed length of the nonlinear members based on joint coordinates, pretension, and temperature. 2. Member/Element/Cable stiffness is formed. Cable stiffness is from EA/L and the sag formula plus a geometric stiffness based on current tension. 3. Assemble and solve the global matrix with the percentage of the total applied load used for this load step. 4. Perform equilibrium iterations to adjust the change in directions of the forces in the nonlinear cables, so that the structure is in static equilibrium in the deformed position. If force changes are too large or convergence criteria not met within default number of iterations then stop the analysis. 5. Go to step 2 and repeat with a greater percentage of the applied load. The nonlinear members will have an updated orientation with new tension and sag effects. 6. After 100% of the applied load has converged, then proceed to compute member forces, reactions, and static check. The static check is not exactly in balance due to the displacements of the applied static equivalent joint loads. The load cases in a non linear cable analysis must be separated by the CHANGE command and PERFORM CABLE ANALYSIS command. The SET NL command must be provided to specify the total number of primary load cases. There may not be any Multilinear springs, compression only, PDelta, NONLINEAR, or dynamic cases. Also for cables and preloaded trusses: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Do not use Member Offsets. Do not include the end joints in Master/Slave command. Do not connect to inclined support joints. Y direction must be up. Do not impose displacements. Do not use Support springs in the model. Applied loads do not change global directions due to displacements.
General Description
1-80
Section 1
8. Do not apply Prestress load, Fixed end load. 9. Do not use Load Combination command to combine cable analysis results. Use a primary case with Repeat Load instead.
The eigenproblem is solved for structure frequencies and mode shapes considering a diagonal, lumped mass matrix, with masses possible at all active d.o.f. included. Two solution methods may be used: the subspace iteration method for all problem sizes (default for all problem sizes), and the optional determinant search method for small problems.
Section 1
1-81
usually mass motion in other directions at some or all joints and these mass directions (loads in weight units) must be entered to be correct. Joint moments that are entered will be considered to 2 be weight moment of inertias (force-length units). Please enter selfweight, joint and element loadings in global directions with the same sign as much as possible so that the masses do not cancel each other. Member/Element loadings may also be used to generate joint translational masses. Member end joint moments that are generated by the member loading (including concentrated moments) are discarded as irrelevant to dynamics. Enter mass moments of inertia, if needed, at the joints as joint moments. STAAD uses a diagonal mass matrix of 6 lumped mass equations per joint. The selfweight or uniformly loaded member is lumped 50% to each end joint without rotational mass moments of inertia. The other element types are integrated but roughly speaking the weight is distributed equally amongst the joints of the element. The members/elements of finite element theory are simple mathematical representations of deformation meant to apply over a small region. The FEA procedures will converge if you subdivide the elements and rerun; then subdivide the elements that have significantly changed results and rerun; etc. until the key results are converged to the accuracy needed. An example of a simple beam problem that needs to subdivide real members to better represent the mass distribution (and the dynamic response and the force distribution response along members) is a simple floor beam between 2 columns will put all of the mass on the column joints. In this example, a vertical ground motion will not bend the beam even if there is a concentrated force (mass) at mid span.
General Description
1-82
Section 1
In addition, the dynamic results will not reflect the location of a mass within a member (i.e. the masses are lumped at the joints). This means that the motion, of a large mass in the middle of a member relative to the ends of the member, is not considered. This may affect the frequencies and mode shapes. If this is important to the solution, split the member into two. Another effect of moving the masses to the joints is that the resulting shear/moment distribution is based as if the masses were not within the member. Note also that if one end of a member is a support, then half of the that member mass is lumped at the support and will not move during the dynamic response.
This capability allows the user to analyze the structure for seismic loading. For any supplied response spectrum (either acceleration vs. period or displacement vs. period), joint displacements, member forces, and support reactions may be calculated. Modal responses may be combined using one of the square root of the sum of squares (SRSS), the complete quadratic combination (CQC), the ASCE4-98 (ASCE), the Ten Percent (TEN) or the absolute (ABS) methods to obtain the resultant responses. Results of the response spectrum analysis may be combined with the results of the static analysis to perform subsequent design. To account for reversibility of seismic activity, load combinations can
Section 1
1-83
STAAD is equipped with a facility to perform a response history analysis on a structure subjected to time varying forcing function loads at the joints and/or a ground motion at its base. This analysis is performed using the modal superposition method. Hence, all the active masses should be modeled as loads in order to facilitate determination of the mode shapes and frequencies. Please refer to the section above on "mass modeling" for additional information on this topic. In the mode superposition analysis, it is assumed that the structural response can be obtained from the "p" lowest modes. The equilibrium equations are written as
(1)
{x} = {}i qi
i =1
(2)
(3)
where is the modal damping ratio and the natural frequency for the i th mode. These are solved by the Wilson- method which is an unconditionally stable step by step scheme. The time step for the response is entered by the user or set to a default value, if not entered. The q i s are substituted in equation 2 to obtain the displacements {x} at each time step.
General Description
1-84
Section 1
F (t) = F0 sin ( t + )
In the above equation, F(t) = Value of the forcing function at any instant of time "t" F 0 = Peak value of the forcing function = Frequency of the forcing function = Phase Angle A plot of the above equation is shown in the figure below.
Figure 1.38
T he results are the maximums over the entire time period, including start-up transients. So, they do not match steady- state response.
Section 1
1-85
are chosen from this time 0 to n*tc in steps of "STEP" whe re n is the number of cycles and tc is the duration of one cycle. STEP is a value that the user may provide or may choose the default value that is built into the program. STAAD will adju st STEP so that a cycle will be evenly divided into one or more steps. Users may refer to section 5.31.4 of this manual for a list of input parameters that need to be specified for a Time History Analysis on a structure subjected to a Harmonic loading. T he relationship between variables that appear in the STAAD input and the corresponding terms in the equation shown above is explained below. F0 = AMPLITUDE = FREQUENCY = PHASE
General Description
1-86
Section 1
Figure 1.39a
Figure 1.39b
Section 1
1-87
Figure 1.39c
Figure 1.39d
General Description
1-88
Section 1
ST
Longer leg
RA
Y Y Y
Z Z
Section 1
1-89
Longer leg
ST
RA
Y Y Y
Z Z Z Z
General Description
1-90
Section 1
Solution of the stiffness equations yield displacements and forces at the joints or end points of the member. STAAD is equipped with the following secondary analysis capabilities to obtain results at intermediate points within a member. 1) 2) 3) 4) Member forces at intermediate sections. Member displacements at intermediate sections. Member stresses at specified sections. Force envelopes.
With the SECTION command, the user may choose any intermediate section of a member where forces and moments need to be calculated. These forces and moments may also be used in design of the members. The maximum number of sections specified may not exceed five, including one at the start and one at the end of a member. If no intermediate sections are requested, the program will consider the start and end member forces for design. However, of the sections provided, they are the only ones to be considered for design.
Like forces, displacements of intermediate sections of members can be printed or plotted. This command may not be used for truss or cable members.
Section 1
1-91
Member stresses can be printed at specified intermediate sections as well as at the start and end joints. These stresses include: a) Axial stress, which is calculated by dividing the axial force by the cross sectional area, b) Bending-y stress, which is calculated by dividing the moment in local-y direction by the section modulus in the same direction, c) Bending-z stress, which is the same as above except in local-z direction, d) Shear stresses (in y and z directions), and e) Combined stress, which is the sum of axial, bending-y and bending-z stresses. All the stresses are calculated as the absolute value.
MZ A positive moment will mean a moment causing tension at the top of the member. Conversely, a negative moment will cause tension at the bottom of the member. The top of a member is defined as the side towards positive local y-axis. MY Same as above, except about local z axis.
General Description
1-92
Section 1
Inactive Members
With the INACTIVE command, members can be made inactive. These inactive members will not be considered in the stiffness analysis or in any printout. The members made inactive by the INACTIVE command are made active again with the CHANGE command. This can be useful in an analysis where stage construction is modeled due to which, a set of members should be inactive for certain load cases. This can be accomplished by: a) making the desired members inactive b) providing the relevant load cases for which the members are inactive c) performing the analysis d) using the CHANGE command to make all the inactive members active e) making another set of members inactive and providing the proper load cases for which the members are meant to be inactive, performing the analysis and repeating the procedure as necessary
Section 1
1-93
Extensive design capabilities are available in STAAD for steel, concrete and timber sections. Detailed information on steel, concrete and timber design is presented in Sections 2, 3 and 4 respectively.
General Description
1-94
Section 1
Perform Rotation
See section 5.17
This command can be used to rotate the structure shape through any desired angle about any global axis. The rotated configuration can be used for further analysis and design. This command may be entered after the Joint Coordinates or between two Joint Coordinate commands or after all Member/Element Incidences are specified.
Substitute
See section 5.15
Joint and member numbers may be redefined in STAAD through the use of the SUBSTITUTE command. After a new set of numbers are assigned, input and output values will be in accordance with the new numbering scheme. This facility allows the user to specify numbering schemes that will result in simple input specification as well as easy interpretation of data.
STAAD is capable of calculating the center of gravity of the structure. The PRINT CG command may be utilized for this purpose.
2-1
STAAD contains a broad set of facilities for designing structural members as individual components of an analyzed structure. The member design facilities provide the user with the ability to carry out a number of different design operations. These facilities may be used selectively in accordance with the requirements of the design problem. The operations to perform a design are: Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values. These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements. Steel Design may be performed based on the following codes: AISC-ASD, AISC-LRFD and AASHTO. A brief description of each is presented in the following pages. Currently, STAAD supports steel design of wide flange, S, M, HP shapes, tees, angle, double angle, channel, double channel, pipes, tubes, beams with cover plate and composite beams (I shapes with concrete slab on top.
2-2
Section 2
C, MC, S, M, HP Shapes
The above shapes are available as listed in AISC (9th Edition) without decimal points. For example, C8X11.5 will be input as C8X11 and S15X42.9 will be input as S15X42, omitting the decimal weights. (Exception: MC6X151 for MC6X15.1 and MC6X153 for MC6X15.3.)
Section 2
2-3
10 TO 20 BY 2 TA ST C15X40 1 2 TA ST MC8X20
Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel. 21 22 24 TA D MC9X25 55 TO 60 TA D C8X18
Angles
Angle specifications in STAAD are different from those in the AISC manual. The following example illustrates angle specifications. L 40 35 6 = Angle symbol 10 times length of one leg in inch L 4 x 3-1/2 x 3/8 Thickness in 1/16th inch 10 times length of other leg in inch
Similarly, L505010 = L 5 x 5 x 5/8 and L904016 = L 9 x 4 x 1 At present, there are two ways to define the local y and z-axes for an angle section. To make the transition from the AISC Manual to the program data easy, the standard section for an angle is specified: 51 52 53 TA ST L40356 This specification has the local z-axis (i.e., the minor axis) corresponding to the Z-Z axis specified in the steel tables. Many
2-4
Section 2
engineers are familiar with a convention used by some other programs in which the local y-axis is the minor axis. STAAD provides for this convention by accepting the command: 54 55 56 TA RA L40356 (RA denotes reverse angle)
Double Angles
Short leg back to back or long leg back to back double angles can be specified by inputting the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle either LD or SD will serve the purpose. 14 TO 20 TA LD L35304 SP 0.5 Long leg back to back L3-1/2x3x1/4 with 0.5 space 23 27 TA SD L904012 Short leg back to back L9x4x3/4
Tees
Tees are not input by their actual names, as they are listed in the AISC manual, but instead by designating the beam shapes (W and S) from which they are cut. For example, 1 2 5 8 TA T W8X24 tee cut from W8X24 which is WT4X12
Section 2
2-5
Pipes
Two types of specifications can be used for pipe sections. In general pipes may be input by their outer and inner diameters. For example, 1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 2.0 ID 1.875 will mean a pipe with O.D. of 2.0 and I.D. of 1.875 in current input units.
Pipe sections listed in the AISC manual can be specified as follows. 5 TO 10 TA ST PIPX20 PIP X 20 denotes extra strong pipe of 2 in.dia Pipe symbol 10 X Dia. in inches specify only portion before decimal point
Tubes
Tubes from the AISC tables can be specified as follows. 5 TO 10 TA ST TUB120808 TUB 120 80 8 Tube Symbol Height x 10 (in.) Thickness in 1/16th in. Width x 10 (in.)
2-6
Section 2
Tubes, like pipes, can be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) as follows. 6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 is a tube that has a height of 8, a width of 6, and a wall thickness of 0.5. Member Selection cannot be performed on tubes specified in the latter way. Only code checking can be performed on these sections.
B 61 20 10
Thickness of flange in inches X 10 (Only use portion before decimal point) Nominal flange Width (inches)
1 TO 10 TA ST B612017 15 16 TA ST B682210
Castellated Beams
STAAD.Pro incorporates the non-composite castellated beam tables supplied by the steel products manufacturer SMI Steel Products. See section 2.16 for details.
Section 2
2-7
2-8
Section 2
F b = 0.66F y If meeting the requirements of this section of: a) b f /2t f is less than or equal to 65/ Fy b) b f /t f is less than or equal to 190/ Fy c) d/t is less than or equal to 640(1-3.74(f a /F y ))/ Fy when (f a /F y ) < 0.16, or than 257/ Fy if (f a /F y ) >0.16 d) The laterally unsupported length shall not exceed 76.0b f /F y (except for pipes or tubes), nor 20,000/(dF y /A f ) e) The diameter-thickness ratio of pipes shall not exceed 3300/F y If for these symmetrical members, b f /2t f exceeds 65/ less than 9 5/ Fy , F b =F y (0.79-0.002(b f /2 t f ) Fy )
Fy
, but is
For other symmetrical members which do not meet the above, F b is calculated as the larger value computed as per AISC formulas F1-6 or F1-7 and F1-8 as applicable, but not more than 0.60F y . An unstiffened member subject to axial compression or compression due to bending is considered fully effective when the widththickness ratio is not greater than the following: 76.0/ 95.0/ 127./ , for single angles or double angles with separators. , for double angles in contact. Fy , for stems of tees.
Fy Fy
When the actual width-thickness ratio exceeds these values, the allowable stress is governed by B5 of the AISC code. Tension and compression for the doubly symmetric (I & H) sections with b f /2t f less than 65/ Fy and bent about their minor axis, F b = 0.75F y If b f /2t f exceeds 65/ Fy , but is less than 95/ Fy , F b = F y (1.075-0.005(b f /2t f ) Fy ) For tubes, meeting the subparagraphs b and c of this Section, bent about the minor axis, F b = 0.66F y ; failing the subparagraphs b and c but a width-thickness ratio less than 238/ Fy , F b =0.6F y .
Section 2
2-9
2-10
Section 2
Methodology
If the user were to request design for torsion, the torsional properties required for calculating the warping normal stresses, warping shear stresses and pure shear stresses are first determined. These depend of the boundary conditions that prevail at the ends of the member. These boundary conditions are defined as Free, Pinned or Fixed. They are explained below: Free : Free represents the boundary condition such as that which exists at the free end of a cantilever beam. It means that there is no other member connected to the beam at that point. Pinned : Pinned represents the condition that corresponds to either a pinned support defined at the joint through the Support command or a release of any of the moments at the joint through a Member Release specification. Fixed : Fixed represents the condition where a fixed support exists at the joint. In the absence of a support at that joint, it represents a condition where a rigid frame connection exists between the given member and at least one other member connected to that joint. Also, no member releases should be present at that joint on the given member. After the boundary conditions are determined, the normal and shear stresses are determined. The guidelines specified in the publication T114 for concentrated torsional moments acting at the ends of the member are used to determine these stresses. The warping normal stresses are added to the axial stresses caused by axial load. These are then substituted into the interaction equations in Chapter H of the AISC 89 code for determining the ratio. The plane shear and warping shear stresses are added to the shear stresses causes by actual shear forces and compared against the allowable shear stresses on the cross section.
Section 2
2-11
Restrictions
This facility is currently available for Wide Flange shapes (W, M & S), Channels, Tee shapes, Pipes and Tubes. It is not available for Single Angles, Double Angles, members with the PRISMATIC property specification, Composite sections (Wide Flanges with concrete slabs or plates on top), or Double Channels. Also, the stresses are calculated based on the rules for concentrated torsional moments acting at the ends of the member.
The program contains a large number of parameter names which are needed to perform designing and code checking. These parameter names, with their default values, are listed in Table 2.1. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on
2-12
Section 2
the particular design requirements of an analysis, some or all of these parameter values may have to be changed to exactly model the physical structure. For example, by default the KZ (k value in local z-axis) value of a member is set to 1.0, while in the real structure it may be 1.5. In that case, the KZ value in the program can be changed to 1.5, as shown in the input instructions (Section 6). Similarly, the TRACK value of a member is set to 0.0, which means no allowable stresses of the member will be printed. If the allowable stresses are to be printed, the TRACK value must be set to 1.0. The parameters PROFILE, DMAX and DMIN are only used for member selection.
Section 2
2-13
NSF UNT
UNB
Member Length
CB
1.0
0.0 0.0 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.0
*Top and Bottom represent the positive and negative side of the local Y axis (local Z axis if SET Z UP is used.
2-14
Section 2
Default Value
Member length or depth of beam whichever is greater 0.0
Description
Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design
TRACK
Controls the level of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail (see Figure2.1) Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Weld type, as explained in section 2.12. A value of 1 will mean welding is on one side only except for wide-flange or tee sections, where the web is always assumed to be welded on both sides. A value of 2 will mean welding on both sides. For closed sections like pipe or tube, the welding will be on one side only. 0.0 = design at ends and those locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = design at ends and at every 1/12th point along member length. (Default) Used in member selection. See section 5.47.1 for details. Minimum welding thickness. Maximum welding thickness. Allowable welding stress. "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1)
1000 in. 0.0 in. 1.0 1 for closed sections 2 for open sections
BEAM
1.0
None See Sect. 2.12 See Sect. 2.12 0.4 x FYLD None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member
DJ1
Section 2
2-15
Default Value
End Joint of member
Description
Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1) 0 = deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type (see note below) 0.0 = No torsion check performed. 1.0 = Perform torsion check based on rules of AISC T114. 0.0 = Design tapered I-section based on rules of Chapter F and Appendix B only. Do not use the rules of Appendix F. 1.0 = Design tapered I-sections based on rules of Appendix F of AISC-89. Overstress Factor. All the allowable stresses are multiplied by this number. It may be assigned any value greater than 0.0. Is used to communicate increases in allowable stress for loads like wind and earthquake. 1 - Design single angles for bending based on principal axis. 2 - Design single angles for bending based on geometric axis. 1 Single Angle Member is not fully braced against lateral torsional buckling. 2 - Single Angle Member is fully braced against lateral torsional buckling. 3 - Single Angle Member is braced against lateral torsional buckling at the point of maximum moment.
CAN
TORSION
0.0
TAPER
1.0
OVR
1.0
AXIS
FLX
2-16
Section 2
NOTES: 1) When performing the deflection check, the user can choose between two methods. The first method, defined by a value 0 for the CAN parameter, is based on the local displacement. Local displacement is described in section 5.43 of this manual. If the CAN parameter is set to 1, the check will be based on cantilever style deflection. Let (DX1, DY1,DZ1) represent the nodal displacements (in global axes) at the node defined by DJ1 (or in the absence of DJ1, the start node of the member). Similarly, (DX2, DY2,DZ2) represent the deflection values at DJ2 or the end node of the member. Compute Delta = SQRT((DX2-DX1)**2 + (DY2-DY1)**2 + (DZ2-DZ1)**2) Compute Length = distance between DJ1 & DJ2 or, between start node and end node, as the case may be. Then, if CAN is specified a value 1, dff = L/Delta Ratio due to deflection = DFF/dff 2) If CAN = 0, deflection length is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the Deflection Length will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the Deflection Length may be different. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Also the straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be "1" and DJ2 should be "4".
Section 2
1 1 2 2 3 3 D 4
2-17
EXAMPLE :
3) If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from the original member line. 4) It is important to note that unless a DFF value is specified, STAAD will not perform a deflection check. This is in accordance with the fact that there is no default value for DFF (see Table 2.1). 5) A critical difference exists between the parameters UNT/UNB and the parameters LY & LZ. UNT/UNB parameters represent the laterally unsupported length of the compression flange. It is defined in Chapter F, page 5-47 of the specifications in the AISC 1989 ASD manual as the distance between cross sections braced against twist or lateral displacement of the compression flange. UNT/UNB parameters are used to calculate the allowable compressive stress (FCZ and FCY) for behavior as a beam. LY and LZ on the other hand are the unbraced lengths for behavior as a column and are used to calculate the KL/r ratios and the allowable axial compressive stress FA. 6) SSY and CMY are 2 parameters which are based upon 2 values defined in page 5-55, Chapter H of the AISC 9th ed. manual. SSY is a variable which allows the user to define whether or not the member is subject to sidesway in the local Y direction. CMY is a variable used for defining the expression called Cm in the AISC manual. When SSY is set to 0 (which is the default value), it means that the member is subject to sidesway in the local Y direction. When SSY is set to 1.0, it means that the member is not subject to sidesway in the local Y direction. The only effect that SSY has is that it causes the program to calculate the appropriate value of CMY. If SSY is set to 0 and CMY is not provided, STAAD will calculate CMY as 0.85. If SSY is set to 1 and CMY is not provided, STAAD will calculate CMY from the equation on page 5-55. However, if
2-18
Section 2
the user provides CMY, the program will use that value and not calculate CMY at all, regardless of what the user defines SSY to be.
Figure 2.1 - Terms used in calculating slenderness ratios KL/r for local Y and Z axes
7) For a T shape which is cut from a parent I, W, S, M or H shapes, the PROFILE parameter should be assigned a value corresponding to the parent shape. For example, if the T desired is an American WT6, specify W12 for the PROFILE parameter.
Section 2
2-19
When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed the code or have failed; the critical condition of the AISC code (like any of the AISC specifications or compression, tension, shear, etc.); the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for a value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member) of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs. Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2.2 of this manual.
2-20
Section 2
Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic.
Steel table properties of an entire structure can be optimized by STAAD. The method used in the optimization, which takes place if the SELECT OPTIMIZE command is specified, involves the following steps. a. b. c. d. e. CHECK CODE ALL Modify the ratios SELECT ALL PERFORM ANALYSIS SELECT ALL
An additional step of Grouping may be performed if the FIXED GROUP and GROUP commands are provided (see section 5.48). After the last step, a re-analysis is not automatically performed, so users must ensure that they specify the analysis command following the SELECT OPTIMIZE command.
Section 2
2-21
member rather than as a regular frame member with both ends pinned.
2-22
Section 2
The following parameters have been introduced to support the composite member design, specified using the explicit definition method.
Table 2.2 Composite Beam Design Parameters for AISC-ASD Parameter Name
CMP
Default value
0
Description
Composite action with connectors 0 = design as a non-composite beam 1 = design as a composite beam if the slab is in bending compression throughout the span, design as a non-composite beam if the slab is in tension anywhere along the span 2 = design as a composite beam only. Ignore moments which cause tension in the slab. Diameter of shear connectors Height of shear connectors after welding Ratio of moment due to dead load applied before concrete hardens to the total moment Effective Width of concrete slab Compressive strength of concrete at 28 days Thickness of cover plate welded to bottom flange of composite beam Width of cover plate welded to bottom flange of composite beam Height of rib of form steel deck Width of rib of form steel deck Temporary shoring during construction 0 = without shoring 1 = with shoring Thickness of concrete slab or the thickness of concrete slab above the form steel deck.
0.25 times the member length 3.0 ksi 0.0 0.0 0.0 2.5 in 0
THK
4.0 in
Section 2
2-23
UNIT INCH PARAMETER CODE AISC BEAM 1 ALL TRACK 2 ALL DR1 0.3135 ALL WID 69.525 ALL FPC 3.0 ALL THK 4.0 ALL CMP 1 ALL CHECK CODE ALL SELECT ALL
2-24
Section 2
a) MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b) TABLE refers to the AISC steel section name which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c) RESULT prints whether the member has PASSed or FAILed. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark in front of the member number. d) CRITICAL COND refers to the section of the AISC code which governed the design. e) RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f) LOADING provides the load case number which governed the design.
g) FX, MY and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local yaxis and moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments to perform design, only FX MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h) LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i) If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print the allowable bending stresses in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV), all in kips per square inch. In addition, member length, area, section moduli, governing KL/r ratio and CB are also printed. In the output for TRACK 2.0, the items Fey and Fez are as follows:
j)
Section 2
2-25
Fey =
23( K Y L Y rY ) 12 2
12
2
Fez =
23( K Z L Z rZ )
STAAD.Pro MEMBER SELECTION - (AISC 9TH EDITION) ************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 2 * | | | AX = 8.85 | | * | ST W14X30 | | --Z AY = 3.39 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 3.47 | | AISC-1989 * =============================== ===|=== SY = 5.82 | | * SZ = 42.05 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 19.00 --->| RY = 1.49 | |************* RZ = 5.73 | | | | 70.5 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | L1 IN KIP INCH | |--------------- + L3 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 153.21 | L3 FA = 6.36 | | KL/R-Z= 39.76 + fa = 0.45 | | UNL = 120.00 | L3 L1 FCZ = 21.68 | | CB = 1.00 +L1 FTZ = 24.00 | | CMY = 0.85 | L3 L3 FCY = 30.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + FTY = 30.00 | | FYLD = 40.00 | L1 fbz = 20.13 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 13.8 FV = 16.00 | | dff = 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fey = 6.36 | | (WITH LOAD NO.) Fez = 94.46 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE 4.7 24.3 0.0 0.0 70.5 | | LOCATION 0.0 19.0 0.0 0.0 9.5 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS AISC- H1-3 0.999 1 | | 3.99 C 0.00 -70.55 9.50 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Figure 2.2
2-26
Section 2
ANGLE
y
WIDEFLANGE
y z z y y z z
TEE
y z
CHANNEL
y z
PIPE
y z
TUBE
y z
y z
y z
Figure 2.3
Actual stresses, calculated from the member forces, can be specified by three names, based on their directions.
Section 2
2-27
Horizontal Stress - as produced by the local z-shear force and torsional moment. Vertical Stress - as produced by the axial y-shear force and torsional moment. Direct Stress - as produced by the axial force and bending moments in the local y and z directions. The Combined Stress is calculated by the square root of the summation of the squares of the above three principal stresses. Following are the equations: Forces MX = MY = MZ = FX = VY = VZ = Torsional moment Bending in local y-axis Bending in local z-axis Axial force Shear in local y-axis Shear in local z-axis
Properties of Weld AX SY SZ JW CH Area of the weld as the line member Section modulus around local y-axis Section modulus around local z-axis Polar moment of inertia Distance of the extreme fiber for horizontal (local z) forces CV = Distance of the extreme fiber for vertical (local y) forces Stress Equations: Horizontal stress, Fh = = = = = =
VZ AX
CH MX JW
2-28
Section 2
Vertical stress, Fv =
VY AX
+
CV MX JW
*
Direct stress, Fd =
FX AX
MZ
SZ
MY
SY
* The moments MY and MZ are taken as absolute values, which may result in some conservative results for asymmetrical sections like angle, tee and channel.
where F w = Allowable weld stress, default value is 0.4 FYLD (Table 2.1). The thickness t is rounded up to the nearest 1/16th of an inch and all the stresses are recalculated. The tabulated output prints the latter stresses. If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the output will include the weld properties. The program does not calculate the minimum weld thickness as needed by some codes, but checks only against the minimum thickness as provided by the user (or 1/16th inch if not provided). When the TRUSS qualifier is used with SELECT WELD command, the program will design the welds required for truss angle and double angle members that are attached to gusset plates. The program reports the number of welds (two for single angles, four for double angles), and the length required for each weld. The thickness of the weld is taken as 1/4 inch (6 mm) for members up to 1/4 inch (6 mm) thick, and 1/16 inch (1.5 mm) less than the angle thickness for members greater than 1/4 inch (6 mm) thick. Minimum weld length is taken as four times weld thickness.
Section 2
2-29
The section of the above code implemented in STAAD is Chapter 10, Part C Service Load design Method, Allowable Stress design. Sections 10.32.1.A and 10.36 are implemented. As per the AASHTO committee, this is the last edition for this code (the ASD approach) and only technical errors will be fixed in the future for this code. In general, the concepts followed in MEMBER SELECTION and CODE CHECKING procedures are similar to that of the AISC based design. It is assumed that the user is familiar with the basic concepts of steel design facilities available in STAAD. Please refer to Section 2 of the STAAD Technical Reference Manual for detailed information on this topic. This section specifically addresses the implementation of steel design based on AASHTO specifications. Design is available for all standard sections listed in the AISC ASD 9 th edition manual, namely, Wide Flanges, S, M, HP, Tees, Channels, Single Angles, Double Angles, Tubes and Pipes. Design of HSS sections (those listed in the 3 rd edition AISC LRFD
2-30
Section 2
manual) and Composite beams (I shapes with concrete slab on top) is not suppported.
Allowable Stresses per AASHTO Code
The member design and code checking in STAAD is based upon the allowable stress design method. It is a method for proportioning structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. It is beyond the scope of this manual to describe every aspect of structural steel design per AASHTO specifications because of practical reasons. This section will discuss the salient features of the allowable stresses specified by the AASHTO code. Table 10.32.1A of the AASHTO code specifies the allowable stresses.
Axial Stress
Allowable tension stress, as calculated in AASHTO is based on the net section. This tends to produce a slightly conservative result. Allowable tension stress on the net section is given by,
Ft = 0. 55Fy
Allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members is calculated based on the following formula:
Fy F.S. E F. S.( Kl / r )
2
2 2
Fa =
(1- (Kl / r) Fy 4 E
2
when ( Kl / r ) < C c
Fa =
when ( Kl / r ) > C c
1/ 2
with C c = (2 E / Fy )
Section 2
2-31
It can be mentioned here that AASHTO does not have a provision for increase in allowable stresses for a secondary member and when 1/r exceeds a certain value.
Bending Stress
Allowable stress in bending compression for rolled shape girders and built-up sections whose compression flanges are supported laterally through their full length by embedment in concrete is given by
Fb = 0. 55Fy
For similar members with unsupported or partially supported flange lengths, the allowable bending compressive stress is given by
Fcz
Due to inadequate information in the AASHTO Code, the allowable tensile stresses due to bending for both axes are set to be the same as the corresponding allowable bending compressive stresses.
Shear Stress
For shear on the web, the gross section is defined as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. The AASHTO code does not specify any allowable stress for shear on flanges. The program assumes the same allowable for shear stress (0.33Fy) for both shear on the web and shear on the flanges. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as 2/3 times the total flange area.
2-32
Section 2
Members subjected to both axial and bending stresses are proportioned according to section 10.36 of the AASHTO steel code. All members subject to bending and axial compression are required to satisfy the following formula: fa Fa + C mx f bx (1 f a / Fex ) Fbx + C my f by (1 f a / Fey ) Fby < 1. 0
at support points. The start and end nodes of a member are treated as support points. For members subject to axial tension and bending, the following equations are checked.
f a f bx f by + + Fa Fbx Fby
<1.0
<1.0
at ends of member.
Section 2
2-33
Default Value
1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 36 KSI Depends on FYLD 1.0 Member Length 0.0 0.0 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.0 1.0
Description
K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in local z-axis. Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Net section factor for tension members. Unsupported length of compression flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis. 1.0 = No sidesway Same as above except in local z-axis. Cm value in local y & z axes
0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses.
Verification Problem
One verification problem is shown in the next few pages for reference purposes.
2-34
Section 2
Verification Problem
TYPE:
REFERENCE: Attached step by step hand calculation as per AASHTO code. PROBLEM:
Determine the allowable stresses (AASHTO code) for the members of the structure as shown in figure. Also, perform a code check for these members based on the results of the analysis.
Y 2k/ft (DL + LL)
5 5' 2 8 16'
15 (WL)
5 7
6 8
9 7 4 4'
3
10' 1
4
11' 3
Figure 2.5
Members 1, 2 = W12X26, Members 3, 4 = W14X43 Members 5, 6, 7 = W16X36, Memb 8= L40404, Memb 9 = L50506
SOLUTION COMPARISON:
Governing ratios for the members Member No. Hand Calculation STAAD. Pro 1.218 1.903 1.204 1.126 .690 0.732 0.809 1.09 .928 1.217 1.092 1.203 1.126 .689 0.729 0.808 1.09 .927 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Section 2
2-35
Manual / Code refers to AASHTO Manual . Steel Design Member 1 , Size W 12X26, L = 10 ft., a = 7.65 in 2 , Sz = 33.39 in 3
From observation Load case 1 will govern, Fx = 25.0 kip (compression), Mz = 56.5 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Bending Major Axis:
Fcz
Where, C b = 1.75+ 1.05(M1/M2)+0.3x(M1/M2) 2 Here M1 = 0, so C b = 1.75 S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =204/(0.5X12.22) = 33.38789 in 3 I YC = tb 3 /12 = 0.38 x 6.49 3 /12 = 8.6564 in 4 J = (2 x 6.49x0.38 3 + (12.22 2x0.38)x0.23 3 )/3 = 0.28389 in 4
2-36
Section 2
Fcz =
50 106 1.75 8.6564 0.28389 11.46 + 9.87 0.772 = 33.38789 120 8.6564 120
64375.03 psi From this, calculated FCZ = 64.37.As this is larger than 0.55xFY FCZ = 0.55xF Y = 19.8 ksi
Axial Compression:
Cc =
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 = = 126.099 Fy 36
<
As (kL/r) y
ksi
Shear:
Actual stress (f a ) = 25/7.65 = 3.26 ksi. Actual bending stress = 56.5 x12/33.4 = 1.691616 x 12 = 20.29932 ksi The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio.
Section 2
2-37
Fez =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 * 29000
120 2.12 5.17
2
= 250.5999
Cmy f by fa Cmx fbz 3.26 0.85* 20.299 + + = + + 0 = 1.122 3.26 13.58 Fa fa fa 119.8 F 1 Fbz 1 F 'ey by 250.599 F 'ez
For the end section, Equation 10-43
From observation Load case 1 will govern, Forces at the midspan are Fx = 8.71 kip (compression), Mz = 56.5 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
2-38
Section 2
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Bending Major Axis:
Fcz
Where, C b = 1.75+ 1.05(M1/M2)+0.3x(M1/M2) 2 Here M1 = 39.44, M2 = 677.96 so C b = 1.69 S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =204/(0.5X12.22) = 33.38789 in 3 I YC = tb 3 /12 = 0.38 x 6.49 3 /12 = 8.6564 in 4 J = (2 x 6.49x0.38 3 + (12.22 2x0.38)x0.23 3 )/3 = 0.28389 in 4
Fcz
227337.5 psi Since FCZ is larger than 0.55xF Y, FCZ = 0.55xF Y = 19.8 ksi
Axial Compression:
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 Cc = = = 126.099 Fy 36
Section 2
2-39
As (KL/r) y
<
Shear:
Axial stress (f a ) = 8.71 / 7.65 = 1.138 ksi. The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 56.5 x12/33.4 = 1.691 x 12 = 20.299 ksi (KL/r) z = 1x60/5.16 = 11.618 11.628
Fez =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 * 29000
2.12 (11.618 )
2
= 998.524
Cmy f by fa Cmx fbz 1.138 0.85* 20.299 + + = + + 0 = 0.942 16.13 1.138 Fa fa fa 119.8 F 1 Fbz 1 F 'ey by 1000.22 F 'ez
2-40
Section 2
From observation Load case 3 will govern, Forces at the end are Fx = 25.5 kip (compression), Mz = 112.17 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Major Axis:
Fcz =
Where, C b = 1.75+ 1.05(M1/M2)+0.3x(M1/M2) 2 Here M1 = 0, so C b = 1.75 S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =428/(0.5X13.66) = 62.7 in 3
Section 2
2-41
I YC = tb /12 = 0.53 x 8.0 /12 = 22.61in J = (2 x 8.0x0.53 3 + (13.66 2x0.53)x0.305 3 )/3 = 0.913 in 4
Fcz
50 106 1.75 22.61 0.917 12.6 = + 9.87 0.772 = 83 62.7 22.61 132 132
187.61 psi Since FCZ is larger than 0.55xF Y, FCZ = 0.55xF Y = 19.8 ksi
Axial Compression:
Cc =
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 = = 126.099 Fy 36
<
As (KL/r) y
Shear:
Axial stress (f a ) = 25.5 / 12.6 = 2.024 ksi. The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 112.17 x12/62.7 = 1.789 x 12 = 21.467 ksi (KL/r) z = 1x132/5.828 = 22.649
2-42
Section 2
Fez =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 * 29000
2.12 ( 22.648 )
2
= 263.18
Cmy f by fa Cmx fbz 2.024 0.85* 21.467 + + = + + 0 = 1.069 2.024 14.387 Fa fa fa 119.8 F 1 Fbz 1 F 'ey by 263.209 F 'ez
for the end section, Equation 10-43
From observation Load case 3 will govern, Forces at the end are Fx = 8.75 kip (tension), Mz = 112.17 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Section 2
2-43
Fcz =
Where, C b = 1.75+ 1.05(M1/M2)+0.3x(M1/M2) 2 Here M1 = -191.36 Kip-in , M2 = -1346.08 Kip-in so C b = 1.606 S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =428/(0.5X13.66) = 62.7 in 3 I YC = tb 3 /12 = 0.53 x 8.0 3 /12 = 22.61in 4 J = (2 x 8.0x0.53 3 + (13.66 2x0.530)x0.305 3 )/3 = 0.911 in 4
Fcz
08752.2 psi Since FCZ is larger than 0.55xF Y, FCZ = 0.55xF Y = 19.8 ksi
Axial Compression:
2-44
Section 2
The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 112.17 x12/62.7 = 1.789 x 12 = 21.467 ksi
From observation Load case 3 will govern, Forces at the end are Fx = 14.02 kip (compression), Mz = 57.04 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Major Axis:
Fcz
Section 2
2-45
S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =448/(0.5X15.86) = 56.5 in 3 I YC = tb 3 /12 = 0.43 x 6.99 3 /12 = 12.238 in 4 J = (2 x 6.99x0.43 3 + (15.86 2x0.43)x0.29 3 )/3 = 0.5 in 4
Fcz
63079 psi Since FCZ is larger than 0.55xF Y, FCZ = 0.55xF Y = 19.8 ksi
Axial Compression:
= 39.474
Cc =
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 = = 126.099 Fy 36
<
As (KL/r) y
Shear:
2-46
Section 2
Axial stress (f a ) = 14.02 / 10.6 = 1.323 ksi. The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 57.04 x12/56.5 = 1.001 x 12 = 12.115 ksi (KL/r) z = 1x60/6.5= 9.231
Fez =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 * 29000
2.12 ( 9.231)
2
= 1584.398
Cmy f by fa Cmx f bz 1.323 0.85*12.115 + + = + + 0 = 0.602 1.323 16.149 Fa fa fa 119.8 F 1 Fbz 1 F 'ey by 1584.398 F 'ez
for the end section, Equation 10-43
Section 2
2-47
From observation Load case 3 will govern, Forces at the end are Fx = 10.2 kip (compression), Mz = 62.96 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Major Axis:
Fcz
Where, C b = 1.75+ 1.05(M1/M2)+0.3x(M1/M2) 2 Here M1 = 8.947 M2 = 183.05, so C b = 1.69 S zc =Section modulus w.r.t. compression flange =448/(0.5X15.86) = 56.5 in 3 I YC = tb 3 /12 = 0.43 x 6.99 3 /12 = 12.238 in 4 J = (2 x 6.99x0.43 3 + (15.86 2x0.43)x0.29 3 )/3 = 0.5 in 4
Fcz
50 106 1.69 12.238 0.5 15 = + 9.87 0.772 = 56.5 12.238 192 192
28789.17 psi
2-48
Section 2
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 Cc = = = 126.099 Fy 36
As (KL/r) y
>
Fa =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 *29000
2.12* (126.29 )
2
= 8.46 ksi
Shear:
Axial stress (f a ) = 10.2 /10.6 = 0.962ksi. The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 62.96 x12/56.5 = 1.26106 x 12 = 13. 372 ksi (KL/r) z = 1x192 /6.5 = 29.538
Fez =
2E
F .S . ( KL r )
2
2 * 29000
2.12 ( 29.538 )
2
= 154.58
154.58
Section 2
2-49
Cmy f by fa Cmx fbz 0.962 0.85*13.372 + + = + + 0 = 0.691 8.46 Fa 0.926 fa fa 119.8 F 1 Fbz 1 F 'ey by 154.58 F 'ez
From observation Load case 3 will govern, Forces at the midspan are Fx = 24.05 kip (tension), Mz = 62.96 k-ft
Allowable Stress Calculation:
Allowable minor axis bending stress: FTY = FTZ = 0.55 x F Y = 19.8 ksi
Major Axis:
2-50
Section 2
Axial Tension:
Actual stress (f a ) = 24.05 /10.6 = 2.268 ksi, hence safe. From Table 10.32.1A, Allowable stress in bending(compression) The critical moment occurs at the end node of the beam. So we use the AASHTO equation 10.42 in section 10-36 to calculate the design ratio. Actual bending stress = 62.96 x12/56.5 = 1.11433 x 12 = 13.372 ksi So the design ratio is
From observation Load case 1 will govern, Forces Fx = 23.04 kip (compression)
Section 2
2-51
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 Cc = = = 126.099 Fy 36
As (KL/r) y
<
ksi
Actual Stress Calculation:
From observation Load case 1 will govern, Forces Fx = 48.44 kip (compression)
Allowable Stress Calculation: Axial Compression:
2-52
Section 2
Cc =
2 2 E 2 2 * 29000 = = 126.099 Fy 36
<
As (KL/r) y
si
Actual Stress Calculation:
Section 2
2-53
**************************************************** * * * STAAD.Pro * * Version Bld * * Proprietary Program of * * Research Engineers, Intl. * * Date= * * Time= * * * * USER ID: * ****************************************************
1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 11. 12. 13. 15. 16. 17. 19. 21. 22. 23. 24. 26. 27. 29. 30. 31. 33.
STAAD PLANE VERIFICATION PROBLEM FOR AASHTO CODE * * THIS DESIGN EXAMPLE IS VERIFIED BY HAND CALCULATION * FOLLOWING AASHTO ASD 97 CODE. * UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 25 0 ; 3 0 10 ; 4 25 11 5 0 15 ; 6 25 15 ; 7 5 15 ; 8 21 15 MEMB INCI 1 1 3 ; 2 3 5 ; 3 2 4 ; 4 4 6 5 5 7 ; 6 7 8 ; 7 8 6 ; 8 3 7 ; 9 4 8 MEMB PROP AMERICAN 1 2 TA ST W12X26 ; 3 4 TA ST W14X43 5 6 7 TA ST W16X36 ; 8 TA ST L40404 ; 9 TA ST L50506 MEMB TRUSS ; 8 9 CONSTANT E 4176E3 ALL POISSON STEEL ALL SUPPORT ; 1 2 PINNED LOADING 1 DL + LL MEMB LOAD ; 5 6 7 UNI Y -2.0 LOADING 2 WIND FROM LEFT JOINT LOAD ; 5 FX 15. LOAD COMB 3 ; 1 0.75 2 0.75 PERFORM ANALYSIS
P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S -----------------------------------
NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 8/ 9/ ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 4/ 4/ 15 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 2, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19214.5 MB
2 20
2-54
Section 2
35. PRINT FORCES
MEMBER END FORCES STRUCTURE TYPE = PLANE ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KIP FEET MEMBER LOAD JT AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z TORSION MOM-Y MOM-Z
1 3
1 3 1 3 3 5 3 5 2 4 2 4 4 6 4 6 5 7 5 7 7 8 7 8 8 6 8 6 3 7 3 7 4 8 4 8
25.00 -25.00 12.00 -12.00 8.71 -8.71 15.83 -15.83 25.00 -25.00 25.50 -25.50 6.50 -6.50 -8.75 8.75 -10.64 10.64 14.02 -14.02 5.65 -5.65 10.20 -10.20 -12.85 12.85 -24.06 24.06 23.04 -23.04 -5.41 5.41 26.16 -26.16 48.44 -48.44
-5.65 5.65 1.05 -1.05 10.64 -10.64 -2.77 2.77 5.65 -5.65 10.20 -10.20 -12.85 12.85 -24.06 24.06 8.71 1.29 15.83 -8.33 15.00 17.00 4.50 19.50 1.50 6.50 14.75 -8.75 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
0.00 -56.50 0.00 10.52 56.50 -3.29 -10.52 -3.34 0.00 62.15 0.00 112.17 -62.15 10.76 -112.17 15.95 3.29 15.25 3.34 57.04 -15.25 -0.75 -57.04 -62.96 0.75 -10.76 62.96 -15.95 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
1 3
1 3
1 3
1 3
1 3
1 3
1 3
1 3
Section 2
40. CHECK CODE ALL
STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (AASH) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE FEET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED)
2-55
RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= * 1 ST W12X26 FAIL 25.00 C * 2 ST W12X26 FAIL 8.71 C * 3 ST W14X43 FAIL 25.50 C * 4 ST W14X43 FAIL 8.75 T 5 ST W16X36 PASS 14.02 C 6 ST W16X36 PASS 10.20 C 7 ST W16X36 PASS 24.06 T * 8 ST L40404 FAIL 23.04 C 9 ST L50506 PASS 48.44 C (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 1.218 0.00 56.50 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 1.093 0.00 56.50 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 1.204 0.00 -112.17 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 1.126 0.00 -112.17 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 0.690 0.00 -57.04 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 0.732 0.00 62.96 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-43 0.809 0.00 62.96 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-42 1.091 0.00 0.00 (AISC SECTIONS) AASHTO 10-42 0.928 0.00 0.00
41. FINISH
2-56
Section 2
Section 2
2-57
In the STAAD implementation of LRFD, members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the limit states of strength, stability and serviceability. Accordingly, the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria as augmented by the designer in specification of allowable member depths, desired section type, or other such parameters. The code checking portion of the program checks that code requirements for each selected section are met and identifies the governing criteria. The following sections describe the salient features of the LRFD specifications as implemented in STAAD steel design. A detailed description of the design process along with its underlying concepts and assumptions is available in the LRFD manual. However, since the design philosophy is drastically different from the conventional Allowable Stress Design (ASD), a brief description of the fundamental concepts is presented here to initiate the user into the design process.
The left side is the required strength, which is the summation of the load effects, Qi (forces and moments). The right side, the design strength, is the nominal strength or resistance, R n , divided by a factor of safety. When divided by the appropriate section property (area or section modulus), the two sides of the inequality become the actual stress and allowable stress respectively. ASD, then, is characterized by the use of unfactored "working" loads in conjunction with a single factor of safety applied to the resistance. Because of the greater variability and, hence, unpredictability of
2-58
Section 2
the live load and other loads in comparison with the dead load, a uniform reliability is not possible. LRFD, as its name implies, uses separate factors for each load and resistance. Because the different factors reflect the degree of uncertainty of different loads and combinations of loads and of the accuracy of predicted strength, a more uniform reliability is possible. The LRFD method may be summarized by the inequality
y i Qi < R n
On the left side of the inequality, the required strength is the summation of the various load effects, Q i , multiplied by their respective load factors, y i . The design strength, on the right side, is the nominal strength or resistance, R n , multiplied by a resistance factor, . In the STAAD implementation of LRFD, it is assumed that the user will use appropriate load factors and create the load combinations necessary for analysis. The design portion of the program will take into consideration the load effects (forces and moments) obtained from analysis. In calculation of resistances of various elements (beams, columns etc.), resistance (nominal strength) and applicable resistance factor will be automatically considered.
Section 2
2-59
Sect. C1 of the LRFD specification, an analysis of second order effects is required. Thus, when using LRFD code for steel design, the user must use the P-Delta analysis feature of STAAD.
2-60
Section 2
Section 2
2-61
2-62
Section 2
The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. The parameters DMAX and DMIN are applicable for member selection only.
Default Value
1.0 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length Member Length 36.0 ksi 60.0 ksi 1.0
Description
K value for flexural-torsional buckling. K value in local Y-axis. Usually this is the minor axis. K value in local Z-axis. Usually this is the major axis. Length for flexural-torsional buckling. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y-axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Z-axis. Yield strength of steel. Ultimate tensile strength of steel. Net section factor for tension members.
Section 2
2-63
Default Value
Member Length
Description
Unsupported length (Lb ) of the top* flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the top flange. Unsupported length (Lb ) of the bottom* flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the bottom flange. Spacing of stiffeners for beams for shear design. Coefficient Cb per Chapter F. If Cb is set to 0.0, it will be calculated by the program. Any other value will be directly used in design. 0.0 = Suppress all design strengths. 1.0 = Print all design strengths. 2.0 = Print expanded design output. Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1 of Table 2.1) Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1of Table 2.1) 0 = deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type Permissible ratio of actual load effect to design strength. 0.0 = design at ends and those locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = design at ends and at every 1/12th point along member length. (Default)
UNB
Member Length
STIFF
CB **
TRACK
0.0
45.0 in. 0.0 in. None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member 0
DJ1
DJ2 CAN
RATIO BEAM
1.0 1.0
2-64
Section 2
Default Value
None 1
Description
Used in member selection. See section 5.47.1 for details. 1 - Design single angles for bending based on principal axis. 2 - Design single angles for bending based on geometric axis. 1 Single Angle Member is not fully braced against lateral torsional buckling. 2 - Single Angle Member is fully braced against lateral torsional buckling. 3 - Single Angle Member is braced against lateral torsional buckling at the point of maximum moment.
FLX
*Top and Bottom represent the positive and negative side of the local Y axis (local Z axis if SET Z UP is used). Note: For a description of the deflection check parameters DFF, DJ1, DJ2 and CAN, see the Notes section of Table 2.1 of this manual. The STIFF parameter represents the term a as defined in Section F2, page 6-113 of the LRFD 2 nd edition manual. ** Non-default values of CB must be re-entered before every subsequent CHECK CODE or SELECT command.
Section 2
2-65
Example for the LRFD-2001 code UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER CODE LRFD or CODE LRFD3 FYLD 50 ALL UNT 72 MEMBER 1 TO 10 UNB 72 MEMB 1 TO 10 MAIN 1.0 MEMB 17 20 SELECT MEMB 30 TO 40 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 TO 30
Example for the LRFD-1994 code UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER CODE LRFD2 FYLD 50 ALL UNT 72 MEMBER 1 TO 10 UNB 72 MEMB 1 TO 10 MAIN 1.0 MEMB 17 20 SELECT MEMB 30 TO 40 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 TO 30
2-66
Section 2
If the TRACK is set to 1.0, member design strengths will be printed out.
2.14.13 Composite Beam Design per the American LRFD 3rd edition code
The design of composite beams per the 3 rd edition of the American LRFD code has been implemented. The salient points of this feature are as follows:
Figure 2.6
Theoretical basis:
1.
2.
Find the maximum tensile force carried by the steel beam as: As . fy Tensile strength of concrete is ignored.
Section 2
2-67
3.
If step 1 produces a higher value than step 2, plastic neutral axis (PNA) is in the slab. Else, it is in the steel beam.
CASE 1: PNA IN SLAB
Find the depth of PNA below the top of slab as: 0.85 f c . b . a . = A s . f y a=
As . f y 0.85 f c . b
fC
a hr t
P.N.A.
fy
d/2
d d/2
T fy
Figure 2.7
Lever arm e =
d a + hr + t 2 2
Moment capacity =
b A s . f y . e
2-68
Section 2
Define: C s = Compressive force in slab = 0.85 . f c . b . t C b = Compressive force in steel beam T b = Tensile force in steel beam Cs + Cb = Tb Since magnitude of C b + magnitude of T b = A s . f y Substituting for T b as (A s . f y C b ), we get: Cs + Cb = As . fy Cb C b = (A s . f y C s ) x 0.5 Determine whether the PNA is within the top flange of steel beam, or inside its web. C f = Maximum compressive force carried by flange = Af . fy where, A f = Area of flange If C f >= C b , PNA is in the flange. If C f < C b , PNA is in the web.
Section 2
2-69
fC
t hr y P.N.A.
CS fy Cf e1 Tb
fy
e2
fy
Figure 2.8
Calculate: y=
Cf
(b f . f y )
where, b f = width of flange The point of action of the tensile force is the centroid of the steel area below the PNA. After finding that point, e 1 and e 2 can be calculated. Moment Capacity =
b C f . e1 + C s . e 2
2-70
Section 2
fC
t hr g
CS Cf Cw e3 e1 TS
fy
e2
P.N.A.
fy
Figure 2.9
Cw
(t w . f y ) where, t
= thickness of web
Point of action of the tensile force is the centroid of the steel area below the PNA. After finding that point, e 1 , e 2 and e 3 can be calculated. Moment Capacity =
b (C s . e 2 + C f . e1 + C w . e 3 )
Section 2
2-71
Notes
1. 2.
Rib Height is the distance from top of flange of steel beam to lower surface of concrete. If the slab is flush on top of the steel beam, set the Rib Height to zero.
Reinforced-concrete slab
Rib Height
Figure 2.10
3.
For moments which cause tension in the slab (called positive moments in STAAD convention), design of the beam is presently not carried out. Shear connectors are presently not designed. Member selection is presently not carried out. In order to design a member as a composite beam, the member property specification during the analysis phase of the data must contain the CM attribute. See section 5.20.1 of the STAAD Technical Reference manual for details.
4. 5. 6.
2-72
Section 2
TABLE 2.5 COMPOSITE BEAM DESIGN PARAMETERS FOR AISC-LRFD Name Default value Description
Example STAAD SPACE MEMBER PROPERTY 1 TA CM W12X26 CT 6.0 FC 4.0 CW 40.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE LRFD RBH 5.0 MEMB 1 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 FINISH
Section 2
2-73
Provisions of the AISI Specification for the Design of ColdFormed Steel Structural Members, 1996 Edition have been implemented. The program allows design of single (noncomposite) members in tension, compression, bending, shear, as well as their combinations using the LRFD Method. For flexural members, the Nominal Section Strength is calculated on the basis of initiation of yielding in the effective section (Procedure I). Strength increase from Cold Work of Forming is a user selectable option.
Cross-Sectional Properties
The user specifies the geometry of the cross-section by choosing one of the section shape designations from the STAAD Steel Tables for cold-formed sections, which mirror the Gross Section Property Tables published in the "Cold- Formed Steel Design Manual", AISI, 1996 Edition. The Tables are currently available for the following shapes:
Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Angle with Lips Angle without Lips Z with Lips Z without Lips Hat
Shape selection may be done using the member property pages of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section
2-74
Section 2
designation symbol in the input file. Details of the latter are explained below.
The AISI Steel Section Library:
The command-line syntax for assigning steel sections from the AISI library is as explained below :
C-Section With Lips
Section 2
2-75
At the present time, only standard single sections are available for specification. Options such as double angles, double channels, and user provided sections including pipes and tubes will be available at a later date. Additionally, combination sections, such as an angle placed on top of a channel, or a plate welded to the top, bottom or side of one of the above shapes, are not available at this time. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.
2-76
Section 2
Design Procedure
The following two design modes are available: 1. Code Checking The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with the LRFD Method of the AISI code. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. 2. Member Selection The user may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (AISI standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, present design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not. The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with the following Sections:
B2.1, Uniformly Compressed Stiffened Elements B2.3, Webs and Stiffened Elements with Stress Gradient B3.1, Uniformly Compressed Unstiffened Elements B3.2, Unstiffened Elements and Edge Stiffeners with Stress Gradient B4.2, Uniformly Compressed Elements with an Edge Stiffener
Section 2
2-77
Cross-sectional properties of members are checked for compliance with the following Sections:
B1.1(a), Maximum Flat-Width-to-Thickness Ratios, and B1.2, Maximum Web Depth-to-Thickness Ratio
The program checks member strength in accordance with Chapter C of the specification as follows: 1. Tension Members. Resistance is calculated in accordance with Section C2. 2. Flexural Members. a) C3.1, Strength for bending only:
C3.1.1, Nominal Section Strength, Procedure I C3.1.2, Lateral Buckling Strength b) C3.2, Strength for Shear Only
c) C3.3, Strength for Combined Bending and Shear 3. Concentrically Loaded Compression Members. a) C4.1, Sections not subject to Torsional or Torsional-Flexural Buckling, and b) C4.2, Doubly or Singly Symmetric sections subject to Torsional or Torsional-Flexural Buckling. 4. Combined Axial Load and Bending. a) C5.1, Combined Tensile Axial Load and Bending, and b) C5.2, Combined Compressive Axial Load and Bending.
2-78
Section 2
The following table contains the input parameters for specifying values of design variables and selection of design options.
Default Value
1.0
Description
When this parameter is set to 1.0 (default), the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details). If neither the BEAM parameter nor any SECTION command is specified, STAAD will terminate the run and ask the user to provide one of those 2 commands. This rule is not enforced for TRUSS members. End moment coefficient for bending about Z axis. See AISI C5.2.2. Used for combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. End moment coefficient for bending about Y axis. See AISI C5.2.2. Used for combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See AISI A7.2. Values: 0 effect should not be included 1 effect should be included
CMZ
1.0
CMY
0.0
CWY
Section 2
2-79
Default Value
1000.0
Description
Maximum depth permissible for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Minimum depth required for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Specifies whether torsional-flexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See AISI C4.1 Values: 0 Section subject to torsional flexural buckling and restraint not provided 1 restraint provided or unnecessary
DMIN
0.0
FLX
FU FYLD KT
Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Yield strength of steel in current units. Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall column buckling about the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unitless. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression.
KY
1.0
2-80
Section 2
Default Value
1.0
Description
Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. Net section factor for tension members, See AISI C2.
LT
Member length
LY
Member length
LZ
Member length
NSF
1.0
Section 2
2-81
Default Value
Member length
Description
Spacing in the longitudinal direction of shear stiffeners for reinforced web elements. It is input in the current units of length. See section AISI C3.2 This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0 - Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1 - Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 2 - Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 2.
TRACK
TSA
Specifies whether bearing and intermediate transverse stiffeners are present. If true, the program uses the more liberal set of interaction equations in AISI C3.3.2. Values: 0 Beams with un-reinforced webs 1 Beams with transverse web stiffeners
2-82
Section 2
Figure 2.11
According to the manufacturer, castellated beams are manufactured by cutting a wide flange along the web in a zig-zag pattern, offsetting the two halves, and welding the two halves together, as shown in the next figure. As a result, the underlying steel section is a wide flange (W shapes) in the AISC table or a B shape. STAAD currently supports only the ones derived from W shapes.
Figure 2.12
Section 2
2-83
The local axis system (local X, local Y and local Z) of a castellated beam is identical to that for a wide flange, and is shown in section 1.5.2 of the Technical Reference manual. Users have to recognize that there are two basic issues to be understood with regard to these members a) analysis b) steel design We first explain the design issues because only then will their relationship with the analysis issues become apparent. Design of a castellated beam is done only for FY (shear along the web) and MZ (moment about the major axis which is the Z axis). If at the start of the design process, the program detects that the beam has axial force (FX), shear along local-Z (FZ), torsion (MX) or moment about the minor axis (MY), design of that member will be terminated. And now we come to how these design limitations have a bearing on the analysis issues. If the user intends to design these members, as a result of the above restrictions, he/she must model it in such a way that none of the 4 unacceptable degrees of freedom end up with a non-zero value anywhere along the length of the member. That means, if the member ends are defined as supports, the support conditions must be defined with the above in mind. Similarly, if the castellated member is attached to other members, its end conditions (MEMBER RELEASES) must be modeled taking the above facts into consideration. The design limitations also have a bearing on the type of loads that are applied to the member. Loads which cause any of the abovementioned four degrees of freedom to end up with a non-zero value will cause the member design to be terminated. However, if the user wishes to only analyze the structure, and is not interested in performing a steel design, the above described restrictions for supports, member end conditions or loading are not applicable.
2-84
Section 2
The design method is the allowable stress method, using mainly the rules stated in the AISC ASD 9 th edition code. Only code checking is currently available for castellated beams. Member selection is not.
Design parameters:
The following table contains a list of parameters and their default values.
Table 2.7
Parameter SOPEN Default Value 1.5e + b is the minimum allowable value. Any user-specified value higher than or equal to this minimum will be used by the program. e and b are as described in the next figure. 1.5e + b is the minimum allowable value. Any user-specified value higher than or equal to this minimum will be used by the program. e and b are as described in the next figure. Member length Description Distance from the start of the member to the center of the first hole.
EOPEN
Distance from the center of the last hole to the end of the member.
UNL
Unsupported length of compression flange for calculating allowable bending stress. Yield Stress of Steel Cb value used for computing the allowable bending stress per Chapter F of AISC specifications.
FYLD CB
36 ksi 1.0
Section 2
2-85
Table 2.7
Parameter CMZ Default Value 0.85 Description Cm value in local Z axis. Used in the interaction equations in Chapter H of AISC specifications. Parameter used to control the level of description of design output. Permissible values are 0 and 1 . Permissible maximum ratio of actual load to section capacity. Any input value will be used to change the right hand side of governing interaction equations in Chapter H and elsewhere.
TRACK
RATIO
1.0
References:
STAAD.Pros design of castellated beams is based on the information gathered from the following sources: a. Design of Welded Structures -- Omer W. Blodget, published by The James Lincoln Arc Welding Foundation, pages 4.7-8 and 4.7-9
b. AISC 9 th edition manual Allowable stress design c. ASCE Journal of Structural Engineering 124:10, October 1998 castellated beam web buckling in shear, R.G. Redwood and S. Demirdjian
Design procedure:
Cross-section checks: The first check that is carried out is a verification whether the member properties satisfy certain basic requirements. If the
2-86
Section 2
member fails these checks, the remainder of the checks are not performed. The cross section checks are the following:
Figure 2.13
1. Web Post Width ( e ) should be at least 3.0 inches 2. Tee Depth ( d T -top and d T -bot ) should be greater than the thickness of flange plus one inch. 3. Angle should be between 45 and 70 degrees. 4. In order for the program to determine the number of holes which are admissible for the beam, the parameters SOPEN and EOPEN need to be assigned. In the figure above, there is a term shown as S. This value is part of the section tables supplied with STAAD.Pro, so it retrieves that value from there. It then computes the number of holes, and the remainder of the terms shown in the above diagram. 5. SOPEN and EOPEN (see the parameter table shown earlier) have to be at least 1.5e + b, with e and b as shown in the earlier figure. If the user inputs a value less than these minima, the minimum values are used.
Section 2
2-87
Checking the member for adequacy in carrying the applied loading: This consists of five different checks: 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Global Bending Vierendeel Bending Horizontal Shear Vertical Shear Web Post Buckling
Design for
Section considered in the design (shown with the vertical dotted lines)
Vierendeel Bending
Figure 2.14
2-88
Section 2
1.
Global Bending: Global bending check is done at the web post section. This is the region of the member where the full cross section is active, without interference of the holes. The actual bending stress is computed at the middle of the web post location and is obtained by dividing the moment by the section modulus of the full section. For computing the allowable bending stress, the compactness of the section is first determined in accordance with Table B5.1 in the Chapter B of the AISC 9 th edition specifications. The rules applicable to I-shaped sections are used for this. Following this, the allowable bending stress is computed per chapter F of the same. The ratio is computed by dividing the actual stress by the allowable stress.
2.
Vierendeel Bending: This is checked at the middle of the hole locations. The effective cross section at these locations is a Tee. The overall moment (Mz) at the span point corresponding to the middle of the hole is converted to an axial force and a moment on the Tee. The actual stress is computed at the top and bottom of each Tee section. fa = M / ( deffect * At ) where At is the area of the Tee section fb = V * e * a / ( 2 S ) where a is the area factor. For the top Tee section, a = Area of Top Tee / ( Area of Top Tee + Area of Bottom Tee )
Section 2
2-89
Axial Stress: The allowable axial stress is computed as per the Chapter E of the AISC specifications. The unsupported length for column buckling is equal to e. Bending Stress: The allowable bending stress is computed for the top and bottom Tee section as per the Chapter F of the AISC manual. The axial stress plus bending stress is computed at the top and bottom of each tee section. If it is compressive then it is checked against equations H1-1 and H1-2 of Chapter H of the AISC manual. If it is tensile then it is checked against equation H2-1.
3.
Horizontal Shear: Allowable Shear stress is computed as 0.4 Fy. Actual Stress: Please refer to pages 4.7-8 and 4.7-9 of the reference book on welded structures mentioned under Item (a) earlier.
4.
Vertical Shear: Allowable Shear stress is computed as 0.4 Fy. The actual shear stress is computed at the middle of the web post location.
5.
Web Post buckling: Please refer to pages 1202-1207 of the ASCE journal mentioned under Item (c) earlier.
2-90
Section 2
The command syntax in the STAAD input file for assigning castellated beams is:
MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN Member-list TABLE ST section-name Example MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 2 TABLE ST CB12x28
Under the PARAMETERS block on input, the code name must be specified as:
CODE AISC CASTELLATED Example
PARAMETER CODE AISC CASTELLATED UNL 0.01 MEMB 25 31 FYLD 50 MEMB 25 31 SOPEN 11.124 MEMB 25 31 CHECK CODE MEMB 25 31
Section 2
2-91
A typical TRACK 2 level output page from the STAAD output file is as shown.
Figure 2.15
2-92
Section 2
After the analysis and design is completed, double click on the castellated member. This feature, known as member query, brings up a dialog box, one of whose tabs will be Castellated Beam Design as shown.
Figure 2.16
Section 2
2-93
Example Problem :
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE PROBLEM FOR *CASTELLATED BEAM DESIGN UNIT FT KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0. 0. ; 2 45 0 3 0 15; 4 45 15 MEMBER INCIDENCE 1 1 3; 2 3 4; 3 4 2 MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 2 TA ST CB27x40 1 3 TA ST W21X50 UNIT INCH CONSTANTS E STEEL ALL DEN STEEL ALL POISSON STEEL ALL MEMBER RELEASE 2 START MX MY MZ 2 END MY MZ UNIT FT SUPPORT 1 2 FIXED LOADING 1 DEAD AND LIVE LOAD MEMB LOAD 2 UNI Y -0.4
2-94
Section 2
LOADING 2 WIND FROM LEFT MEMBER LOAD 2 UNI Y -0.6 LOAD COMB 3 1 1.0 2 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 3 PRINT MEMBER FORCES PRINT SUPPORT REACTION UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER CODE AISC CASTELLATED UNL 0.01 MEMB 2 FYLD 50 MEMB 2 CMZ 0.85 MEMB 2 CB 1.1 MEMB 2 TRACK 2.0 ALL SOPEN 11.124 MEMB 2 EOPEN 11.124 MEMB 2 CHECK CODE MEMB 2 FINISH
3-1
STAAD has the capabilities for performing concrete design. It will calculate the reinforcement needed for the specified concrete section. All the concrete design calculations are based on the current ACI 318. Two versions of the code are currently implemented. The 2002 edition and the 1999 edition. To access the 2002 edition, specify the commands: START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI or CODE ACI 2002 To access the 1999 edition, use the commands: START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 1999
3-2
Section 3
Prismatic (Rectangular & Square), Trapezoidal and T-shapes Prismatic (Rectangular, Square and Circular) Finite element with a specified thickness.
ZD
ZD
YD YD YB YD
ZB TRAPEZOIDAL
Figure 3.1
Section 3
3-3
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (18 inch depth and 12 inch width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 12 inch diameter. It can been seen that no area (AX) is provided for these members. For concrete design, this property must not be provided. If shear areas and moments of inertias are not provided, the program calculates these values from YD and ZD. Notice that in the above example the IZ and IY values provided are actually 50% of the values calculated using YD and ZD. This is a conventional practice which takes into consideration revised section parameters due to cracking of section. The third and the fourth set of members in the above example represent a T-shape and a TRAPEZOIDAL shape respectively. Depending on the properties (YD, ZD, YB, ZB, etc.) provided, the program will determine whether the section is rectangular, trapezoidal or T-shaped and the BEAM design will be done accordingly.
3-4
Section 3
generate load cases which contain loads magnified by the appropriate load factors. Table 3.1 ACI 318 Design Parameters Parameter Name
FYMAIN FYSEC FC CLT CLB CLS MINMAIN ** MINSEC ** MAXMAIN ** SFACE
Default Value
* 60,000 psi * 60,000 psi * 4,000 psi * 1.5 inch * 1.5 inch * 1.5 inch Number 4 bar Number 4 bar Number 18 bar *0.0
Description
Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Yield Stress for secondary steel. Compressive Strength of Concrete. Clear cover for top reinforcement. Clear cover for bottom reinforcement. Clear cover for side reinforcement. Minimum main reinforcement bar size. (Number 4 - 18) Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum main reinforcement bar size Face of support location at start of beam. If specified, the shear force at start is computed at a distance of SFACE+d from the start joint of the member. Face of support location at end of beam. (Note: Both SFACE & EFACE are input as positive numbers) If specified, the shear force at end is computed at a distance of EFACE+d from the end joint of the member.. Tied Column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral. A factor by which the column design moments will be magnified. Width of concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
EFACE
*0.0
REINF MMAG
WIDTH
Section 3
3-5
Default Value
*YD
Description
Depth of concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design. BEAM DESIGN: With TRACK set to 0.0, Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. A value of 1.0 will mean a print out. A value of 2.0 will print out required steel areas for all intermediate sections specified by NSECTION. COLUMN DESIGN: TRACK 0.0 prints out detailed design results. TRACK 1.0 prints out column interaction analysis results in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. TRACK 2.0 prints out a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values in addition to all of above.
NSECTION ***
12
TRACK
0.0
RHOMN
Minimum reinforcement (as the fractional number) required in a concrete column. Enter a value between 0.0 and 0.08 where 0.08 stands for 8%, the max allowed by the ACI code.
* These values must be provided in the current unit system being used. ** When using metric units for ACI design, provide values for these parameters in actual 'mm' units instead of the bar number. The following metric bar sizes are available: 6 mm, 8 mm, 10 mm, 12 mm, 16 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm, 32 mm, 40 mm, 50 mm and 60 mm. *** NSECTION should have no member list since it applies to all members. The minimum value allowed is 12, the maximum is 20. If more than one NSECTION entered, then highest value is used.
3-6
Section 3
Section 3
3-7
combinations of forces and moments, whereas a primary load case is revised during the pdelta analysis based on the deflections. Also, the proper factored loads (such as 1.4 for DL etc.) should be provided by the user. STAAD does not factor the loads automatically.
3-8
Section 3
Section 3
3-9
Example for beam design per the ACI 318-2002 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 2002 or CODE ACI FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL DESIGN BEAM 1 7 10 END CONCRETE DESIGN
Example for beam design per the ACI 318-1999 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 1999 FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL DESIGN BEAM 1 7 10 END CONCRETE DESIGN
3-10
Section 3
3) 4) 5) 6)
BAR INFO Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and bar size. FROM TO ANCHOR Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the reinforcement bar. Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the reinforcement bar. States whether anchorage,
(STA/END) either a hook or continuation, is needed at start (STA) or at the end. 7) ROW Actually required flexural reinforcement (As/bd) where b = width of cross section (ZD for rectangular and square section) and d = effective depth of cross section (YD - distance from extreme tension fiber to the c.g. of main reinforcement). Minimum required flexural reinforcement (Amin/bd) Maximum allowable flexural reinforcement (Amax/bd) Distance between centers of adjacent bars of main reinforcement Factored shear force at section. Nominal shear strength provided by concrete. Nominal shear strength provided by shear reinforcement. Factored torsional moment at section Nominal torsional moment strength provided by concrete. Nominal torsional moment strength provided by torsion reinforcement.
HOOK IF ANCHOR IS YES STIRRUP SPACING
Figure 3.2
Table 3.2
Section 3
3-11
FY - 60000.
FC - 4000.
HEIGHT BAR INFO FROM TO ANCHOR FT. IN. FT. IN. FT. IN. STA END --------------------------------------------------------------------1 0 + 2-5/8 3-NUM.9 2 + 4-5/8 20 + 0-0/0 NO YES |----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL POS MOMENT= 189.77 KIP-FT AT 12.00 FT, LOAD 1 | | REQD STEEL= 2.48 IN2, ROW=0.0090, ROWMX=0.0214 ROWMN=0.0033 | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 7.50/ 2.26/ 4.94 INCH | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 37.95/ 31.42 INCH | |----------------------------------------------------------------| 2 1 + 6-1/8 4-NUM.11 0 + 0-0/0 18 +10-0/0 YES NO |----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL NEG MOMENT= 369.86 KIP-FT AT 0.00 FT, LOAD 1 | | REQD STEEL= 5.47 IN2, ROW=0.0198, ROWMX=0.0214 ROWMN=0.0033 | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 7.50/ 2.82/ 3.20 INCH | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 59.20/153.91 INCH | |----------------------------------------------------------------| 3 1 + 6-3/8 3-NUM.6 16 + 8-1/4 20 + 0-0/0 NO YES |----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL NEG MOMENT= 105.87 KIP-FT AT 20.00 FT, LOAD 1 | | REQD STEEL= 1.31 IN2, ROW=0.0047, ROWMX=0.0214 ROWMN=0.0033 | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 7.50/ 1.75/ 5.13 INCH | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 16.70/ 27.75 INCH | |----------------------------------------------------------------| B E A M N O. 14 D E S I G N R E S U L T S - SHEAR KIP Vs= 63.61 KIP IN. C/C FOR 108. IN. KIP Vs= 32.56 KIP IN. C/C FOR 84. IN.
AT START SUPPORT - Vu= 83.90 KIP Vc= 35.10 PROVIDE NUM. 4 BARS AT 7.0 AT END SUPPORT - Vu= 57.51 KIP Vc= 35.10 PROVIDE NUM. 4 BARS AT 9.3
Figure 3.3
3-12
Section 3
Figure 3.4
Figure 3.5
Section 3
3-13
A typical screen from the STAAD beam design output, showing the cracked moment of inertia value, is shown below.
Figure 3.6
3-14
Section 3
2) Find an approximate arrangement of bars for the assumed reinforcement. 3) Calculate PNMAX = 0.85 Po, where Po is the maximum axial load capacity of the section. Ensure that the actual nominal load on the column does not exceed PNMAX. If PNMAX is less than Pu/PHI, (PHI is the strength reduction factor) increase the reinforcement and repeat steps 2 and 3. If the reinforcement exceeds 8%, the column cannot be designed with its current dimensions. 4) For the assumed reinforcement, bar arrangement and axial load, find the uniaxial moment capacities of the column for the Y and the Z axes, independently. These values are referred to as MYCAP and MZCAP respectively. 5) Solve the Interaction equation
M ny M nz 1.0 + M ycap M zcap
where =1.24 If the column is subjected to a uniaxial moment, is chosen as 1.0 6) If the Interaction equation is satisfied, find an arrangement with available bar sizes, find the uniaxial capacities and solve the interaction equation again. If the equation is satisfied now, the reinforcement details are written to the output file. 7) If the interaction equation is not satisfied, the assumed reinforcement is increased (ensuring that it is under 8%) and steps 2 to 6 are repeated.
Column Interaction
The column interaction values may be obtained by using the design parameter TRACK 1.0 or TRACK 2.0 for the column member. If a value of 2.0 is used for the TRACK parameter, 12 different Pn-Mn pairs, each representing a different point on the Pn-Mn curve are printed. Each of these points represents one of the several Pn-Mn combinations that this column is capable of carrying about the given axis, for the actual reinforcement that the column has been designed for. In the case of circular columns, the values are for
Section 3
3-15
any of the radial axes. The values printed for the TRACK 1.0 output are: P0 Pnmax P-bal M-bal e-bal M0 P-tens Des. Pn = Maximum purely axial load carrying capacity of the column (zero moment). = Maximum allowable axial load on the column (Section 10.3.5 of ACI 318). = Axial load capacity at balanced strain condition. = Uniaxial moment capacity at balanced strain condition. = M-bal / P-bal = Eccentricity at balanced strain condition. = Moment capacity at zero axial load. = Maximum permissible tensile load on the column. = Pu/PHI where PHI is the Strength Reduction Factor and Pu is the axial load for the critical load case.
Des. Mn = Mu*MMAG/PHI where PHI is the Strength Reduction Factor and Mu is the bending moment for the appropriate axis for the critical load case. For circular columns, M u = M 2 + M2 uy uz e/h = (Mn/Pn)/h where h is the length of the column.
Example for column design per the ACI 318-2002 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 2002 or CODE ACI FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL
3-16
Section 3
Example for column design per the ACI 318-1999 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 1999 FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL DESIGN COLUMN 23 25 END CONCRETE DESIGN
Table 3.3
The following output is generated without any TRACK specification.
==================================================================== C O L U M N FY - 60000 N O. 5 D E S I G N R E S U L T S
FC - 4000 PSI,
BAR CONFIGURATION REINF PCT. LOAD LOCATION PHI ---------------------------------------------------------8 - NUMBER 9 5.556 2 (PROVIDE EQUAL NUMBER OF BARS AT EACH FACE) STA 0.700
Section 3
3-17
COLUMN INTERACTION: MOMENT ABOUT Z -AXIS (KIP-FT) -------------------------------------------------------P0 Pn max P-bal. M-bal. e-bal.(inch) 897.12 717.70 189.56 158.50 10.03 M0 P-tens. Des.Pn Des.Mn e/h 137.46 -432.00 323.12 9.88 0.003 -------------------------------------------------------COLUMN INTERACTION: MOMENT ABOUT Y -AXIS (KIP-FT) -------------------------------------------------------P0 Pn max P-bal. M-bal. e-bal.(inch) 897.12 717.70 189.56 158.50 10.03 M0 P-tens. Des.Pn Des.Mn e/h 137.46 -432.00 323.12 128.08 0.033 --------------------------------------------------------
TRACK 2.0 generates the following output in addition to all of the above.
| P0 |* | * Pn,max|__* | * Pn | * NOMINAL | * AXIAL | * COMPRESSION| * Pb|-------*Mb | * ___________|____*_______ | * M0 Mn, | * BENDING P-tens|* MOMENT |
Pn 210.44 202.41 194.25 185.95 178.93 163.81 Pn 210.44 202.41 194.25 185.95 178.93 163.81
Mn 166.60 168.67 169.97 170.45 171.48 171.74 Mn 166.60 168.67 169.97 170.45 171.48 171.74
Pn 156.52 149.93 143.69 137.80 132.25 127.39 Pn 156.52 149.93 143.69 137.80 132.25 127.39
Mn (@ Z ) 170.63 169.69 168.61 167.44 166.20 165.41 Mn (@ Y ) 170.63 169.69 168.61 167.44 166.20 165.41
3-18
Section 3
Section 3
Z Y My
3-19
X Mx TRANS. My Mx LONG.
Figure 3.7
3-20
Section 3
Example for element design per the ACI 318-2002 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 2002 or CODE ACI FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 43 END CONCRETE DESIGN
Example for element design per the ACI 318-1999 code UNIT KIP INCH START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 1999 FYMAIN 58 ALL MAXMAIN 10 ALL CLB 2.5 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 43 END CONCRETE DESIGN
Section 3
3-21
The attributes associated with the surface element, and the sections of this manual where the information may be obtained, are listed below:
Attributes Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output printing Shear Wall Design Related Sections 5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
Description The program implements the provisions of ACI 318-02, except Chapter 21, for the design of shear walls. It performs in-plane shear, compression, as well as in-plane and out-of-plane bending design of reinforcing. The shear wall is modeled by a single or a combination of Surface elements. The use of the Surface element enables the designer to treat the entire wall as one entity. It greatly simplifies the modeling of the wall and adds clarity to the analysis and design output. The results are presented in the context of the entire wall rather than individual finite elements thereby allowing users to quickly locate required information. The definition of the shear wall starts with specification of the Surface element(s). The boundary of the wall should include all corner joints as well as any additional joints required for connections with other elements of the building, such as beams. All geometry and material properties must be specified for surface elements separately from specifications for other element types. The wall may be loaded indirectly through members/elements attached to it, or directly by application of nodal or uniformly distributed loads. All wall elements must be of constant thickness.
3-22
Section 3
The program reports shear wall design results for each load case/combination for a user specified number of sections given by the SURFACE DIVISION (default value is 10) command. The wall is designed at these horizontal sections. The output includes the required horizontal and vertical distributed reinforcing, the concentrated (in-plane bending) reinforcing, and the links required to resist out-of-plane shear. General format: START SHEARWALL DESIGN CODE ACI FYMAIN f1 FC f2 HMIN f3 HMAX f4 VMIN f5 VMAX f6 EMIN f7 EMAX f8 LMIN f9 LMAX f10 CLEAR f11 TWOLAYERED f12 KSLENDER f13 DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST shearwall-list END
Section 3
3-23
The following table explains parameters used in the shear wall design command block above. All reinforcing bar sizes are English designation (#). Table 3.5 - SHEAR WALL DESIGN PARAMETERS Parameter Name FYMAIN FC HMIN Default Value 60.0 ksi 4.0 ksi 3 Description Yield strength of steel, in current units. Compressive strength of concrete, in current units. Minimum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 3 18). Maximum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 3 18). Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 3 18). Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 3 18). Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 3 - 18). Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 3 - 18).
HMAX
18
VMIN
VMAX
18
EMIN
EMAX
18
3-24
Section 3
Table 3.5 - SHEAR WALL DESIGN PARAMETERS Parameter Name LMIN LMAX CLEAR TWOLAYERED Default Value 3 18 3.0 in 0 Description Minimum size of links (range 3 - 18) Maximum size of links (range 3 - 18) Clear concrete cover, in current units. Reinforcement placement mode: 0 - single layer, each direction 1 - two layers, each direction Slenderness factor for finding effective height
KSLENDER
1.5
Example . . . SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 19 16 65 68 SUR 2 11 15 186 165 SUR 3 10 6 138 159 SUR 4 . . . SURFACE PROPERTY 1 TO 4 THI 18 SUPPORTS 1 7 14 20 PINNED
Section 3
3-25
2 TO 5 GEN PIN 6 TO 10 GEN PIN 11 TO 15 GEN PIN 19 TO 16 GEN PIN . . . SURFACE CONSTANTS E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68e-005 ALPHA 5.5e-006 . . . START SHEARWALL DES CODE ACI FC 4 FYMAIN 60 TWO 1 VMIN 5 HMIN 5 EMIN 8 DESIGN SHEA LIST 1 TO 4 END
3-26
Section 3
Notes regarding the above example: 1. Command SET DIVISION 12 indicates that the surface boundary node-to-node segments will be subdivided into 12 fragments prior to finite element mesh generation. Four surfaces are defined by the SURFACE INCIDENCES command. The SUPPORTS command includes the support generation feature. For instance, the line 2 TO 5 GEN PIN assigns pinned supports to all nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As the node-to-node distances were previously subdivided by the SET DIVISION 12 command, there will be an additional 11 nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As a result, all 13 nodes will be assigned pinned supports. Please note that the additional 11 nodes are not individually accessible to the user. They are created by the program to enable the finite element mesh generation and to allow application of boundary constraints. Surface thickness and material constants are specified by the SURFACE PROPERTY and SURFACE CONSTANTS, respectively. The shear wall design commands are listed between lines START SHEARWALL DES and END. The CODE command selects the design code that will be the basis for the design. The DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST command is followed by a list of previously defined Surface elements intended as shear walls and/or shear wall components. Refer to the beginning of this section for references to all related commands. Technical Overview The program implements provisions of Chapter 14 of ACI-318-02 and relevant provisions from Chapters 10 and 11, as referenced therein, for all active load cases. The wall is designed as an unbraced reinforced wall. The following steps are performed for each of the horizontal sections of the wall set using the SURFACE DIVISION command whose default value is 10.
2. 3.
4.
5.
Section 3
3-27
Design for in-plane shear (denoted using Fxy in the shear wall force output) per Section 11.10 of ACI 318 a. Extreme compression fiber to centroid of tension (concentrated) reinforcement distance, d, is taken as 0.8 horizontal length of the wall (ACI - 11.10.4),
b. Limit on the nominal shear strength, Vn, is calculated (ACI - 11.10.3), c. Nominal shear strength of concrete is computed (11.10.6),
d. If the factored shear force does not exceed of the design strength of concrete, the minimum ratios of shear (distributed) reinforcing are reported, in accordance with 14.3.2 and 14.3.3. Otherwise, the reinforcing ratios are established in accordance with 11.10.9. e. If the factored shear force is greater than but does not exceed the design strength of concrete, the ratios reported are the minima calculated in accordance with 11.10.9.2 and 11.10.9.4. If the factored shear force exceeds the design strength of concrete, the distributed reinforcing is calculated based on 11.1.1 and 11.10.9.
f.
g. Number of distributed reinforcing layers and reinforcing allocation between layers reflect requirements of 14.3.4. h. Rebar spacing is given c/c and meets the requirements of 14.3.5, 11.10.9.3, and 11.10.9.5 of ACI 318, as applicable. Design for in-plane bending (denoted by Mz in the shear wall force output) per Section 14.4 of ACI 318 a. Walls are assumed to be cantilever beams fixed at their base and carrying loads to the foundation.
b. Strength reduction factor is established in accordance with Section 9.3.2. c. Minimum reinforcing is calculated in accordance with 10.5.1 or 10.5.3, whichever produces a smaller ratio.
3-28
Section 3
d. Extreme compression fiber to centroid of tension reinforcement distance, d, is taken as 0.8 horizontal length of the wall (11.10.4 of ACI 318). e. f. Flexural design of the wall is carried out in accordance with provisions of Chapter 10. The flexural (concentrated) reinforcing is located at both ends (edges) of the length of the wall. Rebar layout conforms to the spacing requirements of Section 7.6.
Design for compression and out-of-plane bending (Section 14.8) a. The design is based on the Alternative Design of Slender Walls procedure.
b. The procedure requires that the wall panel be designed as simply supported (at top and bottom), axially loaded with out-of-plane uniform lateral load, with maximum moments and deflections occurring at mid-height. c. Minimum distributed reinforcing ratio is controlled by the in-plane shear design calculations.
d. The reinforcing amount required by 14.8 is over and above any reinforcing required due to in-plane shear.
Section 3
3-29
Description Slab Interactive Design offers the following advantages: 1. Bending and shear design, fully conforming to the ACI 318-02 Code. 2. Design based on finite element analysis - no limitations of traditional design approaches, such as the Direct Design or Equivalent Frame methods. 3. It is suitable for systems with non-uniform slab thickness. 4. Reinforcing calculations may be based on extremum or average bending moment. 5. Layout of reinforcement may be exported in dxf format for use in contract documents. The fundamental design entity in the Slab Design module is a panel. The program performs design on a panel-by-panel basis. The panel is a portion of the slab that is delineated in one of the following two ways: a. At a launch of the module, all areas of the slab that are rectangular and are enclosed by beams on all four sides are automatically defined as panels, or, b. The user may manually define a panel of an arbitrary shape. Any number of panels can be defined anywhere within the slab area. The program performs design in the following modes: a. Full panel design, including reinforcing for orthogonal column and middle strips. This option is available for rectangular panels only. They may be automatically generated by the program or manually entered by the user.
b. Design for a specific section of a panel, chosen by the user. This mode is suitable for both rectangular and other shapes of panels. The selection of the design section defines the directions of reinforcing that the program will
3-30
Section 3
compute - one of the orthogonal directions is assumed to be parallel to the design section. c. Punching shear check. This design is performed for all rectangular columns satisfying the following conditions: The column supports the slab at a node located within a design panel or on its boundary, There are no beams attached to the common slabcolumn node.
Table 3.6 - INTERACTIVE SLAB DESIGN PARAMETERS Parameter Name Fc Fyld Min. bar size Max. bar size Default Value 4.0 ksi 60.0 ksi #3 #8 Description specified compressive strength of concrete specified yield strength of reinforcing steel smallest size of rebar required in reinforcing output largest size of rebar permitted in reinforcing output minimum c/c bar spacing allowed in reinforcing output maximum c/c bar spacing allowed in reinforcing output clear concrete cover for top bars clear concrete cover for bottom bars
Technical Overview Interactive slab design in STAAD.Pro is based on a prior finite element analysis (FEA) of the entire structure. The analysis allows to get accurate values of internal forces for the model, including component plate elements of the slab. As with any FEA project,
Section 3
3-31
the denser the grid of elements, the more precise the results that will be obtained. The program extracts and processes the internal forces from the FEA results in three ways (for each load case / combination): a. For all rectangular panels, where design is performed for the entire area of the panel (four column strips, two middle strips), notional boundaries are generated that reflect each of the six design strips. Within each boundary, the program establishes a series of transverse sections, spaced longitudinally at a user-defined distance D (Design Options of the Slab Design dialog box). Along each of these sections, internal forces are retrieved, again at intervals D. Depending on the users selection in Design Options (Design for Maximum Moments or Design for Average Moments), for each transverse section either the maximum force is established or an average force is calculated. In this way the program associates values of the bending moment with all transverse sections of a strip.
b. For all user selected design sections (within rectangular or non-rectangular panels), the program fetches values of internal forces at the user-defined interval D along the length of the section. These values are used by the program to report bending moments on the Moment Diagram page of the Slab Design Report. c. For punching shear design, the program fetches values of stresses at four corners of the critical section. These stresses are reported on the Punching Shear page of the Slab Design Report.
Most of the force values referred to above are obtained by extrapolation and averaging of FEA results, as the grid of points where forces are required rarely includes points for which FEA provides output directly.
3-32
Section 3
There are two categories of output for bending moments (envelopes are reported) and flexural reinforcing in the Slab Design Report window. a. Moment Diagram page allows to browse the results displayed for each of the transverse sections of the strip or user defined section. The force shown is as previously calculated (maximum or average) and the reported required reinforcing is based on that force.
b. Design Report page displays governing values of bending moments, as well as top and bottom reinforcing within a strip or along a user defined section. If the Design for Maximum Moments option was chosen, the program reports the maximum values of positive and negative moments. If the Design for Average Moments option was selected, the program calculates the average negative moment and the average positive moment for the strip or users section. Those values are reported as the Design Moment (rows labeled Top and Bottom) and are used by the program for computation of reinforcing areas. Flexural design notes: As the program obtains values of internal forces from finite element analysis, the design process is not constrained by the limitations of traditional methods such as Direct Design and Equivalent Frame, Section 13.5 of ACI 318-02. However, the provisions of 13.5.3 for unbalanced moment transfer have been implemented. Reinforcement calculations for slab panels are based on Chapter 10 of ACI 318-02. The reinforcement areas are computed for a notional band one unit of length wide. The minimum reinforcing ratio complies with the limits prescribed for shrinkage and temperature reinforcement in Section 7.12. The maximum reinforcing ratio corresponds to the net tensile strain at nominal strength equal to 0.004 (Clause 10.3.5).
Section 3
3-33
Distance from extreme compression fiber to centroid of tension reinforcement, d, is assumed to be equal to: for longitudinal bending: slab depth - concrete cover - dia. of min. size bar for transverse bending: slab depth - concrete cover - 1 dia. of min. size bar
Strength reduction factor is established in accordance with Section 9.3.2. The program allows the designer, as an option, to use the WoodArmer equations for reinforcement calculations, as follows: a. Mx, My, and Mxy are fetched or calculated, as described above. They are used to compute the values of design moments, Mxd and Myd.
b. For top reinforcement, the program computes: Mx1 My1 Mx2 My2 = = = = Mx My Mx My + + + + abs(Mxy) abs(Mxy) abs(Mxy 2 / My) abs(Mxy 2 / Mx)
If both Mx1 and My1 are positive, Mxd = Mx1 and Myd = My1. If both Mx1 and My1 are negative, Mxd = 0 and Myd = 0. If Mx1 is negative and My1 positive, Mxd = 0 and Myd = My2. If My1 is negative and Mx1 positive, Mxd = Mx2 and Myd = 0. c. For bottom reinforcement: = = = = Mx My Mx My abs(Mxy) abs(Mxy) abs(Mxy 2 / My) abs(Mxy 2 / Mx)
3-34
Section 3
If both Mx1 and My1 are positive, Mxd = 0 and Myd = 0. If both Mx1 and My1 are negative, Mxd = Mx1 and Myd = My1. If Mx1 is negative and My1 positive, Mxd = Mx2 and Myd = 0. If My1 is negative and Mx1 positive, Mxd = 0 and Myd = My2. Mxd and Myd are then used in lieu of Mx and My for calculations of the required reinforcing. Punching shear design notes: Design for two-way shear is carried out in accordance with Section 11.12. The unbalanced moment transfer by eccentricity of shear is based on Clause 11.12.6. Shear strength of concrete is based on Clause 11.12.2.1. Strength reduction factor used is 0.75, in accordance with Section 9.3.2.
The program computes shear stress values at four corners of the rectangular critical section located at the distance of d/2 from edges of a column. The calculations include the unbalanced moment transfer effect, if applicable, in accordance with 11.12.6.2. These values are compared with the design strength stress and a Pass or Fail identifier is reported.
Section 3
3-35
2.
3-36
Section 3
If the thickness of the web is the same as the width of one of the flanges but not the other, the member is designed as a T-section or a rectangular section, depending on which side the compression due to bending is at. If the web thickness does not match the width of either flange, design is done using the rules applicable for Tbeams one flange is in compression, the other in tension, and tensile capacity of concrete on the tensile side of the neutral axis is ignored.
The program is also able to design the beam as a doubly reinforced section if it is unable to design it as a single-reinforced section. 3. The parameters for designing these members are as shown in Table 3.1 of this manual. Detailed output on design at individual section locations along the member length may be obtained by setting the TRACK parameter to 3.0.
Section 3
3-37
An example for I-beam design is shown below. STAAD PLANE I BEAM CONCRETE DESIGN PER ACI-318 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 10 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT INCHES KIP MEMBER PROPERTY 1 TAPERED 18 10 18 15 2.5 CONSTANTS E 3300 ALL DENSITY CONCRETE ALL POISSON CONCRETE ALL SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED UNIT FEET KIP LOAD 1 DEAD LOAD MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -5.76 LOAD 2 LIVE LOAD MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -7.04 LOAD COMB 3 ACI 318-02 1 1.4 2 1.7 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 3
3-38
Section 3
START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI 2002 UNIT INCHES KIP MINMAIN 9 ALL FC 4 ALL FYMAIN 60 ALL TRACK 2.0 ALL DESIGN BEAM ALL END CONCRETE DESIGN FINISH
4-1
Timber Design
STAAD.Pro supports timber design per two codes 1985 AITC code and 1994 AITC code. The implementation of both the codes is explained below. 1994 AITC code implementation The salient aspects of design in accordance with the 4 th edition (1994) of the Timber Construction Manual published by the American Institute of Timber Construction are: 1. Design can be performed for two types of timber sections dimensional timber sections, also known as sawn lumber, and, glulaminated sections. The design facilities of the 1985 code implementation in STAAD was limited to glulaminated sections. 2. The program includes a database of dimensional timber sections with this code. Implementation of Dimensional Lumber Properties The database of sawn lumber sections, listed in Table 8.1 of the 1994 AITC Manual, is implemented in the program. Some of the key aspects of this implementation are: In the property tables in the AITC manual, one will find that, for any particular species of timber, the Modulus of Elasticity (E) and allowable stresses may vary with the cross-section size. For example, a 2x4 Douglas Fir-Larch, Select Structural member has
Timber Design
4-2
Section 4
an E of 1900 ksi and an allowable bending stress, F b , of 1450 psi. A 5x5 Douglas Fir-Larch, Select Structural, Beam or Stringer member has an E of 1600 ksi and an allowable bending stress, F b , of 1600 psi. And a 5x5 Douglas Fir-Larch, Select Structural, Post or Timbers member has an E of 1600 ksi and an allowable bending stress, F b , of 1750 psi. So, in the STAAD timber database for sawn lumber, for each species and grade of timber, the section size, or properties are associated with the Modulus of Elasticity and allowable stresses for the cross-section. When a section is assigned, its E and allowable stresses are automatically fetched along with its properties. The material properties of Southern Pine members were taken from Table 8.4 of the 1994 AITC manual. For all other species with section sizes 2-4 wide, the material properties have been taken from Table 8.3. For all non-Southern Pine species with section sizes greater than 5x5, the material properties are obtained from Table 8.6 of the 1994 AITC Manual. Please note that not all section sizes listed in Table 8.1 are available in every species. Some sizes are not produced for particular species. For example, the Aspen species only produces sizes from 2-4 wide. It does not produce sizes 5x5 and larger. This can be observed by comparing Table 8.3, where Aspen is listed as an available species, to Table 8.6, where Aspen is not listed as an available species. Also note that although 1 wide members are listed in Table 8.1, there are no values available in the species properties tables; Table 8.4, Table 8.5, and Table 8.6. AITC does not allow for the structural design of these small members.
Section 4
4-3
Naming convention in STAAD.Pro for Dimensional Lumber sections As can be seen from Tables 8.3 through 8.6 of the AITC 1994 manual, one or more of the following attributes have to be considered while choosing a section : Species Commercial Grade Size classification Nominal size of the section Grading rules agency
STAAD uses a naming convention that incorporates all of the above. Shown below is the name of a section that has characteristics as shown. It may be found on page 8-637 of the AITC 1994 manual. Species: Douglas Fir Larch Commercial Grade: Dense Select Structural Size Classification: Beams Nominal size: 5x5 Grading Rules Agency: WCLIB
Figure 4.1
Implementation of Glulam Properties For Glulam sections, each glulam designation has an associated value of Modulus of Elasticity and a set of allowable stresses. However, these values are not dependent on the size of the cross section. For example, a 3-1/8x 6 24F-V8 DF/DF beam and a 6-
Timber Design
4-4
Section 4
3/4 x 30 24F-V8 DF/DF beam both have an E of 1600 ksi and an allowable bending stress in the tension zone, F bx , of 2400 psi. Therefore, in STAADs glulam database, the section sizes are not linked to the glulam type. Users may specify any cross-section size they choose and pick the desired glulam type. The Modulus of Elasticity and allowable stresses associated with that glulam are assigned to the member. The material properties for the Glulam database are taken from Table 1 of AITC 117-93 Design Standard Specifications for Structural Glued Laminated Timber of Softwood Species. This publication has been reproduced in the AITC 1994 manual starting from page 8-843. Naming convention in STAAD.Pro for Glulam sections The STAAD name for glulam sections incorporates Combination Symbol Species-Outer Laminations/Core Laminations Shown here is a typical section listed in page 8-854 of the AITC manual. GLT-24F-V11_DF/DFS Implementation of Material Constants As explained in the previous paragraphs, for sawn lumber as well as glulam sections, E is built into the database and gets automatically assigned to the member along with the section dimensions. Density, Poissons ratio and Alpha (coefficient of thermal expansion) have to be assigned separately. If they are not assigned, the analysis engine will use default values for those. A typical set of input data for section properties and constants is as shown below.
Section 4
4-5
UNIT FEET KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFLN_SS_4X4 E 273600 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.025 ALPHA 5.5e-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AITC 3 4 7 8 TABLE ST DFLN_SS_4X4 CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFLN_SS_4X4 MEMB 3 4 7 8
UNIT FEET KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT-24F-V8_WET_DF/DF E 191923 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.025 ALPHA 5.5e-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AITC 8 PRIS YD 1.5 ZD 0.427083 CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT-24F-V8_WET_DF/DF MEMB 8
Timber Design
4-6
Section 4
Assigning the input Please see the Graphical User Interface manual for the procedure for assigning the properties, glulam types and material constants. Design parameters The timber design parameters for the AITC 4 th Edition are listed below.
Section 4
4-7
Timber Design
4-8
Section 4
Design commands Only code checking is available for timber members. Member selection is currently not available. It will be incorporated in a future build of the program. The command is specified as CHECK CODE memb-list The code name command for timber design is treated by STAAD in the following manner : Command in STAAD CODE AITC CODE AITC 1994 CODE AITC 1984 CODE TIMBER Interpretation by the program AITC 1994 edition AITC 1994 edition AITC 1984 edition AITC 1984 edition
Section 4
4-9
Example for Dimensional lumber: STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 6 0 0; 3 12 0 0; 4 18 0 0; 5 24 0 0; 6 6 3 0; 7 12 6 0; 8 18 3 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4; 4 4 5; 5 1 6; 6 6 7; 7 7 8; 8 8 5; 9 2 6; 10 3 7; 11 4 8; 12 6 3; 13 3 8; UNIT FEET POUND DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFLR_SS_2X4 E 2.736e+008 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5e-006 ISOTROPIC DFLR_SS_3X6 E 2.736e+008 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5e-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AITC 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 TABLE ST DFLR_SS_2X4 5 TO 8 12 13 TABLE ST DFLR_SS_3X6 CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFLR_SS_2X4 MEMB 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 MATERIAL DFLR_SS_3X6 MEMB 5 TO 8 12 13 MEMBER RELEASE 9 TO 13 START MP 0.99 9 TO 13 END MP 0.99 6 END MP 0.99
Timber Design
4-10
Section 4
7 START MP 0.99 SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 5 FIXED BUT FX MZ UNIT FEET POUND LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD SELFWEIGHT Y -1 MEMBER LOAD 1 TO 4 UNI GY -30 5 TO 8 UNI GY -40 LOAD 2 SNOW LOAD MEMBER LOAD 5 TO 8 UNI GY -50 LOAD 3 WIND LOAD MEMBER LOAD 5 6 UNI Y -30 7 8 UNI Y 25 LOAD COMB 11 D+L+SNOW 1 1.0 2 1.0 LOAD COMB 12 D+L+SNOW+WIND 1 1.0 2 1.0 3 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE AITC BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Section 4
4-11
Example for Glulaminated lumber: STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 12 0 0; 3 24 0 0; 4 36 0 0; 5 0 12 0; 6 6 10 0; 7 18 6 0; 8 30 2 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4; 4 5 6; 5 6 7; 6 7 8; 7 8 4; 8 1 5; 9 2 6; 10 3 7; 11 1 6; 12 2 7; 13 3 8; UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT-24F-V8_DF/DF E 1600 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676e-005 ALPHA 5.5e-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY 1 TO 7 PRIS YD 16.5 ZD 10.75 8 TO 13 PRIS YD 10.5 ZD 8.75 CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT-24F-V8_DF/DF MEMB 1 TO 13 SUPPORTS 1 4 PINNED UNIT POUND FEET LOAD 1 DEAD SELFWEIGHT Y -1 LOAD 2 LIVE
Timber Design
4-12
Section 4
MEMBER LOAD 1 TO 3 UNI GY -100 4 TO 7 UNI GY -100 LOAD COMB 3 1 1.0 2 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE AITC CMT 1 ALL RATIO 0.9 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
1985 AITC code implementation STAADs Timber design module per the 1985 AITC code (Timber Construction Manual, 3rd. Edition, 1985) allows design of Glulam timber sections. It also conforms to the National Design Specification for Wood Construction and Supplement (NDS) and building codes like Uniform Building Code (UBC), Basic/National Building Code and Standard Building Code. Some of the main features of the program are: 1. This feature is for Glulam Timber only. 2. Code check and design of members as per TCM - AITC. 3. Design values for Structural Glued Laminated Timber tables are in-built into the program. The program accepts Table no., Combination and Species specifications as inputs (e.g, 1:16FV3-SP/SP) and reads design values from in-built tables. 4. Incorporates all the following Allowable stress modifiers: i) Duration of Load Factor
Section 4
4-13
iii) Form Factor iv) Lateral stability of Beams and Columns v) Moisture Content Factor vi) Temperature and Curvature factors. The allowable stresses for bending, tension, compression, shear and Moduli of elasticities are modified accordingly . 5. Determines slenderness for beams and columns (Short, intermediate and long) and checks for min. eccentricity, lateral stability, buckling, bending and compression, bending and tension and horizontal shear against both axes. 6. The output results show sections provided or chosen, actual and allowable stresses, governing condition and ratios of interaction formulae and the relevant AITC clause nos. etc for each individual member.
FA
f bz , f by FBZ, FBY
JZ, JY f vz , f vy
Timber Design
4-14
Section 4
FVZ, FVY VZ, VY ZD, YD EZ, EY CFZ, CFY CLZ, CLY RATIO
Allowable horizontal shear stresses. Shear in local Z and local Y direction. Depth of section in local Z and Y axis. Minimum eccentricity along Z and Y axis. CFZ and CFY are values of the size factors in the Zaxis and Y-axis respectively. CLZ and CLY represent the factors of lateral stability for beams about Z-axis and Y-axis respectively. Permissible ratio of the stresses as provided by the user. The default value is 1.
ii) Lateral stability check with Net compressive stress: - f a /FA + f bz /(FBZ x CLZ) + f by /(FBY x CLY) =< RATIO Bending and Axial Compression: i) f a /FA + f bz /(FBZ-JZ x f a ) + f by /(FBY-JY x f a ) =< RATIO Applicability of the size factor: a) When CF < 1.00, if fa > FBZ x (1-CFZ), FBZ is not modified with CFZ. if fa > FBY x (1-CFY), FBY is not modified with CFY. if fa < FBZ x (1-CFZ) FBZ is taken as FBZ x CFZ + fa but shall not exceed FBZ x CLZ if fa < FBY x (1-CFY) FBY is taken as FBY x CFY + fa but shall not exceed FBY x CLY
Section 4
4-15
b) When CF >= 1.00, the effect of CF and CL are cumulative FBZ is taken as FBZ x CFZ x CLZ FBY is taken as FBY x CFY x CLY Min. Eccentricity: The program checks against min. eccentricity in following cases: a) The member is a FRAME member and not a truss member and under compression. b) The value of actual axial compressive stress does not exceed 30% of the allowable compressive stress. c) The actual moments about both axes are less than moments that would be caused due to min. eccentricity. In this approach, the moment due to min. eccentricity is taken as the compressive load times an eccentricity of 1 in. or 0.1 x depth whichever is larger. In case of min. eccentricity, f bz is taken as f a x (6+1.5 x JZ)/(EZ/ZD) f by is taken as f a x (6+1.5 x JY)/ (EY/YD) the following conditions are checked : f a /FA + f bz /(FBZ-JZ x f a ) =< RATIO and f a /FA + f by /(FBY-JY x f a ) =< RATIO Shear Stresses: Horizontal stresses are calculated and checked against allowable values: f vz = 3 x VY /(2 x Area x NSF) =< FVZ/f vy = 3 x VZ /(2 x Area x NSF) =< FVY
Timber Design
4-16
Section 4
Section 4
4-17
Glued Laminated Timber. The structural members are to be specified in the following manner:
GLULAM 1 : 16F-V3-DF/DF
GLULAM 2 : 3 - DF
Figure 4.2
For TABLE-2 members, the applicable stress values are selected based on the depth and the number of laminations. Please note here that lamination thickness (in inch) can be provided by the user and in case it is not provided the default is taken as 1.5 inch. Usually, it is either 1.5 inch or 1.375 inch.
Timber Design
4-18
Section 4
YD
ZD
YD
ZD
Figure 4.3
Section 4
4-19
Default Value
Length of the Member(L) -DO1.92*L 1.92*L 0.0
Description
Effective length of the column in z-axis. Same as above in y-axis. Unsupported effective length for beam in z. Unsupported effective length for beam in y. 0.0 - dry condition 1.0 - wet condition wet use factors are in-built Net section factor for tension members. (both shear and tension stresses are based on sectional area x nsf ) Duration of load factor Form factor Temp. factor Curvature factor. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses. Thickness of lamination in inch (1.50 or 1.375) 0.0 = design for end forces or at locations specified by section command. 1.0 = calculate moments at twelfths sections along the beam and use the max. for design. (Default)
NSF
1.0
Note: i. In case the column buckling is restrained in Y and/or Z direction provide LY and/or LZ as zero(s). Similarly, lateral beam buckling in Y and/or Z direction could be restrained by providing LUY and/or LUZ as zeros. ii. Size Factor, lateral stability and moisture content factors and few others are either calculated or read from tables within the program.
Timber Design
4-20
Section 4
RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 2 PR 8.000X15.000 FAIL TCM:CL. 5-18 1.205 2 2.24 C 0.00 45.38 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMB2 GLULAM GRADE:16F-V1-DF/WW LAM.=1.500 UNITS: POUND-INCH | | LZ=240.00 LY=240.00 LUZ=240.00 LUY=240.00 JZ =0.370 JY =1.000 CDT=1.000 | | CSF=1.00 WET=0.0 CCR=1.00 CTM=1.00 CFZ=0.98 CFY=1.00 CLZ=1.000 CLY=1.000 | |ACTUAL STRESSES: fa= 18.67,fbz=1815.06,fby= 0.00,fvz= 49.37,fvy= 0.00 | |ALLOW. STRESSES: FA= 366.67,FBZ=1579.49,FBY= 950.00,FVZ=140.00,FVY=130.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| 8.000X15.000 FAIL TCM:CL. 5-18 1.239 2 10.64 C 0.00 43.94 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMB3 GLULAM GRADE:16F-V1-DF/WW LAM.=1.500 UNITS: POUND-INCH | | LZ=180.00 LY=180.00 LUZ=180.00 LUY=180.00 JZ =0.074 JY =0.997 CDT=1.000 | | CSF=1.00 WET=0.0 CCR=1.00 CTM=1.00 CFZ=0.98 CFY=1.00 CLZ=1.000 CLY=1.000 | |ACTUAL STRESSES: fa= 88.68,fbz=1757.49,fby= 0.00,fvz= 36.61,fvy= 0.00 | |ALLOW. STRESSES: FA= 652.22,FBZ=1600.00,FBY= 950.00,FVZ=140.00,FVY=130.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD MEMBER SELECTION - (AITC) ************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE FEET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) 3 PR
RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 2 PR 8.000X18.000 PASS TCM:CL. 5-18 0.860 2 2.24 C 0.00 45.38 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMB2 GLULAM GRADE:16F-V1-DF/WW LAM.=1.500 UNITS: POUND-INCH | | LZ=240.00 LY=240.00 LUZ=240.00 LUY=240.00 JZ =0.173 JY =1.000 CDT=1.000 | | CSF=1.00 WET=0.0 CCR=1.00 CTM=1.00 CFZ=0.96 CFY=1.00 CLZ=1.000 CLY=1.000 | |ACTUAL STRESSES: fa= 15.56,fbz=1260.46,fby= 0.00,fvz= 41.14,fvy= 0.00 | |ALLOW. STRESSES: FA= 366.67,FBZ=1545.08,FBY= 950.00,FVZ=140.00,FVY=130.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| 8.000X18.000 PASS TCM:CL. 5-18 0.876 2 10.64 C 0.00 43.94 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMB3 GLULAM GRADE:16F-V1-DF/WW LAM.=1.500 UNITS: POUND-INCH | | LZ=180.00 LY=180.00 LUZ=180.00 LUY=180.00 JZ =0.000 JY =0.997 CDT=1.000 | | CSF=1.00 WET=0.0 CCR=1.00 CTM=1.00 CFZ=0.96 CFY=1.00 CLZ=1.000 CLY=1.000 | |ACTUAL STRESSES: fa= 73.90,fbz=1220.48,fby= 0.00,fvz= 30.51,fvy= 0.00 | |ALLOW. STRESSES: FA= 652.22,FBZ=1600.00,FBY= 950.00,FVZ=140.00,FVY=130.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| 3 PR
Figure 4.4
Section 4
4-21
Governing Criteria
Axial Compression and Bending with MINIMUM ECCENTRICITY. Axial Compression and Bending Axial Tension and Bending Horizontal Shear Lateral stability for net compressive stress in case of Tension and Bending.
e) RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. This ratio is usually the cumulative ratio of stresses in the interaction formula. In case of shear governing the design, it means the ratio of the actual shear stress to allowable shear stress. If this value exceeds the allowable ratio (default 1.0) the member is FAILed. f) LOADING provides the load case number that governed.
Timber Design
4-22
Section 4
g) FX, MY and MZ provide the design axial force, moment in local Y axes and moment in local Z axes respectively. FX value is followed by a letter C or T to denote COMPRESSION or TENSION. h) LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern in case BEAM command or SECTION command is specified. OUTPUT parameters that appear within the box are explained as follows: a) MEMB refers to the same member number for which the design is performed. b) GLULAM GRADE refers to the grade of the timber. c) LAM refers to lamination thickness provided in the input or assumed by the program. See INPUT PARAMETERS section. d) LZ, LY, LUZ and LUY are the effective lengths as provided or calculated. See INPUT PARAMETERS section. e) JZ and JY are the modifiers for the P-DELTA effect about Zaxis and Y-axis respectively. These are calculated by the program. f) CDT, CSF, WET, CCR, CTM are the allowable stress modifiers explained in the INPUT PARAMETERS section.
g) CFZ and CFY are values of the size factors in the Z-axis and Y-axis respectively. CLZ and CLY represent the factors of lateral stability for beams about Z-axis and Y-axis respectively. These values are printed to help the user see the intermediate design values and re-check the design calculations. h) f a , f bz , f by , f vz and f vy are the actual axial stress, bending stresses about Z and Y axes and horizontal shear stresses about Z and Y axes respectively. If the bending moments about both axes are less then the eccentric moments based on min. eccentricity then bending stresses are calculated based on the min. eccentricity . Refer DESIGN OPERATIONS section for details.
Section 4
4-23
i)
FA, FBZ, FBY, FVZ and FVY are the final allowable axial, bending (Z and Y axes) and horizontal shear (Z and Y axes) stresses. Refer DESIGN OPERATIONS section for details.
Timber Design
4-24
Section 4
5-1
STAAD
5-2
Section 5
Input Instructions
Section 5
5-3
The decimal point may be omitted if the decimal portion of the number is zero. c) Alphanumeric: These are characters, which are used to construct the names for data, titles or commands. Alphabetic characters may be input in upper or lower case letters. No quotation marks are needed to enclose them. Example MEMBER PROPERTIES 1 TO 8 TABLE ST W8X35
5-4
Section 5
d) Repetitive Data: Repetitive numerical data may be provided in some (but not all) input tables such as joint coordinates by using the following format: n*f where n = number of times data has to be repeated f = numeric data, integer and floating point Example JOINT COORDINATES 1 3*0. This joint coordinate specification is same as:
1 0. 0. 0.
Section 5
5-5
5-6
Section 5
Example
XY YZ XZ
In the above example, the user must make a choice of XY or YZ or XZ. Example * FX FY FZ Here the user can choose one or all of the listing (FX, FY and FZ) in any order. Parentheses, ( ), enclosing a portion of a command indicate that the enclosed portion is optional. The presence or absence of this portion affects the meaning of the command, as is explained in the description of the particular command. Example PRINT (MEMBER) FORCES PERFORM ANALYSIS (PRINT LOAD DATA) In the first line, the word MEMBER may be omitted with no change of the meaning of the command. In the second line, PRINT LOAD DATA command may also be omitted, in which case the load data will not be printed. e) Multiple Data Separator: Multiple data can be provided on a single line, if they are separated by a semicolon (;) character.
Section 5
5-7
One restriction is that a semicolon can not separate consecutive commands. They must appear on separate lines.
Example MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4 etc. Possible Error: PRINT FORCES; PRINT STRESSES In the above case, only the PRINT FORCES command is processed and the PRINT STRESSES command is ignored. f) Listing Data: In some STAAD command descriptions, the word "list" is used to identify a list of joints, members/elements or loading cases. The format of a list can be defined as follows:
list =
* i 1 i 2 i 3 ....... i 1 TO i 2 (BY i 3 ) X or Y or Z
TO means all integers from the first (i 1 ) to the second (i 2 ) inclusive. BY means that the numbers are incremented by an amount equal to the third data item (i 3 ). If BY i 3 is omitted, the increment will be set to one. Sometimes the list may be too long to fit on one line, in which case the list may be continued to the next line by providing a hyphen preceded by a blank. Also, only a list may be continued and not any other type of data. Instead of a numerical list, a single group-name may be entered if that group was previously defined. Instead of a numerical list, the specification X ( or Y or Z) may be used. This specification will include all MEMBERs
5-8
Section 5
parallel to the global direction specified. Note that this is not applicable to JOINTs or ELEMENTs. ALL, BEAM, PLATE, SOLID. Do not use these unless the documentation for a command specifically mentions them as available for that command. ALL means all members and elements, BEAM means all members, etc. g) Continuing a command to the next line: Only lists may be continued to the next line by ending the line with a blank and hyphen (see above) with few exceptions: Multilinear spring supports, Supports, Master/Slave. Others have special types of continuations. Please follow the command descriptions. Example 2 4 7 TO 13 BY 2 19 TO 22 28 31 TO 33 FX 10.0 This list of items is the same as: 2 4 7 9 11 13 19 20 21 22 28 31 32 33 FX 10.0 Possible Error: 3 5 TO 9 11 15 FX 10.0 In this case, the continuation mark for list items is used when list items are not continued. This will result in an error message or possibly unpredictable results.
Section 5
5-9
General format:
f 1, f 2
XRANGE, YRANGE, ZRANGE = direction of range (parallel to global X, Y, Z directions respectively) f1, f2 = values (in current unit system) that defines the specified range. Notes 1) Only one range direction (XRANGE, YRANGE etc.) is allowed per list. (Exceptions: Area/Floor load and Master/Slave). 2) No other items may be in the list. 3) The values defining the range (f1, f2) must be in the current unit system. Example MEMBER TRUSS XRANGE 20. 70. CONSTANTS E STEEL YRANGE 10. 55. In the above example, a XRANGE is specified with values of 20. and 70. This range will include all members lying entirely within a range parallel to the global X-axis and limited by X=20 and X=70.
5-10
Section 5
STAAD Commands
STAAD
(any title a 1 )
Description Any STAAD input has to start with the word STAAD. Following type specifications are available: PLANE = SPACE = TRUSS = FLOOR = Plane frame structure Space frame structure Plane or space truss structure Floor structure
a 1 = Any title for the problem. This title will appear on the top of every output page. To include additional information in the page header, use a comment line containing the pertinent information as the second line of input.
Section 5
5-11
Notes 1) The user should be careful about choosing the type of the structure. The choice is dependent on the various degrees of freedom that need to be considered in the analysis. The following figure illustrates the degrees of freedoms considered in the various type specifications. Detailed discussions are available in Section 1.3.
STRUCTURE TYPES
PLANE
SPACE
TRUSS 2D 3D
FLOOR
Figure 5.1
2) The optional title provided by the u s er is p rin ted o n top of every page of the output. The user can us e th is facility to customize his output. Limits
1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) Joint numbers: Number of joints: Member/Element numbers: Number of Members & Elements: Load Case numbers: Number of primary & combination cases Number of modes & frequencies Number of load cases that may be combined by a Repeat Load or Load Combination command * 550 1 to 999999 130000 * 1 to 999999 130000 * 1 to 99999 4000 2700
Some STAAD copies are available with much smaller limits, please check what limits you have purchased.
5-12
Section 5
force-unit INCHES FEET or FT or FO CM METER MMS DME KM KIP POUND KG MTON NEWTON KNS MNS DNS
length-unit =
force-unit =
Note: DME denotes Decimeters. MNS denotes mega Newtons (1,000,000 Newtons) and DNS denotes DecaNewtons (10 Newtons). MTON denotes Metric Ton (1000 kilograms). All other units are self explanatory. Description The UNIT command can be specified any number of times during an analysis. All data is assumed to be in the most recent unit
Section 5
5-13
specification preceding that data. Also, the input unit for angles is always degrees. However, the output unit for joint rotations (in joint displacement) is radians. For all output, the units are clearly specified by the program. Example UNIT UNIT UNIT UNIT Notes This command may be used as frequently as needed to specify data or generate output in the desired length and/or force units. Mixing of different unit systems (Imperial, Metric, SI etc.) is allowed. This command may be anywhere a primary level command (e.g, JOINT COORD, MEMBER INCIDENCE, etc.) can be. In addition, it may also be wherever a first level load command may be. Exceptions: The second level load commands (MEMBER LOAD, JOINT LOAD and FLOOR LOAD), allow the UNIT command to be entered on a separate line, not within a continuation or between semi-colons. KIP FT INCH METER KNS CM MTON
5-14
Section 5
INPUT OUTPUT
WIDTH
i1
For OUTPUT WIDTH, i 1 = 72 or 118 depending on narrow or wide output. Description The user may specify the required input/output width, as required, using this command. For INPUT width, 79 is always used. The program can create output using two different output widths - 72 (default) and 118. The 72-character width may be used for display on most CRTs and for printing on portrait wide paper. The 118character width may be used for printing on landscape wide paper. Notes This is a customization facility that may be used to improve the presentation quality of the run documents.
Section 5
5-15
SET
i1 i2 i3 i4 i5 i7
i6 UP
where, i 1 = Maximum number of primary load cases (NL) i 2 = Maximum allowable displacement tolerance for any joint in the structure. i 3 = Damping ratio to be used for all springs in computing the modal composite damping in dynamics. i 4 = Warping restraint ratio to be used for I section members in computing the torsional rigidity. If 0.0 then no warping restraint, normal default option; If 1.0 then full warping restraint. Cw, the warping constant, will be computed and used in the torsional rigidity calculation. Values between 0.0 and 1.0 will result in a partial warping restraint. i 5 = Maximum number of tension/compression iterations. i 6 = 1, Bypass forming data and files needed for post-processing. i 7 = 1, Bypass printing Zero Stiffness messages.
5-16
Section 5
Description The SET NL command is used in a multiple analysis run if the user wants to add more primary load cases after one analysis has been performed. Specifically, for those examples, which use the CHANGE or RESTORE command, if the user wants to add more primary load cases, the NL value should be set to the maximum number with the SET NL command. The program will then be able to set aside additional memory space for information to be added later. This command should be provided before any joint, member or load specifications. The value for i 1 should not be greater than the maximum number of primary load cases. For PDELTA ANALYSIS with CONVERGE option the SET DISPLACEMENT command is used to specify the convergence tolerance. If the RMS displacement of two consecutive iterations changes less than the value entered, then that load case is converged. This command should be placed before the JOINT COORDINATE specification. The SET ECHO ON command will activate and the SET ECHO OFF command will deactivate the echoing of input file commands in the output file. In the absence of the SET ECHO command, input file commands will be echoed back to the output file. By default, the Y-axis is the vertical axis. However, the SET Z UP command may be used to model situations where Z-axis represents the vertical axis (direction of gravity load) of the structure. This situation may arise if the input geometry is created through some CAD software. This command will affect the default BETA angle specification. However, BETA can be set to a certain value for all members parallel to a particular global axis by using the MEMBER X (or Y or Z) type of listing. For additional information, see the CONSTANTs specification (Section 5.26). Notes for SET Z UP The SET Z UP Command directly influences the values of the following input: 1) JOINT COORDINATE
Section 5
5-17
2) Input for the PERFORM ROTATION Command 3) BETA ANGLE The following features of STAAD cannot be used with the SET Z UP command: 1) 2) 3) 4) Wind Load Generation Floor Load Generation Automatic Generation of Spring Supports for Mat Foundations UBC Loading
The SET SDAMP command will allow the damping of springs to be considered in computing the composite modal damping for each mode in a dynamic solution. This command is not used unless CDAMP ratios are also entered for the members and elements in the CONSTANTS command. Composite damping is generally only used if there are many modes in the dynamic solution and there are a wide range of damping ratios in the springs / members / elements. The SET WARP command will allow the I section member end warping restraint to be considered in calculating the torsional stiffness rigidity. Full or partial or no warping restraint are allowed. The SET ITERLIM command is for raising the max. iteration limit above the default of 10 in tension/compression iterations. Since this iterative procedure will not necessarily converge, this option of more iterations may not help and should be used with caution. The minimum iteration limit that may be entered is 3. After any tension/compression analysis, the output file (.ANL) should be scanned for warnings of non-convergence. Do not use results from non-converged cases. The SET PRINT 1 command is for eliminating the Zero Stiffness messages. The SET SHEAR command is for omitting the additional pure shear distortion stiffness terms in forming beam member
5-18
Section 5
stiffnesses. With this command you can exactly match simple textbook beam theory results. Other rarely used SET commands:
SET DATA CHECK IGNORED SET RUN IGNORED SET COMPRESS TURN OFF FILE COMPRESSION SET SOLUTION INCORE use determinant search for frequencies for small problems SET SOLVER should ignore SET CORE should ignore (Memory) SET EXM should ignore (EXTENDED MEMORY) SET NJ should ignore SET NM should ignore SET CONNECTIVITY should ignore SET MASS =1 use generated moments as masses. SET MODAL should ignore SET THISTORY =2 Use exact force integration in time history. SET INTERPOLATION Lin or Log for spectra SET DISPLACEMENT METHOD should ignore SET ???? ??? file extension for L43 SET BUBBLE =1 do not use bubble fns in solids SET NOSECT no section results will be calculated SET TMH should ignore SET SSVECT to instruct the program to use a different initial set of trial vectors for eigensolution. May be used if eigen extraction fails. SET INCLINED REACTION to obtain reactions at inclined supports in the inclined axis system
Section 5
5-19
a1
The semicolon (;) is the default character which functions as the separator for multiple line data on one line. However, this separator character can be changed by the SEPARATOR command to any character a 1 , other than the comma or asterisk. Notes Comma (,) or asterisk (*) may not be used as a separator character.
5-20
Section 5
Section 5
5-21
PAGE
LENGTH EJECT
a1
The page length in STAAD output is based on a default value of 60 lines . However, the user may change the page length to any number i (number of lines per page) desired. Description Standard page eject character (CNTRL L for PCs and 1 for Mini/Mfrm) is embedded in the STAAD program. The PAGE EJECT command with the input of the character a 1 will alter the default page eject character in the program. A blank character will suppress page ejection.
5-22
Section 5
Section 5
5-23
5-24
Section 5
Description The command JOINT COORDINATES specifies a Cartesian Coordinate System (see Figure 1.2). Joints are defined using the global X, Y and Z coordinates. The command JOINT COORDINATES CYLINDRICAL specifies a Cylindrical Coordinate System (see Figure 1.3). Joints are defined using the r, and z coordinates. JOINT COORDINATES CYLINDRICAL REVERSE specifies a Reverse Cylindrical Coordinate system (see Figure 1.4). Joints are defined using the r, y and coordinates.
Section 5
5-25
JTORIG causes the program to use a different origin than (0, 0, 0) for all of the joints entered with this JOINT COORDINATES command. It is useful in instances such as when the center of cylinder is not at (0, 0, 0) but at a different point in space. The JTORIG command should be entered on a separate command line. Basically after the joint coordinates are entered or generated, then the xOrigin, yOrigin, and zOrigin values are added to the coordinates. For example a cylinder could be generated about the Y axis then moved by this command to its proper place. To create multiple offset structural parts, enter additional JOINT COORDINATES commands, each one followed by its JTORIG command. An example showing the use of this command is provided later in this section. The multiple JOINT COORDINATES command concept allows UNIT changes and PERFORM ROTATION commands in between, such that these commands would apply to a selected portion of the joints. However, the PERFORM ROTATION command applies to all prior defined joints, not just those in the previous JOINT COORDINATE command. NOREDUCE BAND causes the program to execute without performing a bandwidth reduction. Example JOINT COORDINATES NOREDUCE BAND The REPEAT command causes the previous line of input to be repeated n number of times with specified coordinate increments. The REPEAT ALL command functions similar to the REPEAT command except that it repeats all previously specified input back to the most recent REPEAT ALL command, or all joint data if no previous REPEAT ALL command has been given. Note: Use REPEAT ALL 0 to start a section of data to be repeated if necessary. (When using the REPEAT and REPEAT ALL commands, joint numbering must be consecutive and should begin with 1.)
5-26
Section 5
* i1 =
The joint number for which the coordinates are provided. Any integer number within the limit (see section 5.2 for limit) is permitted. x 1 , y 1 and z 1 = X, Y & Z (R, & Z for cylindrical or R, Y & for cylindrical reverse) coordinates of the joint. For PLANE analyses z 1 is an optional data item when defining input for individual joints. z 1 is always required for joint generation. The following are used only if joints are to be generated.
* i2 =
The second joint number to which the joint coordinates are generated. x 2 , y 2 , and z 2 = X, Y & Z (R, & Z for cylindrical or R, Y & for cylindrical reverse) coordinates of the joint i 2 . Joint number increment by which the generated i3 = joints will be incremented. Defaults to 1 if left out. n= Number of times repeat is to be carried out. n cannot exceed 150 in any one single REPEAT command. xi k , yi k & zi k = X, Y & Z (R, & Z [R, Y & ]) coordinate increments for k th repeat. The X, Y and Z (R, & Z [R, Y & ]) coordinates will be equally spaced between i 1 and i 2 .
* The REPEAT command uses the highest joint number entered so far plus one for the intermediate generated joint numbers. Example 1 JOINT COORDINATES 1 10.5 2.0 8.5 2 0.0 0.0 0.0 3 5.25 0.0 8.5 6 50.25 0.0 8.5 In this example, X Y Z coordinates of joints 1 to 6 are provided. The joints between 3 & 6 will be generated with joints equally
Section 5
5-27
spaced from 3 to 6. Hence, joint 4 will have coordinates of 20.25 0.0 8.5 and joint 5 will have coordinates of 35.25 0.0 8.5. Example 2 JOINT COORDINATES 1 0.0 0.0 0.0 4 45 0.0 0.0 REPEAT 4 0.0 0.0 15.0 REPEAT ALL 10 0.0 10.0 0.0 Here, the 220 joint coordinates of a ten story 3 X 4-bay structure are generated. The REPEAT command repeats the first input line 4 times, incrementing each Z coordinate by 15. Thus, the first 2 lines are sufficient to create a "floor" of twenty joints.
1 0. 0. 0. ; 2 15. 0. 0. ; 3 30. 0. 0. ; 4 45. 0. 0. 5 0. 0. 15. ; 6 15. 0. 15. ; 7 30. 0. 15. ; 8 45. 0. 15. ..... ..... ..... ..... 17 0. 0. 60. ; 18 15. 0. 60. ; 19 30. 0. 60. ; 20 45. 0. 60. The REPEAT ALL command repeats all previous data (i.e. the 20 joint "floor") ten times, incrementing the Y coordinate by 10 each time. This creates the 200 remaining joints of the structure: Example 3 21 0.0 10.0 0.0 ; 22 15.0 10.0 0.0 ; ... ;
40 45.0 10.0 60.0 ; 41 0.0 20.0 0.0 ; ... ; 200 45.0 90.0 60.0 ; 201 0.0 100.0 0.0 ; ... ; 219 30.0 100.0 60.0 ; 220 45.0 100.0 60.0
5-28
Section 5
REPEAT 10 5. 10. 5. The above REPEAT command will repeat the last input line 10 times using the same set of increments (i.e. x = 5., y = 10., z = 5.)
REPEAT 3 2. 10. 5. 3. 15. 3. 5. 20. 3. The above REPEAT command will repeat the last input line three times. Each repeat operation will use a different increment set.
REPEAT 10 0. 12. 0. 15*0 0. 10. 0. 9*0 The above REPEAT command will repeat the last input line 10 times; six times using x, y and z increments of 0., 12. and 0., and four times using increments of 0., 10. and 0. Each x, y and z value of 0 represents no change from the previous increment. To create the 2nd through 6th repeats, five sets of 0., 0. and 0. (15*0) are supplied. The seventh repeat is done with increments of 0., 10. and 0. The 8th through 10th repeats are done with the same increments as 7, and is represented as 9*0. Notes The PRINT JOINT COORDINATE command may be used to verify the joint coordinates provided or generated by REPEAT and REPEAT ALL commands. Also, use the Post Processing facility to verify geometry graphically.
Section 5
5-29
5-30
Section 5
Note: Use REPEAT ALL 0, to start a set of members that will be repeated if you dont want to repeat back to the last REPEAT ALL. The following data are used for member generation only: i 4 = Second member number to which members will be generated. i 5 = Member number increment for generation. i 6 = Joint number increment which will be added to the incident joints. (i 5 and i 6 will default to 1 if left out.) n = Number of times repeat is to be carried out. m i = Member number increment j i = Joint number increment Example MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 2 5 7 5 7 11 13 13 2 3 In this example, member 1 goes from joint 1 to 2. Member 2 is connected between joints 5 and 7. Member numbers from 3 to 5 will be generated with a member number increment of 1 and a joint number increment 1 (by default). That is, member 3 goes from 6 to 8, member 4 from 7 to 9, member 5 from 8 to 10. Similarly, in the next line, member 9 will be from 14 to 16, 11 from 17 to 19 and 13 from 20 to 22. Additional example MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 21 20 21 21 22 23 REPEAT 4 3 4 36 21 25 39 REPEAT 3 4 4 REPEAT ALL 9 51 20
Section 5
5-31
This example creates the 510 members of a ten story 3 X 4-bay structure (this is a continuation of the example started in Section 5.12). The first input line creates the twenty columns of the first floor: 1 1 21 ; 2 2 22 ; 3 3 23 ; ... ; 19 19 39 ; 20 20 40 The two commands (21 21 22 23 and REPEAT 4 3 4) create 15 members which are the second floor "floor" beams running, for example, in the east-west direction:
21 21 22; 22 22 23; 23 23 24 24 25 26; 25 26 27; 26 27 28 ... ... ... 33 37 38; 34 38 39; 35 39 40 The next two commands (36 21 25 39 and REPEAT 3 4 4) function similar to the previous two commands, but here create the 16 second floor "floor" beams running in the north-south direction:
36 21 25; 37 22 26; 38 23 27; 39 24 28 40 25 29; 41 26 30; 42 27 31; 43 28 32 ... ... ... ... 48 33 37; 49 34 38; 50 35 39; 51 36 40 The preceding commands have created a single floor unit of both beams and columns, a total of 51 members. The REPEAT ALL now repeats this unit nine times, generating 459 new members and finishing the ten story structure. The member number is incremented by 51 (the number of members in a repeating unit) and the joint number is incremented by 20, (the number of joints on one floor).
5-32
Section 5
Notes The PRINT MEMBER INFO command may be used to verify the member incidences provided or generated by REPEAT and REPEAT ALL commands. Also, use the Post Processing facility to verify geometry graphically.
Section 5
5-33
5-34
Section 5
Section 5
5-35
i1
i 2 ...i 5
= Element number (any number up to six digits). If MEMBER INCIDENCE is provided, this number must not coincide with any MEMBER number. = Clockwise or counterclockwise joint numbers which represent the element connectivity. i 5 is not needed for triangular (3 noded) elements.
The following data is needed if elements are to be generated: i 6 = Last element number to which elements are generated. i 7 = Element number increment by which elements are generated. Defaults to 1 if omitted. i 8 = Joint number increment which will be added to incident joints. Defaults to 1 if omitted. The following data is needed if REPEAT or REPEAT ALL commands are used to generate elements: n = Number of times repeat is to be carried out. e i = Element number increment. j i = Joint number increment. Example ELEMENT INCIDENCE 1 1 2 7 6 2 3 4 8 3 8 9 11 10 TO 8 9 1 3 7 TO 14 Notes The PRINT ELEMENT INFO command may be used to verify the element incidences provided or generated by REPEAT and REPEAT ALL commands. Also, use the Post Processing facility to verify geometry graphically.
5-36
Section 5
Section 5
5-37
Specify the four nodes of any of the faces of the solid element in a counter-clockwise direction as viewed from the outside of the element and then go to the opposite face and specify the four nodes of that face in the same direction used in specifying the nodes of the first face. The opposite face must be behind the first face, as defined by the right hand rule, i.e. the opposite (back) face points to the first (front) face, which points to the viewer. Use REPEAT ALL 0 to start a set of solids that will be repeated if you dont want to repeat back to the last REPEAT ALL. Example ELEMENT INCIDENCE SOLID 1 1 5 6 2 21 25 26 22 TO 3 4 21 25 26 22 41 45 46 42 TO 6
5-38
Section 5
Section 5
5-39
General Format: SET DIVISION m SURFACE INCIDENCE n1, ..., ni SURFACE s DIVISION sd1, ..., sdj RECOPENING x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 DIVISION od1, ..., odk where : m number of segments to be generated between each pair of adjacent nodes
n1, ..., ni
- node numbers defining the perimeter of the surface, - surface ordinal number,
sd1, ..., sdj - number of divisions for each of the nodeto-node distance on the surface perimeter, x1 y1 z1 (...)- coordinates of the corners of the opening, od1, ..., odk - divisions along edges of the opening. The SET DIVISION command specifies a default number of generated meshing divisions for all node to node segments. In its absence, that number is taken as 10. If the sd1, ..., sdj or the od1, ..., odk list does not include all nodeto-node segments, or if any of the numbers listed equals zero, then the corresponding division number is set to the default value (=10, or as previously input by the SET DIVISION command). Notes 1. The surface definition must comprise a minimum of four nodal points forming corners of a rectangle. However, any number of additional nodes may be incorporated into the
5-40
Section 5
2.
3. 4. 5.
surface boundaries provided the nodes are collinear on edges they belong to. In addition, the user specifies the number of edge divisions that will be the basis for mesh generation. A single command per wall is used for this purpose. The program will subdivide all edges into the requested number of fragments and each of these fragments will become an edge of a plate element. However, if the original surface edges have additional nodal points between the corners, all node-to-node lengths of the surface edge will be divided into the same number of fragments. Surface thickness and material constants are specified in a manner similar to that for plate elements, except that, currently, only a constant surface thickness is supported. A support generation function allows quick assignment of support specifications to multiple nodal points. Surface elements may be loaded by uniformly distributed loads in any global direction or by loads normal to the plane. It is possible to obtain in-plane bending moments as well as stresses along any arbitrary line cutting the surface.
Example
SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 34 37 54 51 SUR 2 19 16 65 68 SUR 3 DIV 10 16 10 16 RECO 5.8 1.5 6.9 6.4 1.5 6.9 6.4 0.5 6.9 5.8 0.5 6.9 DIV 5 10 5 10
This example illustrates definition of three Surface elements. SET DIVISION 12 command establishes a default number of boundary divisions for automatic mesh generation. This command will apply to outer edges of the elements as well as to the edges of openings, if present.
Section 5
5-41
SURFACE INCIDENCES command start the specifications of the elements. SUR 1 and SUR 2 commands define Surface elements No. 1 and 2 with default boundary divisions and no openings. SUR 3 command defines Surface No. 3 with non-default edge divisions and one opening. The DIV command following SUR 3 defines Surface element edge divisions. Non-default opening edge divisions are defined by the DIV command following the RECO command.
5-42
Section 5
Section 5
5-43
CYL RCYL
(x o ,y o ,z o ))
GENERATE ELEMENT
( QUADRILATERAL) TRIANGULAR
where A i , A j = Alphabets A - Z or alphabets a - z. Maximum is 52. x i ,y i ,z i = Coordinates for boundary point A i . If CYL or RCYL is defined, above coordinates will be in cylindrical or reverse cylindrical coordinates system. Optional coordinates x o , y o and z o will be the cartesian coordinates for the origin of the cylindrical coordinates. Defaults to 0, 0, 0 if not provided. The 3 fields (x,y,z) may be replaced by a joint number whose coordinates have been defined in the JOINT COORDINATE command by entering instead. A i JOINT jn A i ,A j ,A k ... =A rectangular super-element defined by four or eight boundary points. There should be no spaces between the letters. = Number of elements along the side A i A j of the supern1 element. (Must not exceed 28). = Number of elements along the side A j A k of the supern2 element. (Must not exceed 28). If n 2 is omitted, that is, only n 1 is provided, then n 1 will indicate the total number of elements within the super-element. In this case, n 1 must be the square of an integer.
5-44
Section 5
Limits There is a limit of 21 Mesh commands. Up to 33000 joints may be generated and up to 67000 elements. Total number of joints in the model after this command is completed may not exceed 100,000. Notes All coordinates are in current unit system. While using this facility the user has to keep the following points in mind: 1. All super-elements must be 4-noded or 8-noded. Generated elements for 4-noded super-elements will retain the straight-line edges of the super-elements, while joints of elements generated from 8-noded super-elements will lie on a curved trajectory.
F
C D
G E
2.
2 super-elements, which have a common boundary, must have the s ame number of elements along their common boundary. Sequence of super-elements - MESH commands define the superelements. The sequence of this MESH command should be such that once one is defined, the next super-elements should be the ones connected to this. Therefore, for convenience, the first superelement should be the one, which is connected by the largest number of super-elements. In the example shown here for the tank, th e bottom super-element is specified first.
3.
Section 5
5-45
4.
This command must be used after the MEMBER INCIDENCE & ELEMENT INCIDENCE section and before the MEMBER PROPERTIES & ELEMENT PROPERTIES section. The elements that are created internally are numbered sequentially with an increment of one starting from the last member/element number plus one. Similarly the additional joints created internally are numbered sequentially with an increment of one starting from the last joint number plus one. It is advisable that users keep the joint numbers and member/element numbers in a sequence with an increment of one starting from one. If there are members embracing a super-element which is being meshed, the users will have to take care of the required additions/modifications in the MEMBER INCIDENCE section themselves since a few more new joints might appear on the existing common boundary as a result of meshing the superelement. See the following figure:
A B
5.
Figure 5.3 Note : If a member exists between points A and B, the user must breakup this member into 4 parts. Members will not be meshed automatically.
6.
The sub-elements will have the same direction (Clockwise or Anticlockwise) as the super-elements. For a super-element bounded by four points A, B, C and D, if ABCD, BCDA etc. are in clockwise direction, CBAD or DCBA etc. are in anti-clock wise direction. If the particular super-element is denoted as ABCD, all the subelements in it will have a clockwise element incidence in this example.
5-46
Section 5
7.
Element incidences of the generated sub-elements may be obtained by providing the command 'PRINT ELEMENT INFORMATION' after the 'MESH...' command in the input file. If the STAAD input file contains commands for JOINT COORDINATES, MEMBER INCIDENCES, ELEMENT INCIDENCES and MESH GENERATION, they should be specified in the following order: STAAD SPACE UNIT . . . JOINT COORDINATES MEMBER INCIDENCES ELEMENT INCIDENCES DEFINE MESH GENERATE ELEMENT
8.
9.
Newly created joints will be merged with existing joints if they are within 0.001 inches of each other.
Section 5
5-47
Example The following section of input illustrates the use of MESH GENERATION facility, the user may compare this with the geometry inputs for Example Prob. No. 10 in the STAAD example manual:
Figure 5.4
STAAD SPACE TANK S TRUCTURE WITH * MESH GE NERATION UNIT . . . DEFINE MESH A 0 0 0 ; B 0 20 0 ; C 20 20 0 D 20 0 0 ; E 0 0 -20 ; F 0 2 0 -20 G 20 20 -20 ; H 20. 0. -2 0 GENERATE ELEM ENT MESH AEHD 16 MESH EABF 16 MESH ADCB 16 MESH HEFG 16 MESH DHGC 16
5-48
Section 5
Section 5
5-49
SUBST
JOINT MEMBER
COLUMN
f1, f2 START i
where, f 1 and f 2 are two range values of x, y, or z and i is the new starting number. Description Joint and member numbers can be redefined in STAAD through the use of the SUBSTITUTE command. After a new set of numbers is assigned, input and output values will be in accordance with the new numbering scheme. The user can design numbering schemes that will result in simple input specification as well as easy interpretation of results. For example, all joints in first floor of a building may be renumbered as 101, 102 ...., all second floor joints may be renumbered as 201, 202 ....., etc. Example UNIT METER SUBST JOINT YR 9.99 10.0 START 101 SUBST COLUMN START 901
5-50
Section 5
Joints with Y coordinates ranging from 9.99 to 10 meters will have a new number starting from 101. Columns will be renumbered starting with the new number 901. Note Meaningful re-specification of JOINT and MEMBER numbers may significantly improve ease of interpretation of results. This command may be in between incidence commands: MEMBER INCIDENCE SUBSTITUTE ELEMENT INCIDENCE
Section 5
5-51
5-52
Section 5
END GROUP DEFINITION where, group-name = an alphanumeric name specified by the user to identify the group. The group-name must start with the '_' (underscore) character and is limited to 24 characters. member-list = the list of members/elements/solids belonging to the group. TO, BY, ALL, BEAM, PLATE, and SOLID are permitted. ALL means all members+ plates+ solids; BEAM means all beams; PLATE all plates; and SOLID all solids. joint-list = the list of joints belonging to the group. TO, BY, and ALL are permitted. Notes 1) The GROUP definition must start with the START GROUP DEFINITION command and end with the END command. 2) More than one GROUP name may be specified within the same definition specification. 3) The words JOINT, MEMBER, ELEMENT, FLOOR and SOLID may be provided if the user wishes to identify the group name and lists with those specific items. However, if the group name and list is merely a means of grouping together more than one type of structural component under a single heading, the word GEOMETRY may be provided. In the absence of any of those words (GEOMETRY, JOINT, MEMBER, ELEMENT, FLOOR or SOLID), the list is assumed to be that for GEOMETRY. 4) The same joint or member/element number may be included in up to 4 groups. Multiple definitions are useful for output but can be ambiguous for input data such as constants, section property, release, etc. 5) If two or more consecutively entered groups have the same name, then they will be merged. If not consecutive, the second entry of the same name will be ignored. 6) A member group may be used in lieu of a member-list with virtually any command which requires member lists, such as MEMBER LOADS, steel and concrete parameters, etc. There is one place however where a MEMBER GROUP will not
Section 5
5-53
suffice, and that is for defining panels during a FLOOR LOAD assignment. In section 5.32.4 of this manual, as explained under the topic Applying floor load on members grouped under a FLOOR GROUP name, a panel has to be specified using a FLOOR GROUP, not a MEMBER GROUP. A FLOOR GROUP is presently not accepted in lieu of a member-list for any other command. Example START GROUP DEFINITION _TRUSS 1 TO 20 25 35 _BEAM 40 TO 50 END MEMBER PROPERTIES _TRUSS TA LD L40304 _BEAM TA ST W12X26
Example START GROUP DEFINITION JOINT _TAGA 1 TO 10 MEMBER _TAGB 40 TO 50 GEOMETRY _TAGC 101 TO 135 END MEMBER PROPERTIES _TAGB TA LD L40304 _TAGC TA ST W12X26
5-54
Section 5
where, d 1 , d 2 , d 3 are the rotations (in degrees) about the X, Y and Z global axes respectively. This command may be entered after the Joint Coordinates or between two Joint Coordinate commands or after all Member/Element Incidences are specified. This command can be used to rotate the structure geometry (defined prior to this command) by any desired angle about any global axis. The rotated configuration is used for analysis and design. While specifying this command, the sense of the rotation should conform to the right hand rule. Description This command can be used to rotate the geometric shape through any desired angle about any global axis. The rotated configuration can be used for analysis and design. Example PERFORM ROTATION X 20 Z -15
Section 5
5-55
INACTIVE
DELETE
Description These commands can be used to specify that certain joints or members be deactivated or completely deleted from a structure. The INACTIVE command makes the members and elements temporarily inactive; the user must re-activate them during the later part of the input for further processing. The DELETE command will completely delete the members/elements from the structure; the user cannot re-activate them. The Delete Joint command must be immediately after the Joint Coordinates. The DELETE member commands must be provided immediately after all member/element incidences are provided and before any INACTIVE commands. Notes a) The DELETE MEMBER command will automatically delete all joints associated with deleted members, provided the joints are not connected by any other active members or elements. b) The DELETE MEMBER command will also delete all the joints, which were not connected to the structure in the first
5-56
Section 5
c)
d)
e) f)
g)
h)
i)
place. For example, such joints may have been generated for ease of input of joint coordinates and were intended to be deleted. Hence, if a DELETE MEMBER command is used, a DELETE JOINT command should not be used. The DELETE MEMBER command is applicable for deletion of members as well as elements. If the list of members to be deleted extends beyond one line, it should be continued on to the next line by providing a blank space followed by a hyphen (-) at the end of the current line. The INACTIVE MEMBER command cannot be used in situations where inactivating a member results in joints becoming unconnected in space. The INACTIVE MEMBER command should not be used if the MEMBER TENSION/COMPRESSION command is used. The INACTIVated members may be restored for further processes (such as an analysis or design for a 2 nd set of load cases) by using the CHANGE command. See Section 5.37 and Example 4 for more information. The DELETE MEMBER command should be used to delete elements too. Specify the command as DELETE MEMBER j where j is the element number of the element you wish to delete. In the example shown below, 29 to 34 and 43 are element numbers. Loads that have been defined on members declared as INACTIVE members will not be considered in the analysis. This applies to SELFWEIGHT, MEMBER LOADS, PRESTRESS and POSTSTRESS LOADS, TEMPERATURE LOADs, etc. The DELETE JOINT command must be specified before all incidence commands such as MEMBER INCIDENCE, ELEMENT INCIDENCE, etc.
Section 5
5-57
fn
section-type
5-58
Section 5
section-name
propertyspec
Any user designated section name, use 1 to 12 characters. First three characters of Pipes and Tubes must be PIP and TUB respectively. Only alphanumeric characters and digits are allowed for defining section names. (Blank spaces, asterisks, question marks, colon, semi-colon etc. are not permitted.) Properties for the section. The requirements are different for each section type as follows. Shear areas AY and AZ must be provided to ensure proper shear stress or shear strength calculations during design. Also, SY, SZ, IZ and IY must be provided for design. The default length units for properties are the current units. If UNIT command is entered within the User Table in the input file then those units become the current units. However, a UNIT command on an external file only affects that file and has no effect on the units in subsequent input file commands. The user may specify the desired length unit by using the UNIT command as the first command in the table (see example following this description). If data is from input file, then use up to 3 lines of input per property-spec (end all but last with a hyphen, - ). If data is from external file, then use only one line, but it can be up to 250 characters long.
Section 5
5-59
Wide Flange
1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) 9) 10) Cross section area Depth of the section Thickness of web Width of the flange Thickness of flange Moment of inertia about local z-axis (usually strong axis) IY = Moment of inertia about local y-axis IX = Torsional constant AY = Shear area in local y-axis. If zero, shear deformation is ignored in the analysis. AZ = Same as above except in local z-axis. AX = D = TW = WF = TF = IZ =
Channel
1) AX, 2) D, 3) TW, 4) WF, 5) TF, 6) IZ, 7) IY, 8) IX, 9) CZ, 10) AY, 11) AZ
CZ Y
Figure 5.6
Angle
1) D, 2) WF, 3) TF, 4) R, 5) AY, 6) AZ R = radius of gyration about principal axis, shown as r(Z-Z) in the AISC manual. Must not be zero.
5-60
Section 5
Double Angle
1) D, 2) WF, 3) TF, 4) SP, 5) IZ, 6) IY, 7) IX, 8) CY, 9) AY, 10) AZ
Y WF
CY Z
SP
Figure 5.7
Tee
1) AX, 2) D, 3) WF, 4) TF, 5) TW, 6) IZ, 7) IY, 8) IX, 9) CY, 10) AY, 11) AZ
Y CY
Figure 5.8
Pipe
1) OD = Outer diameter 2) ID = Inner diameter 3) AY, 4) AZ
Section 5
5-61
Tube
1) AX, 2 ) D, 3) WF, 4) TF, 5) IZ, 6) IY, 7) IX, 8) AY, 9) AZ
General
The following cross-sectional properties should be used for this section-type. This facility allows the user to specify a built-up or unconventional steel section. Provide both the Y and Z parameters for design or code checking. 1) 2) 3) = Cross section area. = Depth of the section. = Thickness associated with section element parallel to depth (usually web). To be used to check depth/thickness ratio. B = Width of the section. TB = Thickness associated with section element parallel to flange. To be used to check width/thickness ratio. IZ = Moment of inertia about local z-axis. IY = Moment of inertia about local y-axis. IX = Torsional Constant. SZ = Section modulus about local z-axis. SY = Section modulus about local y-axis. AY = Shear area for shear parallel to local y-axis. AZ = Shear area for shear parallel to local z-axis. PZ = Plastic modulus about local z-axis. PY = Plastic modulus about local y-axis. HSS = Warping constant for lateral torsional buckling calculations. DEE = Depth of web. For rolled sections, distance between fillets should be provided. AX D TD
Note: Properties PZ, PY, HSS and DEE must be provided for code checking/member selection per plastic and limit state based codes (AISC LRFD, British, French, German and Scandinavian codes). For codes based on allowable stress design (AISC-ASD, AASHTO, Indian codes), zero values may be provided for these properties.
5-62
Section 5
Isection
This section type may be used to specify a generalized I-shaped section. The cross-sectional properties required are listed below. This facility can be utilized to specify tapered I-shapes. 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) 9) 10) DWW TWW DWW1 BFF TFF BFF1 TFF1 AYF AZF XIF = = = = = = = = = = Depth of section at start node. Thickness of web. Depth of section at end node. Width of top flange. Thickness of top flange. Width of bottom flange. Thickness of bottom flange. Shear area for shear parallel to Y-axis. Shear area for shear parallel to Z-axis. Torsional constant ( IX or J).
BFF TFF
DWW
DWW
DWW1
Figure 5.9
Section 5
5-63
NOTES: 1) DWW should never be less than DWW1. The user should provide the member incidences accordingly. 2) The user is allowed the following options for the values AYF, AZF and XIF. a) If positive values are provided, they are used directly by the program. b) If zero is provided, the program calculates the properties using the following formula. AYF = D x TWW (where D =Depth at section under consideration) = 0.66 ((BFF x TFF) + (BFF1 x TFF1)) = 1/3 ((BFF x TFF 3 ) + (DEE x TWW 3 ) + (BFF1 x TFF1 3 )) (where DEE = Depth of web of section)
AZF XIF
c) If negative values are provided, they are applied as factors on the corresponding value(s) calculated by the program using the above formula. The factor applied is always the absolute of the value provided, i.e. if the user provides the value of XIF as -1.3, then the program will multiply the value of XIF, calculated by the above formula, by a factor of 1.3.
Prismatic
The property-spec for the PRISMATIC section-type is as follows 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) 6) 7) 8) AX = IZ = IY = IX = AY = AZ = YD = ZD = Cross-section area Moment of inertia about the local z-axis Moment of inertia about the local y-axis Torsional constant Shear area for shear parallel to local y-axis. Shear area for shear parallel to local z-axis. Depth of the section in the direction of the local y-axis. Depth of the section in the direction of the local z-axis.
5-64
Section 5
Example START USER TABLE TABLE 1 UNIT . . . WIDE FLANGE W14X30 8.85 13.84 .27 W21X50 14.7 20.83 .38 W14X109 32. 14.32 .525 TABLE 2 UNIT . . . ANGLES L25255 2.5 2.5 0.3125 L40404 4. 4. .25 .795 END *
6.73 .385 291. 19.6 .38 0 0 6.53 .535 984 24.9 1.14 7.92 0 14.605 .86 1240 447 7.12 7.52 0
.489 0 0 0 0
These section-names must be provided in ascending order by weight, since the member-selection process uses these tables and the iteration starts from the top. The above example can also be input as follows:
START USER TABLE TABLE 1 TFILE1 TABLE 2 TFILE2 END Where TFILE1 and TFILE2 are names of files which must be created prior to running STAAD, and where the file TFILE1 will contain the following:
Section 5
5-65
UNIT . . . WIDE FLANGE W14X30 8.85 13.84 .27 6.73 .385 291. 19.6 .38 0 0 W21X50 14.7 20.83 .38 6.53 .535 984 24.9 1.14 7.92 0 W14X109 32. 14.32 0.525 14.605 .86 1240 447 7.12 7.52 0 and the file TFILE2 will contain: UNIT . . . ANGLES L25255 2.5 2.5 .3125 .489 0 0 L40404 4. 4. .25 .795 0 0 Notes The User-Provided Steel Table(s) may be created and maintained as separate file(s). The same files may be used for all models using sections from these tables. These files should reside in the same directory where the input file is located. On each file the first table should contain a UNITS command.
5-66
Section 5
MEMBER PROPERTIES
member-list
For specification of PRISMATIC properties, see Section 5.20.2 For specification of TAPERED members, see Section 5.20.3 For specification from USER PROVIDED TABLES, see Section 5.20.4 Examples are available in Section 5.20.6.
Section 5
5-67
The MEMBER PROPERTY command may be extended to multiple lines by ending all lines but the last with a space and hyphen (-).
1.
MEMBER PROPERTIES
AMERICAN AUSTRALIAN BRITISH CANADIAN CHINESE DUTCH EUROPEAN FRENCH GERMAN INDIAN JAPANESE KOREAN MEXICAN RUSSIAN SAFRICAN SPANISH VENEZUELAN
member-list
ASSIGN profile-spec
AMERICAN, BRITISH, EUROPEAN (etc.) option will instruct the program to pick up properties from the appropriate steel table. The default depends on the country of distribution. a. For type-specs and additional-specs, see Section 5.20.1
b. For ASSIGN profile-spec, see Section 5.20.5 Section 2 of this manual and the sections on steel design for various countries in the International Codes manual contain information on the section types which can be assigned for the various countries named in the above list.
5-68
Section 5
Examples are available in Section 5.20.6. The MEMBER PROPERTY command may be extended to multiple lines by ending all lines but the last with a space and hyphen (-).
2.
MEMBER PROPERTIES
BUTLER COLD AMERICAN COLD BRITISH COLD INDIAN KINGSPAN LYSAGHT RCECO
member-list
TABLE ST section-name-in-table
Section 2 of this manual and the sections on steel design for various countries in the International Codes manual contain information on the section types which can be assigned for the various countries/organizations named in the above list.
3.
General format for steel joists: MEMBER PROPERTIES SJIJOIST member-list TABLE ST section-name-in-table
Section 1 of this manual contains information on the joist types which can be assigned from the Steel Joist Institutes tables.
Section 5
5-69
4.
General format for Aluminum: MEMBER PROPERTIES ALUMINUM member-list TABLE ST section-name-in-table
The section on aluminum design in the International Codes manual contain information on the section types which can be assigned for the aluminum table in the above list.
5.
TABLE ST section-name-in-table
Section 4 of this manual and the sections on timber design in the International Codes manual contain information on the section types which can be assigned for the above list.
5-70
Section 5
5.20.1 Type Specs and Additional Specs for assigning properties from Steel Tables
Purpose In the previous section, there is a reference to type specs for hot rolled steel (See the article: General format for standard steel (hot rolled) ). The following are those type specifications. Note that these are currently available for hot rolled steel sections from the built-in tables only.
type-spec =
ST RA D LD SD T CM TC BC TB
ST specifies single section from the standard built-in tables. RA specifies single angle with reverse Y-Z axes (see Section 1.5.2). D specifies double channel. LD specifies long leg, back to back, double angle. SD specifies short leg, back to back, double angle. T specifies tee section cut from I shaped beams. CM specifies composite section, available with I shaped beams. TC specifies beams with top cover plate. BC specifies beams with bottom cover plate. TB specifies beams with top and bottom cover plates.
Section 5
5-71
table-name = Table section name like W8X18, C15X33 etc. The documentation on steel design per individual country codes contains information regarding their steel section specification also. For details on specifying sections from the American steel tables, see Section 2.2.1 of this manual. * SP WP TH WT additional-spec = DT OD ID CT FC CW CD SP f 1
See Section 1.7.2
f1 f2 f3 f4 f5 f6 f7 f8 f9 f10 f11
WP f 2
TH f 3
WT f 4 DT f 5 OD f 6 ID f 7 CT f 8 FC f 9 CW f 10 CD f 11
= = = = = = = =
This set describes the spacing (f 1 ) between angles or channels if double angles or double channels are used. f1 defaults to 0.0 if not given. b. For composite sections, SP = rib height. a. Width (f 2 ) of the cover plate if a cover plate is used with I shaped sections. b. For composite sections, WP = bottom coverplate width. a. Thickness (f 3 ) of plates or tubes. b. For composite sections, TH = bottom coverplate thickness. Width (f 4 ) of tubes, where TUBE is the table-name. Depth (f 5 ) of tubes. Outside diameter (f 6 ) of pipes, where PIPE is the tablename. Inside diameter (f 7 ) of pipes. Concrete thickness (f 8 ) for composite sections. Compressive strength (f 9 ) of the concrete for composite sections. Concrete width (f 10 ) for composite sections. Concrete density (f 11 ) for composite sections. Default value is 150 pounds/cu.ft.
a.
5-72
Section 5
Example See Section 5.20.6 Notes All values f 1-9 must be supplied in current units. Some important points to note in the case of the composite section are: 1. The 'CM' parameter can be assigned to I-shaped sections only. A 'CM' (composite) section is one obtained by considering a portion of a concrete slab to act in unison with the I shaped steel section. FC is the strength or grade of concrete used in the slab. In the USA, FC is called the specified compressive strength of concrete. Typical values of FC range between 2.0 and 5.0 ksi, and 20 to 50 Mpa. The width of the concrete slab (CW) (if not entered) is assumed to be the width of the top flange of the steel section + 16 times the thickness of the slab. In order to calculate the section properties of the cross-section, the modular ratio is calculated assuming that: Es= Modulus of elasticity of steel = 29000 Ksi. Ec= Modulus of elasticity of concrete = 1802.5 FC Ksi
2.
3.
where FC (in Ksi) is defined earlier. Some other general notes on this subject of member property designations are : 4. The 'T' parameter stands for a T-shaped section obtained by cutting an I-shaped section at exactly its mid height level along the web. Hence, the area of a T shape is exactly half the area of the corresponding I shape. The depth of a T shape is half the depth of the I shape it was cut from. What we refer to as I shaped sections are sections which look like the english alphabet I. The American Wide Flange, the British UB and UC sections, Japanese H sections, etc., all fall under this
Section 5
5-73
category. Consequently, the 'T' shape cut from a Japanese H shape is one obtained by cutting the H shape at exactly its midheight level of the web. Not all I shaped sections have a corresponding T. This may be inferred by going through the section libraries of individual countries and organizations. In such cases, if a user were to specify such a T section, the program will terminate with the message that the section does not exist. 5. Steel Cover plates also can be added only to I shaped sections. Thus, the 'TC', 'BC' and 'TB" are not applicable to any shape other than an I shape.
Figure 5.10
5-74
Section 5
property-spec =
See Section 1.7.1
AX IX IY IZ AY AZ YD ZD YB ZB
f1 f2 f3 f4 f5 f6 f7 f8 f9 f10
ZD
ZD
YD
YB
YD
ZB T-SECTION
ZB TRAPEZOIDAL SECTION
Figure 5.11
AX IX IY IZ AY AZ
f 1 = Cross sectional area of the member. Set to zero for TEE, Rectangular, Trapezoid, or circular. f 2 = Torsional constant. f 3 = Moment of inertia about local y-axis. f 4 = Moment of inertia about local z-axis (usually major). f 5 = Effective shear area in local y-axis. f 6 = Effective shear area in local z-axis.
If any of the above 6 parameters are omitted, it will be calculated from the YD, ZD, YB, and/or ZB dimensions.
Section 5
5-75
YD ZD
YB ZB
f 7 = Depth of the member in local y direction. (Diameter of section for circular members) f 8 = Depth of the member in local z direction. If ZD is not provided and YD is provided, the section will be assumed to be circular. f 9 = Depth of stem for T-section. f 10 = Width of stem for T-section or bottom width for TRAPEZOIDAL section.
5-76
Section 5
5.20.2.1
General format:
* ROUND HEXDECAGONAL property-spec = DODECAGONAL START d1 END d2 THICK t OCTAGONAL HEXAGONAL SQUARE
START END THICK d 1 = Depth of section at start of member. d 2 = Depth of section at end of member. t = Thickness of section (constant throughout the member length).
Example UNIT . . . MEMBER PROPERTY 1 PRIS ROUND STA 10 END 8 THI 0.375 2 PRIS HDC STA 15 END 10 THI 0.375 3 PRIS DOD STA 12 END 12 THI 0.375
Section 5
5-77
HEXAGONAL (6 SIDES)
D t
OCTAGONAL (8 SIDES)
t t
ROUND
D
t
5-78
Section 5
Section 5
5-79
UPTABLE stands for user-provided table i 1 = table number as specified previously (1 to 20) section-name = section name as specified in the table. (Refer to Section 5.19)
See Section 1.7.3
5-80
Section 5
profile-spec =
Example See Section 5.20.6 Notes Sections are always chosen from the relevant built-in steel table. To find out the details of the sections that are chosen, the command PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES should be provided after specification of all member properties.
Section 5
5-81
5-82
Section 5
Member 56 is a wideflange W12X26 with a 4.0 unit wide cover plate of 0.3 units of thickness at the top. Member 57 is a composite section with a concrete slab of 5.0 units of thickness at the top of a wide flange W14X34. The compressive strength of the concrete in 2 the slab is 3.0 force/length .
Section 5
5-83
= an alphanumeric name specified by the user to identify the deck. The deck-name line must start with '_DEC'. The deck-name is the second word
5-84
Section 5
member-list =
d1 d2 d3
= = =
and is limited to 19 characters. This name must not be the same as any group name. the list of members belonging to the deck. TO, BY, ALL, and BEAM are permitted. ALL means all members in structure; BEAM means all beams. x component of the direction of the deck. y component of the direction of the deck. z component of the direction of the deck.
The following parameters may be in any order or omitted. They only apply to the composite members listed above. Do not enter a member list for these parameters. f1 = compressive strength of the concrete for all composite members listed above for this composite deck. = concrete thickness. = concrete density. = height of rib of form steel deck. This is the distance from the top of the I beam to the bottom of the concrete deck. = width of rib of form steel deck. = thickness of cover plate welded to bottom flange of composite beam. = width of cover plate welded to bottom flange of composite beam. = diameter of shear connectors. = height of shear connectors after welding. = ratio of moment due to dead load applied before concrete hardens to the total moment. = temporary shoring during construction. 0 = no shoring 1 = with shoring = composite action with connectors. 0 = no composite action in design 1 = composite action 2 = ignore positive moments during design
f2 f3 f4
f5 f6 f7 f8 f9 f10 f11
f12
Section 5
5-85
The following parameter may be specified by member list. They only apply to the composite members listed above. f13 = concrete width for each composite member listed. cw-member-list = the list of composite members in this deck that have this width. Enter as many CW lines as necessary to define the width of all composite members of this deck.
This Deck definition data should be entered after the member properties have been entered. Notes 1) The DECK definition must start with the START DECK DEFINITION command and end with the END command. 2) More than one DECK may be specified between the START and END. 3) The same member number may be included in up to 4 deck/groups. Multiple definitions are useful for output but can be ambiguous for input data such as constants, section property, release, etc. 4) If two or more consecutively entered decks have the same name, then they will be merged. If not consecutive, the second entry of the same name will be ignored. 5) The _deck-name must be unique within the Deck definitions and the Group definitions. 6) PER, DIR, OUT are data created by the GUI. Do not edit this data. 7) This Deck definition data should be entered after the member properties have been entered.
5-86
Section 5
Example START DECK DEFINITION _DECK DEC-1 PERIPHERY 4 16 40 18 38 56 50 49 DIRECTION 0.000000 0.000000 -1.000000 COMPOSITE 41 7 4 38 OUTER 7 8 31 30 VENDOR USSTEEL DIA 0.700 HGT 2.75 CT 11.0 FC 3.1 RBW 2.6 RBH 0.1 CMP 1.0 SHR 1 CD 0.0000870 CW 123.000000 MEMB 41 CW 123.000000 MEMB 7 CW 61.500000 MEMB 4 CW 61.500000 MEMB 38 END DECK DEFINITION
Section 5
5-87
member-list RADIUS r GAMMA g PRESS p where r = radius in length units g = The angle in degrees used to define the plane of the circle. The angle is defined using the same set of rules used to define the orientation (beta angle) of a straight member connected between the 2 nodes. p = Pressure/Flexibility parameter for pipe bends. See notes. The plane of the circle defines the plane formed by the straight line joining the 2 ends of the arc, and the local Y axis of an imaginary straight member between those 2 points. The positive value of the GAMMA angle is obtained using the same sense as the positive value of the beta angle of that imaginary straight line member whose local Y axis points towards the vertex of the arc. Several diagrams intended to show the GAMMA angle for various segments lying in the 3 global planes are shown. Pressure/Flexibility Parameter. This applies only to pipe bend (elbow) members (OD and ID entered). These members will flex more due to ovalization depending on internal pressure. The
5-88
Section 5
ASME Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code, Section III, NB-3687.2, 1971, for Class I components is used to calculate the flexibility reduction factor. Set p = 0 or omit for this flexibility increase calculation to occur with internal pressure equal to zero. Set p > 0 to specify internal pressure to use in this flexibility calculation. Pressure reduces the flexibility increase. Set p = -9999 to ignore this additional flexibility calculation and use only beam theory. Set p = flexibility reduction factor (-FLEXF below); which must be a negative number less than 1.0 . ___________________________________________________ 0) ASME PIPE ELBOW FLEXIBILITY FACTORS THEORY [ASME SECTION NB-3687.2] This Section only applies if (Bend Radius/Mean Radius) 1.70 or if (Arclength) > (2 * Mean Radius) FLEXF = (Flexibility Factor) =
165 *( Mean Radius)2 . 1 * t *( Bend Radius ) 1 + (Pr ess )( Mean Radius )( FACT.) where
FACT. = 6 *( MR / t )4/ 3 *( BR / MR )1/ 3 Et
MR BR Pr ess t E
= = = = =
Mean Radius of e lbow wall Bend Radius Internal Pressure elbow wall thickness Modulus of Elasticity
If the Flexibility Factor computed is less than 1.0, then STAAD will use 1.0 . The Flexibility Factor directly multiplies or contributes t o most non-shear terms in the elbow flexibility matrix.
Section 5
5-89
Notes:
1) The input for defining the curved member involves 2 steps. The first is the member incidence, which is the same as that fo r a straight line member. The second is the command described a bove, which indicates that the segment between the 2 nodes of the member is curved, and not a straight line. 2) A ny non-tapered cross section property currently available in STAAD can be assigned to these members. 3) Currently, two load types are permitted on curved members. One is the SELFWEIGHT load type, described in Section 5.32.9 of the STAAD.Pro Technical Reference manual. The other is the UNIformly distributed load type of the MEMBER LOAD options explained in Section 5.32.2 of the same manu al. The uniformly distributed load has to be applied over the full span of the member. Other member loads such as LINEAR, TRAP, CONCENTRATED force or moment, UNIFORM moment, e tc. are not currently supported. These options are e xpected to become available in future versions of the program. 4) Some of the other member load types such as PRESTRESS, TEMPERATURE, STRAIN loads, e tc. are also not currently s upported. These options too are expected to become available in future versions of the program. 5) The results of the analysis currently consist of the nodal displacements of the ends of the curved member, and the member end forces. The nodal displacements are in the glob al coordinate system. The member end forces are in the local coordinate system, with each end of the member having its own unique local axis system. Results at inte rmediate sections, such as sectional displacements, and sectional forces will be available in future versions of the program.
5-90
Section 5
Start Node
End Node
Gamma = 0
Gamma = 0
End Node
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global XY plane
Section 5
5-91
Y End Node
Y Start Node
Gamma = 0
Gamma = 0
Gamma = 180
Start Node
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global XY plane
5-92
Section 5
Start Node
End Node
Gamma = 180
Gamma = 0
Start Node Z
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global YZ plane
Section 5
5-93
Y End Node
Y Start Node
Gamma = 0
Gamma = 0
Gamma = 180
Start Node
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global YZ plane
Figure 5.13d
5-94
Section 5
Start Node
Start Node
Gamma = +90
Gamma = -90
End Node Z X Z
End Node
End Node
End Node
Gamma = -90
Gamma = +90
Start Node Z Z
Start Node
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global XZ plane
Figure 5.13e
X X
Section 5
5-95
X
End Node
Gamma = -90
Start Node Z X Z
Start Node
End Node
Gamma = -90
Gamma = +90
Gamma angle for various configurations of the circular arc lying in the global XZ plane
Figure 5.13f
The local axis directions for curved members are dependent on t he point of interest along the curve. The general rules for l ocal axis, as laid out in Section 1.5.2 of thi s manual are applicable. The figure shown later for member end forces indicates the directions of axes at the start and end nodes.
Rotation of local axis
There is currently no facility available to change the orientation of a curved member. Hence, BETA ANGLE and REFERENCE POINT options, explained in section 1.5.3 and 5.26.2 of this manual, are not available for curved members.
Gamma = +90
5-96
Section 5
The displacements of the nodes of the curved member are along the global axis system just as in the case of straight members.
Sign convention for member end forces
The member end forces for curved members are quite similar to that for straight members. The only distinguishing item is that they are normal and tangential to the local axis at the corresponding ends. For example, FX at the start is tangential to the curve at the start node, and FX at the end is tangential to the curve at the end node. Similarly, FZ is along the radial direction at the two ends. Member releases, offsets, tension/compression, truss and cable may not be specified for curved beams.
MX2
MY1
FX1 FY1
FZ1
MX1
Z
Section 5
5-97
Example
staad space unit kip feet joint coord cyl reverse 1 150 0 0 13 150 0 90 repeat 1 30 0 0 repeat all 1 0 15 0 memb inci 1 1 27 26 101 27 28 112 113 40 41 124 201 27 40 213 start group definition member _column 1 to 26 _circumferential 101 to 124 _radial 201 to 213 end group definition member properties _column pris yd 3.0 _circumferential pris yd 3.0 _radial pris yd 3.0 constant E concrete all density concrete all poisson concrete all MEMBER CURVED 101 TO 112 RADIUS 150 GAMMA 90.0 113 TO 124 RADIUS 180 GAMMA 90.0 supports 1 to 26 pinned load 1 self y -1.0 perform analysis print stat check PRINT MEMBER FORCE LIST 101 113 finish
5-98
Section 5
No tes
1. 2.
The radius should be in cur rent units. Certain attributes like relea ses, TENSION/COMPRESSION flags, and several member load types are currently not available. Section forces too are currently not available.
Section 5
5-99
The next figure shows this con figuration. The fire-protection material forms a rectangular block a round the steel section. T he area of fireproofing material (A fp ) at any section along the m ember length is calculated in the following manner. For Wide Flanges (I-shaped sections), Channels and Tees, A fp = [(B f + 2T)*(D+2T)] - A steel For single angles, A fp = [(B f + 2T)*(D+2T)] - A steel B f is the flange width D the overall depth of the steel section T is the thickness of the fireproofing material beyond the outer edges of the cross section as shown in the next figure. A steel = Area of the steel section
5-100
Section 5
T T T
T T T T T
Figure 5.14
In this configuration, the fire-protection material forms a coating around the steel section as shown in the next figure. The area of fireproofing material (A fp ) for this case is calculated in the following manner. For Wide Flanges (I-shaped sections) A fp = [(B f + 2T)*(T f +2T)]*2 + [(D-2T-2T f )*(T w +2T)] - A steel
For single angles, A fp = [(L 1 +2T)*(2T+T a ) + (L 2 -T a )*(2T+T a )] - A steel For Tees, A fp = [(B f + 2T)*(T f +2T)] + [(D-T f )*(T w +2T)] - A steel
Section 5
5-101
B f is the flange width D the overall depth of the steel section T is the thickness of the fireproofing material be yond the outer edges of the cross section as shown in the next figure. T f is the thickness of the flange for the I shape and Tee T a is the th ickness of the leg of the angle T w is the thickness of the web for the I shape and Tee A steel = Area of the steel section
T T
T he number of input items required to apply this attribute is four a) the type of fireproofing b) the thickness T shown in the above fi gures c) the density of the fire proofing material d) the members on which it is to be applied. For each such member, A fp is calculated and multiplied by the density of the fireproofing material to obtain the weight per unit length of the member. This is added to the weight per unit length of the steel section itself and the total is used in calculating selfweight. Hence, SELFWEIGHT must be one of the load components of load cases if the weight of the fireproofing material should be considered as part of those load cases.
5-102
Section 5
where, f1 = thickness (T in the figures above) in length units f2 = density of fireproofing material in (force / length ^ 3) units In the actual load case itself, nothing besides the SELFWEIGHT command is necessary to instruct the program to include the weight of th e fireproofing material in the se lfweight calculation.
Exa mple Problem STAAD SPACE UNIT KIP FEET JOINT COORDINATES 1 0. 0. ; 2 0. 15. ; 3 20. 15. ; 4 20. 0. MEMBER INCIDENCE 1 1 2;2 2 3;3 3 4 MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 3 TABLE ST W12X26 2 TABLE ST W14X34 CONSTANTS E STEEL ALL POISSON STEEL ALL DENSITY STEEL ALL SUPPORT 1 FIXED ; 4 PINNED UNIT POUND INCH MEMBER FIREPROOFING 1 3 FIRE BFP THICK 2.0 DENSITY 40 2 FIRE CFP THICK 1.5 DENSITY 40
Section 5
5-103
UNIT KIP FT LOADING 1 DEADWEIGHT OF STEEL + FIREPROOFING SELF Y -1.0 LOAD 2 LIVE MEMBER LOAD 2 UNI GY -0.8 LOAD COMBINATION 3 1 0.75 2 0.75 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT MEMBER FORCES PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS FINISH
5-104
Section 5
Individual plate elements, and the Surface element need to h ave their thickness specified before the analysis can be performed. The commands for spec ifying this information are explained in this section. No similar properties are required for solid elements. However, constants such as modulus of elasticity, Poissons Ratio, etc. are required.
Section 5
5-105
This set of commands may be used to specify properties of plate finite elements.
General Format: ELEMENT PROPERTY element-list THICKNESS f 1 (f 2 , f 3 , f 4 )
= Thickne ss of the element. f1 f 2 .. .f 4 = Thicknesses at oth er nodes of the element, if different from f 1 . Description
See Section 1.6
Ele ments of uniform or lin ear ly vary in g thick ne s s ma y be m odeled using this comma nd. The v alu e of the thic kne ss must be pro vided in current units.
Example UNIT . . . ELEMENT PROPERTY 1 TO 8 14 16 TH 0.25
5-106
Section 5
surface-list
THICKNESS t
The attributes associated with surfaces, and the sections of this manual where the information may be obtained, are listed below:
Attributes
Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output printing Shear Wall Design -
Related Sections 5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
Section 5
5-107
5-108
Section 5
Thi s set of commands may be used to ful ly release specific degrees of freedom at the ends of frame members. They may also be used to describe a mode of attachment where the member end is connected to the joint for specific degrees of freedom through the mea ns of springs .
Ge neral format: MEMBER RELEASES
* KFX f1 * FX FY KFY f2 FZ KFZ f3 MX KMX f4 MY KMY f5 MZ KMZ f6 where FX through MZ and KFX through KMZ represent force-x through moment-z degrees of freedom in the member local axes and f1 through f6 are spring constants for these degrees of freedom. If FX through MZ is used, it signifies a full release for that d.o.f, and if KFX through KMZ is used, it signifies a spring attachment Example MEMBER RELEASE 1 3 TO 9 11 12 START KFX 1000.0 MY MZ 1 10 11 13 TO 18 END MZ KMX 200.0
In the above example, for members 1, 3 to 9, 11 and 12, the moments about the local Y and Z axes are released at their start joints (as specified in MEMBER INCIDENCES). Further, these members are attached to their START joint along their local x axis through a spring whose stiffness is 1000.0 units of force/length.
Section 5
5-109
For members 1, 10, 11 and 13 to 18, the moment about the local Z axis is released at their end jo int. Also, the members are attached to their END joint about their local x axis through a moment-spring whose stiffness is 200.0 units of forcelength/Deg ree. Members 1 and 11 are released at both start and end joints, though not necessarily in the same degrees of freedo m.
* MP
where f 1 = release fa ctor for all 3 moments; or enter f 4 , f 5 , and/or f 6 as release factors for each moment sep arately. The moment related stiffness co-effici ent will be mu ltiplied by a factor of (1-f 1 ) at the specified end. Release factors must be in the range of 0.001 through 0.999.
Example MEMBER RELEASE 15 TO 25 START MP 0.25
5-110
Section 5
The above RELEASE command will apply a factor of 0.75 on the moment related stiffness coefficients at START of members 15 t o 25.
Notes
Member releases are a means for describing a type of end conditio n for members when the default condition, namely, fully moment and force resistant, is not applicable. Examples are bolted or rivet ed connections. Partial moment releases are a way of specify ing bending and torsional m oment capacity of connections a s being a fraction of the full bending and torsional strength. It is important to note that the factor f 1 indicates a red uction in the s tiffness corresponding to the rotational degrees of freedom MX, MY and MZ. In other words, the user should not expe ct the moment on the member to reduce by a factor of f 1 . It may be necessary for the user to perform a few trials in order to arrive at th e right value of f 1 , which results in the desired reduction in moment. A lso, START and END are based on the MEMBER INCIDENCE specification. The BOTH specification will apply the releases at b oth ends. At any end of the member, for any particular DOF, full, partial and spring release cannot be applied simultaneously. Only one out of the three is permitted. If MY (or MZ) is fully released at both ends, then VZ (or VY) cannot be transmitted through the member. The final shears in the member will be entirely due to loads applied directly to the member.
Section 5
5-111
This set of commands may be used to release specified degrees of freedoms at the cor ners of plate finite elements.
General Form at: ELEMENT RELEASE
element-list
J1 J2 J3 J4
* FX FY FZ MX MY MZ
where the keywords J1, J2, J3 and J4 signify joints in the order of the specific ation of the element incidence. For example, if the in cidences of the element were defined as 35 42 76 63, J1 represents 35, J2 represents 42, J3 represents 76, and J4 represents 63. Elem ent releases at multiple joints cannot be specified in a s ingle line. Those must be specified separately as shown below. FX through MZ represents forces/moments to be released per local axis system.
Example
C orrect Usage
ELEMENT RELEASE 10 TO 50 J1 MX MY 10 TO 50 J2 MX MY 10 TO 50 J3 MY 10 TO 50 J4 MY
Incorrect Usage
ELEMENT RELEASE 10 TO 50 J1 J2 MX MY 10 TO 50 J3 J4 MY
5-112
Section 5
Notes
1. All releases are in the local axis system. See Figure 1.13 for the various degrees of freedom. Fx and Fy have the same sen se as Sx and Sy in Figure 1.13. Fz has the same sense as S Qx or SQy. Generally, do not ov er release. The element must still behave as a plate after the releases. 2. Selfweight is applied at each of the nodes as if there were no releases. 3. Thermal stresses w ill include the fixed-end thermal pre-stress as if there were no release. 4. May not be used with the Element Plane Stress or Element Ignore Inplane Rotation commands on the same element. 5. Note that the usual definitions of local Mx and My are reversed here. See Figure 1.13 for the definitions of Mx and My. Releasing Fz, Mx, My will release all bending capability. Releasing Fx, Fy, Mz will release all in-plane stiffness.
Section 5
5-113
Structural units like glass panels or corrugated sheet roofs are subjected to loads like wind pressures or snow loads. While these units are designed to carry those loads and transmit those loads to the rest of the structure, they are not designed to provide any additional stiffness to the structure. One way to handle the situation is to not input the unit as part of the structural model, and apply the load using load generation techniques like AREA LOAD or FLOOR LOAD. STAAD provides another way of handling such units. This is through the help of the ELEMENT IGNORE STIFFNESS command. To use this feature, the glass panel or roof unit must be defined usin g plate elements. The IGNORE STIFFNESS command enables one to consider the unit just for the purpose of application of load, while its stiffness will not be considered during the a ssembly of the stiffness matrix. In other words, it is like an INACTIVE member which is active for load application but INACTIVE for stiffness.
General F ormat: IGNORE STIFFNESS Example
{ ELEMENT } element-list
5-114
Section 5
Section 5
5-115
This comm and may be used to model a specified set of members as TRUSS members.
Description
This specification m ay be used to specify TRUSS type members in a PLANE, SPACE or FLOOR structure. The TRUSS members are capable of carrying only axial fo rces. Typically, bracing members in a PLANE or SPACE frame will be of this nature.
Genera l format: MEM BER TRUSS member-list T EN SION f 1
This command is superfluous when a TRUSS type structure has already been specified using the command STAAD TRUSS.
Example MEMB TRUSS 1 TO 8 10 12 14 15
5-116
Section 5
Notes
The TRUSS member has only one degree of freedom - the axial deformation. Note also that Member Releases are not allowed. Selfweight and transverse loads may induce shear/moment distributions in the member. Member loads are lumped at each end, whereas a frame member with moment releases only retains the axial component of the applied member load.
Section 5
5-117
Thi s command may be used to model a specified set of members as CABLE members.
Description for use in all analyses except Non Linear Cable Analysis:
The CABLE members, in addition to elastic axial deformation, a re also capable of accommodating the stiffness eff ect of initial tension and tension due to static loads. Theoretical discussions of CA BLE members are presented in Section 1.11 of this m anual.
Ge neral format: MEMBER CABLE
See Sections 1.9, 1.11.
member-list
TENSION f 1
The TENSION specified in the CABLE member is applied on the stru cture as an external load as well as is used to modify the stiffness of the member. S ee Section 1.11 for details. If TEN SION or the value is omitted a minimum tension will be used.
5-118
Section 5
This is a truss m ember but not a tension-only member unless you also inclu de this member in a MEMBER TENSION input. See section 5.2 3.3. Note also that Member Releases are not allowed. The tensio n is a preload and will not be the final tension in the cable afte r the deformation due to this preload.
Descript ion for use in Non Linear Cable Analysis :
The CABLE members, in addition to elastic axial deformation, are also capab le of accommodating large displacements.
General format: MEMBER CABLE membe r-list ---OR--mem ber-list
See Sections 1.9, 1.11, 1.18.2.5, 5.37
where f 1 = Initial Tension in cable member (in current units) where f 2 = Unstressed cable length (in current units)
Example MEMB CABLE 20 TO 25 TENSION 15.5 Notes
The TE NSION specified in the CABLE member is applied on the structure as an external load as well as used to modify the stiffn ess of the member. See Section 1.11 for details. The tension is used to determine the unstressed length. That length will be shorter than the distance between the joints by the distance that the tension will stretch the cable.
Section 5
5-119
This command may be used to designate certain members as Ten sion-only or Compression-only members.
General Format: MEMBER TENSION member - list MEMBER COMPRESSION member - list MEMB ER TENSION 0 (No list required) Des cription
Tension-only members are truss/cable members that are capable of carrying tensile forces only. Thus, they are automatically inactivated for load cases that create compression in them.
LINEAR TENSION/COMPRESSION ANALYSIS Compression-only members are truss members that are capable of carrying compressive forces only. Thus, they are auto matically inactivated for load cases that create tension in them. Member Releases are not allowed on members with this attribute.
The procedure for analysis of Tension-only or Compression-only membe rs requires iterations for every load case and therefore may be quite involved. The user may also consider using the INACTIVE specification (instead of Tension/Compres sion) if the solution time becomes unacceptably high.
5-120
Section 5
If a CHANGE command is used (because of a change in the list of tension members, cable tension, supports, etc.), then the SET NL command must be used to convey to STAAD that multiple analyses and multiple stru ctural conditions are involved.
For NON-L INEAR CABLE ANALYSIS : This command is unnecessary and ignored. Cables are automatically assumed to be partially to fully tension only (except that there should always be selfweight) without this command. In this analysis type, trusses without preload are assumed to be linear members that carry both tension and compression regardless of this command. Example MEMBER TENSION 25 TO 30 35 36 Example MEMBER COMPRESSION 43 57 98 102 145 Example MEMBER TENSION 12 17 19 TO 37 65 MEMBER COMPRESSION 5 13 46 TO 53 87 Notes for LINEAR TENSION/COMPRESSION ANALYSIS
1) Loads that have been defined on members declared as MEMBER TENSION or MEMBER COMPRESSION will be active even when the member becomes INACTIVE during the process of analysis. This applies to SELFWEIGHT, ME MBER
Section 5
5-121
2)
3)
4)
5)
LOADS, PRESTRESS & POSTSTRESS LOADS, TEMPERATURE LOAD, etc. A member declared as a TENSION only member or a COMPRESSION only member will carry axial forces only. It will no t carry moments or shear forces. In other words, it is a truss member. The MEMBER TENSION and MEMBER COMPRESSION commands should not be specified if the INACTIVE MEMBER command i s specified. Do not use Load C ombination to combine these cases. Tensio n/Compression cases are non-linear and should not be linearly combined as in Load Combination. Use a primary load case with the Repeat Load command. The following is the genera l sequence of commands in the input file if the MEM BER TENSION or MEMBER COMPRESSIO N command is used. This example is for the MEMBER TENSION command. Similar rules are applicable for the MEMBER COMPRESSION command. The dots indicate other input data items.
STAAD SET NL UNITS JOINT COORDINATES MEMBER INCIDENCES ELEMENT INCIDENCES CONSTANTS MEMBER PROPERTY ELEMENT PROPERTY SUPPORTS MEMBER TENSION
5-122
Section 5
LOAD 1 LOAD 2 LOAD 3 LOAD 4 LOAD 5 REPEAT LOAD PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD LIST ALL PRINT PRINT PARAMETER CHECK CODE FINISH
MEMBER TENSION 0 This command switches off ALL tensi on/compression only specifications for load cases which are specified subsequent to this command, usually entered after a CHA NGE command. There is no list associated with this command. He nce, for any further primary load cases, the tension/compression only attributed is disabled for ALL members. Notes a) See Section 5.5 for explanation of the SET NL command. The number that follows this command is an upper bound on the total number of primary load cases in the file.
b) STAAD performs up to 10 iterations automatically, stopping if converged. If not converged, a warning message will be in the o utput. Enter a SET ITERLIM i command (i>10) before the first
Section 5
5-123
load case to increase the default number of iterations. Since convergence may not be possible using this procedure, do not set th e limit too high. c) The principle used in the analysis is the following. The program reads the list of members declared as MEMBER TENSION and/or COMPRESSION. The analysis is performed for the entire structure and the member forces are computed. For the members declared as MEMBER TENSION / COMPRESSION, the program checks the axial force to determine whether i t is tensile or compressive. If the member cannot take tha t load, the member is "switched off" from the structure. The analysis is per formed again without the switched off members. Up t o ITERLIM iterations of the above steps are made for each load case. This method does not always converge and may become unstable. Check the output for instability messages. Do not us e results if the last iteration was unstable.
d) A r evised MEMBER TENSION / COMPRESSION command and its accompanying list of members may be provided after a CH ANGE command. If entered, the new MEMBER TENSION/COMPRESSION commands replace all prior such commands. If these commands are not entered after a CHANGE, then the previous commands will still be applicable. e) The MEMBER TENSION command should not be used if the following load cases are present : Response Spectrum load case, Time History Load case, Moving Load case. If used, the MEMBER TENSION /COMPRESSION will be ignored in all load cases. f) If UBC Load cases are included, then follow each UBC load case with an Analysis command, then a Change command.
5-124
Section 5
These commands allow the user to model the following conditions on plate elements a) PLANE STRESS condition b ) In-plane rotation stiffness refo rmulated to be rigid or to be zero.
G e ner a l Format: E LE MENT element-list Descri ption
See Section 1.6
The PL ANE STRESS specification allows the user to model selected element s for PLANE STRESS action only [No bending or tr ansverse shear stiffness]. The RIGID INPLANE ROTATION command causes the program to conn ect the corner Mz "in-pl ane rotation" action to the other corner M z rotation s rigidly. The STAAD plate element formula tion normally produces a very soft Mz stiffn ess that improves the inplane shear deformation. However when the plate Mz is c onnected to a beam bending m oment as the only load path for that moment, then th e RIGID INPLANE option may be used to have th at element carry the Mz moment to the other joints rigidly to avoid the instability at the beam end. Usually only the elements connected to beams in this manner would have this specification. The IGNORE INPLANE ROTATION command causes the program to ignore "in-plane rotation" actions. The STAAD plate
Section 5
5-125
elem ent formulation normally includes this important action automa tically. However, it may be noted that some element formulations ignore this action by default. The user may utilize this opt ion to compare S TAAD results with solutions from these program s. These options are exclusive of each other and also exclusive of element releases. No single element may have more than one of these options.
Example ELEMENT PLANE STRESS 1 TO 10 15 20 25 35 ELEMENT IGNORE 30 50 TO 55
5-126
Section 5
This command may be used to rigidly offset a frame member end from a joint to model the offset conditions existing at the ends of frame members.
General format: ME MBER OFFSETS START member-list END Description
Y
WP refers to the location of the centroid of the starting or ending point of the member
( LOCAL )
f 1, f 2, f 3
7" WP n1 1 WP
6"
n2 9" 2 WP X
f 1 , f 2 , and f 3 correspond to the distance, measured in LOCALized or Global coordinate system, from the joint (START or END as specified) to the centroid of the starting or ending point of the me mbers listed. MEMBER OF FSET command can be
Figure 5.16
used for any me mber whose starting or ending point is not concurrent with the given incident joint. This command enables the user to account for the secondary forces, which are induced due to the eccentricity of the member. Member offsets can be speci fied in any direction, in cluding the direction that may coincide with the member x-axis.
Section 5
5-127
wp in the diagr am refers to the location of the centroid of the starting or ending point of the member.
LOCA L is an o ptional parameter, if not entered the n f1, f2, f3 are assumed to be in glob al. LOCAL means that the distances f1, f2, f3 are in the sa me member coordinate system that would result if the member wer e not offset and BETA = 0.0.
Example MEMBER OFFSET 1 START 7.0 1 END -6.0 0.0 2 END -6.0 -9.0 Notes
1) If a MEMBER LOAD (see MEMBER LOAD specification) is applied on a member for which MEMBER OFFSETS have been specified, the location of the load is measured not from the coordinates of the starting joint. Instead, it is measured from the offset location of the starting joint. 2) START and END is based on the user's specification of MEMBER INCIDENCE for the particular member.
5-128
Section 5
Material constants are attributes like Modulus of Elasticity and Density which are required for operations like generating the stiffness matrix, computing selfweight, and for steel and concr ete design. In STAAD, there are 2 ways in which this data may be specified : a. a 2-step pro cess that involves step 1 - Creatin g the material data by defining MATERIAL tags specified under the heading DEFINE MATERIAL (see Section 5.26.1) step 2 - Assigning them to individual members, plates and solids under the heading CONSTANTS (see Section 5 .26.2) Thi s will cr eat e commands as shown below : DEFINE MATERIAL ... name ... <-------------- Part 1 ... E ND MAT E RIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL n am e . .. <-------------- Part 2
Section 5
5-129
b. Assign material attributes explicitly by specifying the individu al constants as explained in section 5.26 .2. CONST ANTS E ... POISSO N .. Section 5.26.3 explains the commands required to assign material data to Surface elements.
5-130
Section 5
This command may be used to specify the material properties by material name. Then assign the members and elements to this material name in the CONSTANTS command.
General format: DEFINE MATERIAL ISOTROPIC name or 2DORTHOTROPIC name
f1 f1 f1 f1 f1 f1 f1
f2
f2
Repeat ISOTROPIC or 2DORTHOTROPIC name and values for as many materials as desired then:
END MATERIAL (DEFINITION)
Name E G
POISSON
material name (name of up to 36 characters). specifies Young's Modulus. specifies Shear Modulus. Enter only for beams & plates and when Poisson would not be 0.01 to 0.499. specifies Poisson's Ratio. If G is not entered, then this value is used for calculating the Shear Modulus (G=0.5xE/(1+POISSON)). Must be 0.01 to 0.499. Po isson must b e entered for orthotropic
Section 5
5-131
plates or when Poisson cannot be computed from G. DENSITY specifies weight density. ALPHA Co-efficient of thermal expansion. DAMPING or CDAMP Damping ratio to be used in computing the modal damping by the composite damping method. Value of the corresponding constants. For E, G, f1 f2 POISSON, DENSITY, ALPHA and damping. For plates only, the first value is for local x direction and the second for local y.
5-132
Section 5
5.26.2 Specifying CONSTANTS for members, plate elements and solid elements
Purpose
This command may be used to specify the material properti es (Moduli of Elas ticity a nd Sh ear, Poisso n's ratio, Densi ty, Coefficient of linear expansion, and m aterial dam ping) of the member s and el ements . In addi tion, t his com mand m ay als o be used to sp ecify t he me m ber orientation (BETA angle or REFERE NCE point).
General forma t: CONSTANTS MATERIAL name MEMBER m emb/elem -list ( ALL )
where name is the material name as specified in the DEFINE MATERIAL command (see section 5.26.1). -OR-
f1
MEMBER memb/elem-list
List specifier: MEM, BEA, PLA, SOL, ALL. Only MEM may be followed by a list. Blank means ALL. ALL means all members and elements; BEA means all members; PLA, all plates; SOL, all solids.
Section 5
5-133
specifies Young's Modulus. This value must be provided before the POISSON for each member/elem ent in the Constants list. specifies Sh ear Modulus. Enter only for beams & plates and w hen Poisson would not be 0.01 to 0.499. specif ies Poisson's Ratio. If G is not entered, then this v alue is used for calculating the Shear Modulus (G=0.5xE/(1+POISSON)). M ust be 0.01 to 0.4 99. Poisson must be entered when Poisson cannot be com puted from G. specifies weight density. Co -efficient of thermal expansion. Damping ratio to be used i n computing the modal damping by the composite d amping method. specifies member rotation angle in degrees (see Section 1.5.3). Note : Single angle sections are oriented according to their principal axes by default. If it is necessary to orient them such that their legs are parallel to the global axes, the BETA specification must be used. STAAD offers the following additional specifications for this purpose : BETA ANGLE BETA RANGLE Both of the above options will result in an orientation with the legs parallel to the global axis. The 'ANGLE' option rotates the section through the angle (90 - "alpha") (where "alpha" = angle between the principal axis system and the global axis system). [Please review the figures on the
PO ISSON
B ETA
5-134
Section 5
next page.] The 'RANGLE' option rotates the section through an angle equal to (180 - "alpha"). Both options will work the same way for equal angles. For unequal angles, the right option must be used based on the required orientation.
Local Y
90 -
Local Y
180
Local Z
Local Y
B eta = R A N G LE
Lo cal Y
9 0 -
Lo cal Y
180
Lo cal Z
L ocal Y L oca l Z "S T " A ngle B eta = 0 "S T " A ngle B eta = A n gle "S T " A n gle B eta = R A N G LE
Lo cal Z
Figure 5.17a
Section 5
5-135
Local Y
Global X
Orientation of a column ( vertical member ) corresponding to BETA = 0; Local X and Global Y come out of the paper ( Local X is parallel to Global Y )
Global X
Local Y
Global Z Local Z Orientation of a column ( vertical member ) corresponding to BETA = ANGLE Local X and Global Y come out of the paper ( Local X is parallel to Global Y )
Figure 5.17b
5-136
Section 5
f1
Value of the corresponding constants. For E, G, POISSON, DENSITY, ALPHA and CDAMP, built in material names can be entered instead of f 1 . Th e built-in names are STEEL, CONCRETE & ALUMINUM. Appropriate values will be automatically assigned for th e built-in names.
C ONSTANTS in Kip, inch, Fahrenheit units
Constant E (US)
Poissons D ensity A lpha C DAMP E (nonUS)
Steel 29000
0.30 .000283 6.5E-6 .03 29732.736
Concrete 3150
.17 .0000868 5.5E -6 .05
Aluminum 10000
.33 .000098 12.8E-6 .03
Units Kip/in 2
Kip/in 3 L/L/deg-F Ratio Kip/in 2
Units kN/m 2
kN/m 3 L/L/deg-C Ratio kN/m 2
E (US) i s used if US codes were installed or if Member Properties Am erican is specified for an analysis; otherwise E (nonUS) is used.
f2, f3, f4 f5
Global X, Y, and Z coordinates for the reference point or use location of joint f 5 for the reference point, from which the BETA angle will be calculated by S TAAD (see sectio n 1.5.3).
Section 5
5-137
Example DEFINE MATERIAL ISOTROPIC CFSTEEL E 28000. POISSON 0.25 DENSITY 0.3E-3 ALPHA 11.7E-6 DAMP 0.075 END MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL CFSTEEL MEMB 1 TO 5 CONSTANTS E 2.1E5 ALL BETA 45.0 MEMB 5 7 TO 18 DENSITY STEEL MEMB 14 TO 29 BETA 90 MEMB X
The last command in the above example will set BETA as 90 fo r all members parallel to the X-axis.
5-138
Section 5
Notes
1) The value for E must always be given first in the Constants list for each member/element. 2) All numerical value s must be provided in the current units. 3) It is not necessary or possible to specify the units of tem perature or ALPHA. The user must ensure that the value pro vided for ALPHA is consistent in terms of units with the value provided for temperature (see Section 5.32.6). 4) If G is not specified, but Poisson is specified, G is calculated from E [2 ( 1 + Poisson )] . 5) If neither G nor Poisson is specified, Poisson is assumed based on E, and G is then calculated. 6 ) If G and Poisson are both specified, the input value of G is used, G is not calculated in this situation. 7) If G and Poisson are both required in the analysis, such as for the stiffness matrix of plate elements, and G is specified, but Poisson is not, then, Poisson is calculated from [(E/2G) 1 ]. 8) To obtain a report of the values of these terms used in the analysis, specify the com ma nd PRINT MATERIAL PROPERTIES.
Section 5
5-139
Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading S tress/Force output printing S hear Wall Design General format: SURFACE CONSTANTS
E POISSON G f DENSITY ALPHA
5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
5-140
Section 5
where f is one of the following, as appropriate: Youngs Modulus (E), Poissons Ratio, Modulus of R igidity (G), Weight density, Coefficient of thermal expansion, all in current units. In li eu of numerical values, built-in material names may be used for the above specification of constants. The built-in names are STEEL, CONCRETE and ALUMINUM.
Example SURFACE CONSTANTS E 3150 1 TO 4 POISSON 0.17 ALL DENSITY 8.68e-005 1 TO 4 ALPH A 5.5e-006 1 TO 4
Notes:
1. If G is not specified, but Poisson is specified, G is calculated from E [2 ( 1 + Poisson )] . 2. If neither G nor Poisson is specified, Poisson is assumed based on E, and G is then calculated. 3. If G and Poisson are both specified, the input value of G is used, G is not calculated in this situation. 4. If G and Poisson are both required in the analysis, such as for the stiffness matrix of plate elements, and G is specified, but Poisson is not, then, Poisson is calculated from [(E/2G) 1]. 5. To obtain a report of the values of these terms used in the analysis, specify the command PRINT MATERIAL PROPERTIES.
Section 5
5-141
To define unique modal damping ratios for every mode. If all modes have the same damping, then enter damping with the Define Time History Load or with the Dynamic Loading commands. Damping may be entered here 1. EXPLICITly for so me or all modes; 2 . by specifying that STAAD EVALUATE each modes damping based on the frequency of the mode and the mi n imum and maximum damp ing entered he re. Th e formula used to evaluate the damping is give n below . 3. by specifying that STAAD C ALCULATE each mode s damping based on the frequency of the mo de and th e m ass factor, ALPHA, and the STIFFNESS factor, BETA. The formula used to calculate the damping is giv en bel ow. The da mping entered will be used in Dynamic Analy ses such a s Time History load cases; Response Spectrum load cases that u se the CQC/ASCE4 methods and/or Spectra vs. Perio d curves ve rsus d amping; and Steady State load cases.
General Syntax DEFINE DAMPING INFORMATION
EVALUATE dmin (dmax) CALC ALPHA c1 BETA c2 MAX c3 MIN c4 EXPLICIT d1 (d2 d3 d4 d5 .)
END
1. Enter dmin and dmax as the minimum and maximum damping ratios respectively to be used in the formula bel ow, or 2. Alternatively enter c1 and/or c2 (optionally include the limits of c3 and c4) to be used in the formula below, or
5-142
Section 5
3. Alternatively enter d1, d2, d3, etc. as the damping ratios for each mode. With th e Explicit option each value can be preceded by a repetitio n factor (rf*damp) without spaces. For example: EXPLICIT 0.03 7*0.05 0.04 <= mode 1 damping is .03, modes 2 to 8 are .05, mode 9 is .04. If there are fewer entries than modes, then the last damping entered will apply to the remaining modes. This input may be continued to 10 more input lines with word EXPLICIT only on line 1; end all but last line with a space then a hyphen. There may be additional sets of EXPLICIT lines before the END. Damping ratios must be in the range 0.0 through 1.0. ______________________________________________________ The formula used for CALCULATE (to calculate the damping per modal frequency based on mass and/or stiffness proportional damping) is: D(i) = ( / 2i ) + ( i / 2 ) = damping ratio for modes i = 1 to N. If the resulting damping is greater than MAX, then MAX will be used (MAX=1 by default). If the resulting damping is less than MIN, then MIN will be used (MIN=1.E-9 by default). This is the same damping as D = ( + ). Example: To get 4% damping ratio at 4 Hz and 6% damping ratio at 12 Hz Mode 1 3 Hz 4.0 12.0 Rad/sec 25.133 75.398 Damp Ratio 0.04 0.06
Section 5
5-143
However they are determined, the and terms are entered in the CALC data above. For this example cal culate the damping ratio at other frequencies to see the variation in damping versus frequency. Mode 1 3 Hz 4.0 12.0 2 8 20 4.5 Rad/sec 25.133 75.398 12.0664 50.2655 120.664 28.274 Damp R atio .04000 .06000 .05375 .04650 .09200 .03969
The damping, due to times stiffness, increases linearly with frequency; and the damping, due to alpha times mass, decreases parabolicly. The co mbination of the two is hyperbolic. ______________________________________________________ The formula used for EVALUATE (to evaluate the damping per modal frequency) is: Damp ing for the first 2 modes is set to dmin from input. Damping for modes i = 3 to N given dmin and the first two frequencies 1 and 2 and the ith modal frequency i . A 1 = dmin / (1 + 2 ) A 0 = A 1 * 1 * 2 D(i) = (A 0 / i ) + (A 1 * i ) damping for modes i = 3 to N. If the resulting damping is greater than the dmax value of maximum damping, then dmax will be used. Example: (for dmin = .02 , dmax = .12 and the i given below) Mode 1 2 3 N i Damping ratio 3 .0200 4 .0200 6 .0228568 100 .1200 (calculated as .28605 then reset to maximum entered)
5-144
Section 5
This command may be used to designate certain support springs as contributing to the computation of modal damping by the composite damping method. The Response Spectrum or Time History dynamic response analyses must select composite damping for this data to have any effect on results.
General Format: SPRING DAMPING * KFX f 1 KFY f 2 KFZ f 3
join t list
D escription
At least one of KFX, KFY, or KF Z must be entered. Each one en tered must have a spring damp value follow ing it. f 1 f 2 f 3 are da mping ratios (0. 001 to 0.990). If this Spring Damping command is entered, then all springs in the structure are included in the composite damping calculation, otherwise no spring is considered in that calculation. This input command does not create a spring, only that if a supp ort spring exists at the joint in the specified direction then it will be assigned the damping ratio. See Section 5.27.1 to 5.27.3 to defin e springs. This is not a discrete damper definition.
Section 5
5-145
To define camber and drift specifications for selected members. Dr i ft is usually for columns and camber for be ams.
Ge ner a l Format: DEFINE IMPERFECTION
CAMBER
Y * XR f4 f5 (f 1 ) RESPECT (f 2 ) YR f4 f5 ZR f4 f5 Z M EM memb-list LIS T memb-list ALL Y (f 3 ) Z * XR f4 f5 YR f4 f5 ZR f4 f5 MEM memb-list LIS T memb-list ALL
DRIFT
Where f1 f2 f3 f4 and f5
Camber value. Default = 300. Respect value. Default = 1.6 . Drift value. Default = 200. global coordinate values to specify X or Y or Z range for member selection.
Im perfections will be simulated by loads. These loads will be generated for the specified members if there is an Imperfection Analysis specified and if the specified members are active, in com pression, and are not tru ss or tension/compression only m embers.
5-146
Section 5
Section 5
5-147
This set of commands may be used to specify the SUPPORT conditions for supports parallel to the global axes. For SURFACE elem ents, if nodes located along a straight line are all supported identically, as in the case of the base of a wall, support generation can be performed for assigning restraints to those nodes. See the GENERATE option in the command syntax below. The user needs to provide only the starting and ending nodes of the range, and the type of restraint.
General format:
SUPPORTS joint - list ni TO nj GEN ERATE PIN NED FIX ED (BUT release spec [spring spec.] ENFORCED (BUT release spec)
FX FY FZ release spec = MX MY MZ
KFX f1 KFY f2 KFZ f3 KMX f4 KMY f5 KMZ f6
s prin g-spec = *
5-148
Section 5
PINNED support is a support that has translational, but no rotational restraints. In other words, the support has no moment carrying capacity. A FIXED support has both translational and rotational restraints. A FIXED BUT support can be released in the global directions as described in release-spec (FX for force-X through MZ for mom ent-Z). Also, a FIXED BUT support can have spring constants as described in spring-spec (translational spring in global X-axis as KFX through rotational spring in global Z-axis as KMZ). Corresponding spring constants are f 1 through f 6 . The rotational spring constants are always per degree of rotation. All six releases may be provided as may be required when using the CHANGE command. If both release specifications and spring specificati ons are to be supplied for the same support joint, release specificatio ns must come first.
Example SUPPORTS 1 TO 4 7 PINNED 5 6 FIXED BUT FX MZ 8 9 FIXED BUT MZ KFX 50.0 KFY 75. 18 21 FIXED 27 FIXED BUT KFY 125.0
In this example, joints 1 to 4 and joint 7 are pinned. No moments are carried by those supports. Joints 5 and 6 are fixed for all DOF except in force-X and moment-Z. Joints 8 and 9 are fixed for all DOF except moment-Z and have springs in the global X and Y directions with corresponding spring constants of 50 and 75 units respectively. Joints 18 and 21 are fixed for all translational and rotational degrees of freedom. At joint 27, all the DOF are fixed except the FY DOF where it has a spring with 125 units spring constant.
Section 5
5-149
Notes
1) Users are urged to refer to Section 5.38 for information on specification of SUPPORTS along with the CHANGE command specifications. 2) Spring constants must be provided in the current units. 3) All spring DOF must be entered after the last non-spring DOF is specified, if both are on the same line. 4) If there are two entries for the same joint, then: a) any direction that is pinned/fixed on either will be fixed in that direction. b) any direction released on one and is a spring on the other will use the spring. c) Any direction that is pinned/fixed on one and a spring on the other will use the spring. d) Any direction that is a spring on 2 or more entries will have the spring constants added.
Description of Enforced
Enforced Support defines which translational and rotational directions, at a joint, may have a support displacement imposed. The support displacements are defined for each load case in section 5.32.8. If no support displacement is entered, then zero displacement will be imposed, as if that direction was FIXED. The enforced displacement directions will be fixed for dynamic load cases. If there are two entries for the same joint, then any direction that is enforced on either will be enforced in that direction, overriding any other support specification for that joint-direction.
Example for support generation SUPPORTS 3 TO 7 GENERATE PIN
5-150
Section 5
The above command will generate pinned supports for all joints located between nodes No. 3 and 7 along a straight line. This m ay include joints explicitly defined by the user or joints generated by the program for i nternal use only (e.g., as a result of SET DIVISION and SURFACE INCIDENCES commands). Currently the support generation command can only be used in conjunction with the Surface elem ent support specifications.
Section 5
5-151
These commands may be used to specify supports that are inclined with respect to the global axes.
General Format: SUPPORT
joint-list INClined
f1 f2 f3 REF f 4 f 5 f 6 REFJT f 7
where f 1 , f 2 , f 3 are x, y, z global distances from the joint to the reference point"; or where f 4 , f 5 , f 6 are x, y, z global coordinates of the reference point"; or where f 7 is a joint number whose x, y, z global coordinates is the reference point". A vector from the joint location to the reference point location serves to define a local coordinate system (same as member with BETA=0). The inclined support directions are in this local "Inclined Support Axis System" (see more below).
See Section 1.14
Note the release-spec and spring-spec are the same as in the previous section (5.27.1). However, FX through MZ and KFX through KMZ refer to forces/moments and spring constants in the "Inclined Support Axis System" (see below).
5-152
Section 5
2 3
3m
4m
3m
Figure 5.18
Section 5
5-153
Notes
Inclined support directions are assumed to be same as global when computing some dynamic and UBC intermediate results (e.g. global participation factors). If masses and/or forces in the free directions at inclined supports are a relatively small portion of the overall forces, then the effect should be very small.
5-154
Section 5
X joint-list ELASTIC FOOting f1 (f2) XOnly joint-list EL ASTIC MAT DIR Y plate-list PL ATE MAT YOnly
SUBgrade f 3
ZO nly
ALL
w here f1 , f2 X ,Y,Z f3 = Length and width of the footing. If f2 is not given, the footing is assumed to be a square with sides f1 = Global direction in which soil springs are to be generated = Soil sub-grade modulus in force/area/length units.
A LL option
f3, f4, f5 = Soil sub-grade modulus in force/area/length units in Y, X, Z directions respectively. f4, f5 default to f3 if omitted.
Section 5
5-155
5-156
Section 5
Delaunay triangle method used in the ELASTIC MAT option, which is that the contour formed by the nodes of the mat mu st form a convex hull.
The PLATE MAT DIR ALL option : Similar to the Plate Mat except that the spring supports are in 3 directions. If the compression only option is also specified, then the compression direction will be assume d to be in the Y direction. If the Y spring at a joint goes slack (lift off), then the X and Z spring stiffnesses for that joint will al so be set to zero. Otherwise the X and Z springs act in both directions. The area for the X and Z springs is the same as used for the Y spri ng.
The DIR ALL option indicates that springs will be generated in all 3 directions. For the DIR ALL option, three values of subgrade reaction ma y be entered, the first is for the Y direction, the second for X and the third for Z. For compression only springs the ALL pa rameter has s pecial meaning. The compression only spring is in the Y direction; the X and Z direction springs are bi-directional. However when the Y direction spring goes slack, the X and Z springs at the same joint are made inactive as well.
The DIRection option : The keyword DIR is followed by o ne of the alphabets X, Y or Z (or XONLY, YONLY, or ZONLY) which indicate the direction of resistance of the spring supports. If X or Y or Z is selected then a spring support is generated in that d irection plus 3 other directions receive a fixed support, e.g. if Y is selected, then FY is supported by a spring; FX and FZ and MY are fixed su pports; and MX and MZ are free. If XONLY, YONLY, or ZONLY are selected then only a spring support in that direction is generat ed. The SUBGRADE option : The keyword SUB GRADE is followed by the value of the subgrade reaction. The value should be provided in the current unit system signified by the most recent UNIT statement prior to the SUPPORT comma nd.
Section 5
5-157
The PRINT option : Prints the influence area of each joint. The COMP option : The springs generated will be compression only. The MULTI option : The springs generated will be multilinear. Add the associated multilinear curve input after each MAT command (with the multi option) to describe the displacements pring constant curve. See section 5.27.4 for additional information on this input format. The actual spring constant used will be the subgrade modulus (f3 entered above) times the influence area (computed by Staad) times the s i values entered in the curve (so the curve stiffness values will likely be between 0 .0 and 1.0). SPRINGS d 1 s 1 d 2 s 2 d n s n Example SUPPORTS 1 TO 126 ELASTIC MAT DIREC Y SUBG 200. 1 TO 100 PLATE MAT DIREC Y SUBG 200. YR -.01 .01 PLA MAT DIR Y SUBG 200 MUL SPRINGS -0.51 40.0 -0.50 50.0 0.5 65.0
The first command above instructs STAAD to internally generate supports for all nodes 1 through 126 with elastic springs. STAAD first calculates the influence area perpendicular to the global Y axis of each node and then multiplies t he corresponding influence area by the soil subgrade modulus of 200.0 to calculate the spring constant to be a pplied to the node. In the 2 nd example, the nodes of p lates 1 to 100 are assigned spring supports, generated using a s ubgrade modulus of 200 units.
Notes:
A closed surface is generated by the program based on the joint-list that accompanies the ELASTIC MAT command. The area within this closed
5-158
Section 5
surface is determined and the share of this area for each node in the list is then calculated. Hence, while speci fying the joint-list, one should make sure that these joints make up a clo sed surface. Without a proper closed surface, the area calculated for the region may be indeterminate a nd the spring constant values may be erroneous. Consequently, the list should have at a minimum, 3 nodes. The internal angle formed by 2 adjacent segments connecting 3 consecutive nodes in the list should be less than 180 degrees. In other words, the region should have the shape of a convex polygon. The example below explains the method that may be used to get around a situation where a convex polygon is not available. For the model comprised of plate elements 100 to 102 in the figure below, one wishes to generate the spring supports at nodes 1 to 8. However, a single ELASTIC MAT command will not suffice because the internal angle between the edges 1-8 and 8-7 at node 8 is 270 degrees, which violates the requirements of a convex polygon. So, one should break it up into 2 commands: 1 2 3 8 ELASTIC MAT DIREC Y SUBG 200. 3 4 5 6 7 8 ELASTIC MAT DIREC Y SUBG 200.
102 8
100 2
101
3
Figure 5.19
Section 5
5-159
Joints 3 and 8 will hence get the contribution from both of the above commands. The command works only when the plane of the closed region is parallel to one of th e global planes X-Y, Y-Z or X-Z. For regions that are inclined to one of the global planes, the spring constant will have to be evaluated manually and specified using the FIXED BUT type of spring support.
5-160
Section 5
where (di si) pairs represent displacement and spring constant p airs (si is zero or positive), starting from the maximum negative displacemen t to the maximum positive displacement. The first pair defines the spring constant from negative infinity di splacement up to the d isplacement defined in the second pair. The second pair define the spring constant when the support di splaces in the range from the displacement defined in the second pa ir, up to the displacement d efined in the third pair. This c ontinues for each displacement and spring constant pair until the last pair which defines the spring constant for displacements g reater than the displacement in the last pair to positive infinity.
Example
UNIT SUPPORT 1 PINNED; 2 4 FIXED BUT KFY 40.0 MULTILINEAR SPRINGS 2 4 SPRINGS -1 40.0 -0.50 50.0 0.5 65.0
Section 5
5-161
Loa d-Displacement characteristics of soil can be represe nted by a multi-linear curve. Amplitude of this curve will represent the spri ng characteristic of the soil at different displacement values. A typical spring characteristic of soil may be represented as the step curve as shown in the figure below. In the above example, the multi-linear spring command specifies soil spring at joints 2 and 4. (Note that the amplitude of the st ep curve does not change after the first p oint.) Each load case in a multi-linear analysis must be separated by a CHANGE com mand and have its own PERFORM ANALYSIS comm and. There may not be any PDELTA, NONLIN, dynamics, CABLE o r TENSION/COMPRESSI ON analysis included. The multi -linear spring command will initiate an iterative analysis and convergence check cycle. The cycles will continue until the RMS of the effective spring rates used remain virtually the same for 2 consecutive cycles.
Notes :
1. SUPP ORT springs m ust have previously been entered for each spring entered here. For the first cycle, the spring value used will be the support spring value (not the zero displacement value here). Use a realistic and stable value. 2. All directions that have been defined with an initial spring stiffness in the SUPPORT command will become multi-linear with this one curve. 3. This command c an be continued to up to 11 lines by ending all but last with a hyphen. The semi-colons and the XRANGE, YRANGE, ZRANGE list item s may not be used. 4. This command needs a m inimum of two displacement and spring constant pairs.
5-162
Section 5
Figure 5.20
F = For ce U nits L = Length units Spring cons tant is always positive or zero.
Section 5
5-163
This command may be used to designate certain support springs as Ten sion-only or Compression-only springs.
Genera l Format: SPRING TENSION joint list spring-spec SPRING COMPRESSION joint list spring-spec * KFX KFY KFZ ALL
spring-spec =
Description
Tension-only springs are capable of carrying tensile forces only. Thus, they are automatically inactivated for load cases that create compression in them. Compression-only springs are capable of carrying compressive forces only. Thus, they are automatically inactivated for load cases that create tension in them. If no spring spec is entered or ALL is entered then all translational springs at that joint will be tension (or compression) only. This input command does not create a spring, only that if a support spring exists at the joint in the specified direction then it will also be tension (or compression) only. See Section 5.27.1 to 5.27.3 to define springs. For compression only springs the ALL parameter has special meaning. The compression only spring is in the Y direction; the X and Z direction springs are bi-directional. However when the Y
5-164
Section 5
direction spring goes slack, the X and Z springs at the same joint are made inactive as well. The procedure for analysis of Tension-only or Compression-only springs requires iterations for every load case and therefore may be quite invol ved. Since this command does not specify whether the spring is in the positive or negative direction from the joint, it is assumed in STAAD to be in the negative direction. For negative dis placement the spring is in compression and for positive the spring is in te nsion. If a CHANGE comm and is used (because of a change in list of te nsion springs, supports, etc.), then the SET NL command must b e used to co nvey to S T AA D that multiple analyses and multiple structural conditions are involved.
Example SPRING TENSION 12 17 19 TO 37 65 SPRING COMPRESSION 5 13 46 TO 53 87 KFY Notes
1) A spring declared a s TENSION only or COMP RESSION only will carry axial forces only. It will not carry moments. 2) The SPRING TENSION / COMPRESSION commands should not be specified if the INACTIVE MEMBER command is specified. 3) Do not use Load Com bination to combine these cases. Tension/Compression cases are non-linear and should not be linearly combined as in Load Combination. Use a primary load case with the Repeat Load command. 4) The following is the general sequence of commands in the input file if the SPRING TENSION or COMPRESSION
Section 5
5-165
command is used. This example is for the SPRI NG TENS ION command. Similar rules are applicable for the SPRING COMPRESSION command. The dots indicate other input data items.
STAAD SET NL UNITS JOINT COORDINATES MEMBER INCIDENCES ELEMENT INCIDENCES CONSTANTS MEMBER PROPERTY ELEMENT PROPERTY SUPPORTS SPRING TENSION LOAD 1 LOAD 2 LOAD 3 REPEAT LOAD PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD LIST ALL PRINT PRINT PARAMETER
5-166
Section 5
a) See Section 5.5 for explanation of the SET NL command. The number that follows t his command is an upper bound on the total number of primary load cases in the file. b) STAAD performs up to 1 0 iterations automatically, stopping if converged. If not conv erged, a warning message will be in the output. Enter a SET ITERLIM i command (i>10) before the first load case to in crease the default number of iterations. Since convergence may not be possible using this procedure, do not set the limit too high. If not converged, a message will be in the output. c) The principle used in the analysis is the f ollowing. The program reads the list of springs declared as SPRING TENSION and/or COMPRESSION. The analysis is performed for the entire structure and the spring forces are computed. For the springs declared as SPRING TENSION / COMPRESSION, the program checks the axial force to determine whether it is tensile or compressive. Positive displacement is TENSION. If the spring cannot take that load, the spring is "switched off" from the structure. The analysis is performed again without the switched off springs. Up to ITERLIM iterations of the above steps are made for each load case. This method does not always converge and may become unstable. Check the output for instability messages. Do not use results if the last iteration was unstable. You may need to include some support in each global direction that is not tension (or compression) only to be stable on every iteration.
Section 5
5-167
d) A revised SPRING TENSION / COMPRESSION command and its ac companying list of joints may be provided after a CH ANGE command. If entered, the new SPRING commands replace all prior SPR ING commands. If not entered after a CHANGE, then the previous spring definitions are used. e) The SPRING TENSION command should not be used if the following load cases are present : Response Spectrum load case, Time History Load case, Moving Load case. If used, the SPRING TENSION /COMPRESSION will be ignored in all load cases. f) If the SPRING TENSION/COMPRESSION command is used in a model with UBC, IBC or other such seismic load cases, each such load case must be followed by an ANALYSIS and CHANGE command.
5-168
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to model specialized linkages (displacement tying, rigid links) through the specification of MASTER and SLAVE joints. Please read the notes for restrictions.
General format:
SLAVE
* XY YZ ZX RIGID FX FY FZ MX MY MZ
MASTER
JOINT
joint-spec
joint-spec =
Description
The master/slave option provided in STAAD allows the user to model specialized linkages (displacement tying, rigid links) in the system. For example, SLAVE FY connects the two joints such that the Y displacement at the slave will be the sum of Y
Section 5
5-169
displacement at the master plus the rigid rotation, R SIN . Notic e that instead of providing a joint list for the slaved joints, a range of coordinate values (in global system) may be used. All joints whose coordinates are within the range are assumed to be slaved join ts. For convenience, the coordinate range specified for slaved joints in this entry may include the master joint for this entry. However, master and slave joints of other entries must not be included in the coordinate range. All 2 or 3 ranges can be entered to form a tube or box for selecti ng joints in the tube or box region. Fx, Fy etc. are the directions in which they are slaved (any combination m ay be entered ). If two or more consecutive entries have the same ma ster, the slave lists will be merged. It is also OK to have different direction specs. The direction specifiers (XY, YZ, ZX) are combinations of the b a sic directions, XY is the same as entering FX, FY, MZ; etc. Any combination of direction specifiers may be entered. An exam ple of the use of this format is: a rigid diaphragm floor that still retains bending flexibility entered as SLA ZX . If RIGID or if all directions are provided, the joints are assumed to b e ri gidly connected.
5-170
Section 5
Restrictions
Solid elements may not be connected to slave joints. Master joints may not be slaves in another entry. Slave joints may not be master or slaves in another entry. Slave directions at joints may not be supported directions or have displacements imposed. Master and/or slave joints may not be inclined supports. The master / slave specification is only intended for linear static and dynamic analysis. Multilinear springs are not permitted.
Example - Fully Rigid and Rigid Floor Diaphragm SLAVE RIGID MASTER 22 JOINT 10 TO 45 SLAVE RIGID MASTER 70 JOINT YR 25.5 27.5 SLA ZX MAS 80 JOINT YR 34.5 35.5
Section 5
5-171
This command has been discontinued in STAAD.Pro. Please u se the Graphical User Interface for screen and hard copy graphic s.
5-172
Section 5
Section 5
5-173
These commands are used in conjunction with dynamic analysis. They may be used to specify the highest frequency or the number of mode shapes that need to be considered.
General Format:
CUT (OFF)
See Section 1.18.3
W here , f 1 = Highest frequency (cycle/sec) to be c onsidered for dynamic analysis. i 1 = Number of mode shapes to be considered for dynamic analy sis. If the cut off frequency command is not provided, the cut off frequency will default to 108 cps. If the cut of f mode shape command is not provided, the first six modes will be calculated. These commands should be provided prior to the loading specifications. t 1 = Ending time for a time history analysis. If zero (default), the time history will end when the last forcing function ends. A maximum of i 1 mode shapes will be computed regardless of f 1 . If during convergence testing, the 0 through f 1 frequencies are c onverged, then the modal calculation will be completed before i 1 m ode shapes are calculated. If the CUT OFF FREQ f1 and CUT OFF MODE i1 commands are both entered, then after completing each iteration step in the Subspace iteration, convergence testing is performed. If every frequency from 0.0 to f1 meets the convergence tolerance, then the Subspace iteration is done. Similarly, if every mode from 0 to i1
5-174
Section 5
meets the convergence tolerance, then the Subspace iteration is done. If the cut off frequency f1 results in fewer modes than i1, then only those frequencies up to the cut off are used. If the cut off frequency would result in more modes than i1, then only the first i1 modes a re used. That is, the modes cut off takes precedence over the frequency cut off.
Section 5
5-175
This c ommand allows specific ation of a reduced set of active dynamic modes. All modes selected by this command remain select ed until a new MODE SELECT is specified.
Gene ral format:
MODE SELECT
mode_list
Description
T his command is used to limit the m odes used in dynamic analysis to the modes listed in this com mand and deactivate all other modes that were calculated but not listed in this command. If this command is not entered, then all modes calculated are used in the dyna mi c analy s is.
E xample CUT O FF MOD ES 1 0 MODE SELECT 1 TO 3
In this e xample, 10 modes will be calculated but only mode s 1 and 3 will be used in dynamic analysis.
Notes
Do not enter this command within the loads data (from the first Load command in an analysis set down to the associated Analysis command). The advantage of this command is that one may find the amount of structural response generated from a specific mode or a set of
5-176
Section 5
modes. For example, if 50 modes are extracted, but the effect of just the 40 th to the 50 th mode in a response spectrum analysis is to be determined, one may set the active modes to be 40 through 50. The results will then be devoid of any contribution from modes 1 through 39.
Section 5
5-177
This secti on descri bes t he specifications necessary f or defining various lo ad system s, fo r automati c g ener atio n of M oving loads, UBC Seismic loads and Wind l o ad s. In addition, this section also describe s the specification of Time History load for Time History analysis.
Description
STAA D has built-in algorithms to generate moving loads, lateral seismic loads (per the Uniform Building Code), and wind loads on a structure. Use of the load generation facility consists of two parts: 1) Definition of the load system(s). 2) Generation of primary load cases using previously defined load system(s). Definition of the load system(s) must be provided before any primary load case is specified. This section describes the specification of load system(s). Information on how to generate primary load cases using the defined load system(s) is available in Section 5.32.12. UBC loads do not fully consider the effects of forces at inclined support directions or at slave joint directions. Applying forces at these locations may introduce errors that are generally small.
5-178
Section 5
T his set of commands may be used to define the m oving load sy stem. Enter this command only once with up to 200 TYPE co mmands.
General form at: DEFINE MOVING LOAD TYPE j (FILE file-name)
T he MOVING LOAD system may be defined in two possible ways - directly within the input file or using an external file.
See Section 5.32.12
The FILE option should be used only in the second case when the data is to be read from an external file. The filename should be li mited to 24 characters.
Moving Loads can be generated for frame members only. They will not be generated for finite elements. Note: All loads and distances are in current unit system.
Section 5
5-179
Where, j n fi di w = = = = moving load system type number (integer limit of 200 ty pes) number of loads (e.g. axl es), 2 to 200. value of conc. i th load distance between the (i+1) th load and the i th load in the direction of movement = spacing between loads perpendicular to the direction of movement. If left out, one dimensional loading is assu med. (e.g. the width of vehicle). This parameter will double the total load since the f i is applied to each wheel.
Is the name of the moving load system (maximum of 24 characters). Optional multiplying factor to scale up or down the value of the loads. (default = 1.0)
Following is a typical file containing the data. CS200 ----start in 50. 80. 90. 100. ----7. 7. 9. ----6.5 ----name of load system (load-name, must column 1) loads (all on one 79 char input line) distance between loads (one line) width
5-180
Section 5
50
80
90
100
9.0
Several load systems may be repeated within the same file. The STAAD moving load generator assumes: 1) All positive loads are acting in the negative global vertical (Y or Z) directi on. The user is advised to set up the structure model accor dingly. 2) Resultant direction of movement is determined from the X, Y and Z increments of movements as provided by the user.
R eference Load
The first sp ecified concentrated load in the moving load system is designated as the reference load. While generating subsequent primary load cases, the initial position of the load system and the d irection of movement are defined with respect to th e reference load location. Also, when selecting the reference load location w ith a positive value of Width specified, the following two views define the reference load location.
Section 5
5-181
reference point
x
d1 W
d2 d1 d2
z
reference point
z
Movement parallel to global X axis Figure 5 .22
W
Movement parallel to global Z axis
Notice that in the left view, the reference point is on the positive Z wheel track side; whereas in the right view, the reference point is on the least positive X wheel track side.
TYPE i
(f)
( vs )
where, i = moving load syst em type no. (integer). f = optional multiplying f actor (default = 1.0) vs = variable spacing as de fined by AASHTO, for HS series trucks (default = 14 ft.)
5-182
Section 5
Example DEFINE MOVING LOAD TYPE 1 LOAD 10.0 20.0 15.0 10.0 DISTANCE 5.0 7.5 6.5 WIDTH 6.0 TYPE 2 HS20 0.80 22.0 Example:
Section 5
5-183
5-184
Section 5
5.31.2.1
This feature enables one to generate seismic loads per the UBC 9 7 s pecifications using a static equivalent approach.
Description
T he seismic load generator can be used to generate la teral loads in th e X and Z directions only. Y is the direction of gra vity loads. This facility has not been developed for cases where the Z axis is set to be the vertical direction using the SET Z UP command.
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 14
Method ology
The design base shear is computed in accordance with Section 1630.2.1 of the UBC 1997 code. The primary equation, namely, 30-4, as shown below, is checked.
V=
In addition, the following equations are checked : Equation 30-5 The total design base shear shall not exceed
V=
2.5C a I W R
Equation 30-6 - The total design base shear shall not be less than
V = 0.11Ca IW
Section 5
5-185
Equation 30-7 In addition, for Seismic Zone 4, the total base shear shall also not be less than
V=
0.8ZN v I W R
For an explanation of the terms used in the above equations, please refer to the UBC 1997 code. There are 2 sta ges of command specification for generating lateral loads. This is t he first stage and is activated through the DEFINE UBC LOAD command.
General Format DEFINE UBC (ACCIDENTAL) LOAD ZONE f1 ubc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w [See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition] ubc-spec = { I f2, RWX f3, RWZ f4, STYP f5, NA f6, NV f7, (CT f8), (PX f9), (PZ f10)}
where, f1 = Seismic zone coefficient. Instead of usi ng an integer value like 1, 2, 3 or 4, use the fractional value like 0.075, 0.15, 0. 2, 0.3, 0.4, etc. f2 = Importance factor f3 = Numerical coefficient R for lateral load in X direction f4 = Numerical coefficient R for lateral load in Z direction f5 = Soil Profile type f6 = Near source factor Na f7 = Near sourc e factor Nv f8 = Optional CT value to calculate time period based on Method A (see Note 7) f9 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in X-direction to be used in Method B
5-186
Section 5
f10 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in Z-direction to b e use d in Method B Th e Soil Profile Type parameter STYP can take on values fro m 1 to 5 . These are related to the values shown in Table 16-J of the UB C 1997 code in the following manner :
STAAD Value 1 2 3 4 5 UBC 1997 code value SA SB SC SD SE
The soil profile type S F is not supported. The seism ic zone factor (ZONE) in conjunction with the soil p rofile type (STYP), Near source factor (Na), and the Near source fa ctor (Nv), is u sed to determine the values of seismic coefficients Ca and Cv from Tables 16-Q and 1 6-R of the UBC 1997 code.
Examples DEFINE UBC LOAD
ZONE 0.38 I 1.0 STYP 2 RWX 5.6 RWZ 5.6 NA 1.3 NV 1.6 CT 0.037
SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 101 106 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 151 156 193 200 WEIGHT 720 MEMBER WEIGHT 12 17 24 UNI 25.7 FLOOR WEIGHT YRA 9 11 FLOAD 200 XRA 1 21 ZR 1 41 ELEMENT WEIGHT 234 TO 432 PR 1 5 0
Section 5
5-187
Steps to calculate base shear are as follows: 1. Tim e Period of the structure is calculated based on clause 1630 .2.2.1 (Method A) and 1630.2. 2.2 (Method B). 2. The user may override the period that the program calculates u sing Method B by specifying a value for PX or PZ (Items f9 an d f10) depending on the direction of the UBC load. The specified value will be used in place of the o ne calculated u sing Method B. 3. The governing Time Period of the structure is then chosen b etween the above-mentioned two periods on the basis of the guidance provided in clause 1630.2.2.2. 4. F rom Table 16-Q and 16-R, Ca and Cv coefficients are calc ulated. 5. The Design Base Shear is calculated based on clause 1630.2.1 an d distributed at each floor using the rules of clause 163 0.5. 6. If the ACCIDENTAL option is specified, the program ca lculates the additional torsional mom ent. The lever arm for calculating the torsional moment is obtained as 5% of the building dimension at each floor level perpendicular to the dire ction of the UBC load (clause 1630.6). At each joint where a we ight is located, the lateral seismic force acting at tha t joint is m ultiplied by this lever arm to obtain the torsional moment at th at joint. 7 . If the value of C t is not specified, the program scans the Modulus of Elasticity (E) values of all members and plates to dete rmine if the structure is made of steel, concrete or any othe r material. If the average E is smaller than 2000 ksi, Ct is set to 0.02. If the average E is between 2000 & 10000 ksi, Ct is set to 0.03. If the average E is greater than 10000 ksi, Ct is set t o 0.035. If the building materia l cannot be determined, Ct is set to 0.035. 8. Due to the abstractness of the expression "Height above foundation", in STAAD, height "h" is measured above supports. If supports are staggered all over the vertical elevations of the structure, it is not possible to calculate "h" if one doesn't have a clear elevation level from where to meas ure "h". Also, the code deals with distributing the forces only on regions above the foundation. If there are lumped weights
5-188
Section 5
below the foundation, it is not clear as to how one should determine the lateral forces for those regions. The foll owing example shows the commands required to enable the program to generate the lateral loads. Users may refer to the LOAD GENERATION section of the Reference Manual for this info rmation.
LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) UBC LOAD X 0.75 LOAD 2 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN Z DIRECTION ) UBC LOAD Z 0.75 No tes:
The UBC / IBC input can be provided in 2 or more lines using the con tinuation mark (hyphen) as shown in the following example :
DEFINE UBC ACCIDENTAL LOAD ZONE 3.000 I 1.00 RWX 1.100 RWZ 1.200 STYP 5.000 NA 1.40 NV 1.50 CT 1.300 PX 2.100 PZ 2.200
Section 5
5-189
T his set of command s may be used to define the parameters for ge neration of UBC-type equ ivalent static lateral loads for seismic an alysis.
D escription
T he STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions and Y will be the direction of the gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward (all Y coordinates positive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. Do not use the SET Z UP command. Total lateral seismic force or base shear is automatically calculated by STAAD using the appropriate UBC equation(s).
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 14
V=
ZIC Rw
(1)
V=
ZIKCSW
(2)
Note: 1) All symbols and notations are per UBC 2) Base shear V may be calculated by STAAD using either the 1994 procedure (equation 1) or the 1985 procedure (equation 2). The user should use the appropriate "ubc-spec" (see General Format below) to instruct the program accordingly. STAAD utilizes the following procedure to generate the lateral seismic loads. 1. User provides seismic zone co-efficient and desired "ubc-spec" (1985 or 1994) through the DEFINE UBC LOAD command. 2. Program calculates the structure period T.
5-190
Section 5
3. Program calculates C from appropriate UBC equation(s) utilizing T. 4. Program calculates V from appropriate equation(s). W is obtained from the weight data (SELFWEIGHT, JOINT WEIG HT(s), etc.) provided by the user through the DEFINE UBC LOAD command. The weight data must be in the ord er shown. 5. The total lateral seismic load (base shear) is then distributed by the program among different levels of the structure per UBC procedures.
General form at: DEFINE UBC (ACCIDENTAL) LOAD ZONE f 1 ubc-spec
SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT joint-list WEIGHT w MEMBER WEIGHT UNI v1 v2 v3 mem-list CON v 4 v 5 ELEMENT WEIGHT p late-list FLOOR WEIGHT YRANGE (s e e Section 5.32.4 for input description ) PRESS p 1
f6 f7 f8)
Section 5
5-191
where, = seism ic zone coefficient (0.2, 0.3 etc.). Instead of using an f1 in teger value lik e 1, 2, 3 or 4, use the fractional value like 0.075, 0.15, 0.2, 0.3, 0.4, etc. = im porta nce factor f2 = numerical co-efficient R w for lateral load in X-direction f3 = numerical co-efficient R w for lateral load in Z-directions f4 = site co-effic ient for soil characteristics f5 = horizontal force factor f6 = im porta nce factor f7 = site characteristic period (Referred to as Ts in the UBC f8 code). Default value is 0.5. = Value of the term C t which appears in the eq uation of the f9 period of the structure per Method A. Its default value is 0.035. f 10 = Period of structure (in seconds) in the X- direc tion. f 11 = Period of structure (in seconds) in the Z- direc tion. w = joint weight associated with list UNI = specifies a uniformly distributed load with a value of v 1 starting at a distance of v 2 (from the start of the member) and ending at a distance of v 3 (from the start of the member). If v 2 and v 3 are omitted , the load is assumed to cover the entire leng th of the mem ber. CON = specifies a concent rated force with a value of v 4 applied at a distance of v 5 (from t he start of the member). If v 5 is omitted, the load is assum ed to act at the center of the member. = weight per unit area for the plates selected. Assumed to be p uniform over the entire plate. Element Weight is used if plate elements are part of the model, and uniform pressures on the plates are to be considered in weight calculation. Floor Weight is used if the pr essure is on a region bounded by beams, but the entity which constitues the region, such as a slab, is not def ined as part of the structural model. It is used in the same
5-192
Section 5
sort of situation in which one uses FLOOR LOADS (see sectio n 5.32.4 for details of the Floor Load in puut).
Notes
1) If the option ACCIDENTAL is used, the accidental torsion will be calculated per UBC spe cifications. The value of the accidental torsion is based on the "center of mass" for each level. The "center of mass" is calculated from the weight input (SELFWEIGHT, JOINT WEIG HTs, etc.) specified by the user. 2) In "ubc-spec" for 1985 code, spe cification of TS is optional. If TS is specified, resonance co-efficient S is determined from the building period T and user provided TS using UBC equations. If TS is not spe cified, the default value of 0.5 is assumed. 3) By providing either PX or PZ or both, you may override the period calculated by STAAD for Method B of the UBC Code. The user defined value will then be used instead of the one recommended by UBC per equation 28.5 of UBC 94. If you do not define PX or PZ, the period for Method B will be calculated by the program per equation 28.5. 4) Some of the items in the output for the UBC analysis are explained below.
CALC / USED PERIOD
The CALC PERIOD is the period calculated using the Rayleigh method (Method B as per UBC code). For UBC in the x-direction, the USED PERIOD is PX. For the UBC in the z-direction, the USED PERIOD is PZ. If PX and PZ are not provided, then the used period is the same as the calculated period for that direction. The used period is the one substituted into the critical equation of the UBC code to calculate the value of C. 5) In the analysis for UBC loads, all the supports of the structure have to be at the same level and have to be at the lowest elevation level of the structure.
Section 5
5-193
Example DEFINE UBC LOAD ZONE 0.2 I 1.0 RWX 9 RWZ 9 S 1.5 CT 0.032 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 17 TO 48 WEIGHT 2.5 49 TO 64 WEIGHT 1.25 LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 0.75 SELFWEIGHT Y -1.0 JOINT LOADS 17 TO 48 FY -2.5
5-194
Section 5
The purpose of this comman d is to define and generate static equivale nt seismic loads as per Colombian specifications using a static eq uivalent approach similar to those outlined by UBC. Depending on this definition, equi valent lateral loads will be generated in X or Z direction(s).
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 14
Description
The STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions. Y will be the direction of gravity loads. Thus, for a building m odel, the Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward ( all Y coordinates positive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. . Do not use the SET Z UP command.
Methodology :
Seismi c zone coefficient and pa rameter values are supplied by the user through the DEFINE COLOMBIAN LOAD command. Program calcula tes the natural period of building T u tilizing clause 1 628.2.2 of UB C 1994. Design spectral coefficient (Sa) is calculated utilizing T as, Sa = = = = Aa I (1.0 + 5.0 T) when, 0 T 0.3 sec 2.5 Aa I when, 0.3 < T 0.48 S in sec 1.2 Aa S I / T when, 0.48 S < T 2.4 S in sec Aa I / 2 when, 2.4 S < T
where, Aa S I = = = Seismic Risk factor (user input) Soil Site Coefficient (user input) Coefficient of Importance (user input)
Section 5
5-195
T otal lateral seismic load, Vs is distrib uted by the program among di fferent levels as, Fx = Cvx * Vs ( Wx * hxK ) / ni=1 ( Wx * hxK )
W here, = C vx Where, Wx hx K
= = = = =
Weight at the particular level Height of that particular level 1.0 when, T 0.5 sec 0.75 + 0.5 * T when, 0.5 < T 2.5 sec 2.0 when, 2.5 < T
General Format
DEFINE COLOMBIAN LOAD ZONE f1 ubc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w
[See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition]
5-196
Section 5
where i and f are the load case number and factor to multiply horizontal seismic load respectively.
Example DEFINE COLOMBIAN LOAD ZONE 0.38 I 1.0 S 1.5 JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 101 106 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 151 156 193 200 WEIGHT 720 LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) COLOMBIAN LOAD X
Section 5
5-197
The purpose of this command is to define and generate static equ iv alent seismic loads as p er Japanese specifications using a s tat ic equivalent approach similar to those outlined by UBC. D epending on t his definition, equivalent lateral loa ds will be g enerated in X or Z direction(s).
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 14
Description
The STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions and Y will be the direction of gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward ( all Y coordinates positive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. . D o not use the SET Z UP command.
Methodology :
Seismic zone coefficient and parameter values are supplied by the use r throu g h the DEFINE AIJ LOAD command. Program ca lculates the natural period of building T utilizing the following e quation T wh ere, h = = height of building ratio of steel part = h ( 0.02 + 0.01 )
Rt
= = =
1.0 when T < Tc 2 1 - 0.2 ( T/Tc - 1) when Tc T 2Tc 1.6 Tc / T when 2Tc T
5-198
Section 5
i is calcu l ated from the weight provided by the user in Defin e AIJ Load comm and. Seismic coe fficient of floor Ci is calculated using appropriate equations Ci Where, Z Co Ai = = = zone factor normal coefficient of shear force 1 + ( 1 / i - i ) 2T/ ( 1 + 3T ) = Z Rt Ai Co
The total la teral seismic load is distributed by the program among different lev els.
General F ormat
DEFINE AIJ LOAD ZONE f1 ubc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w
[See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition]
TC f4)
Where, f1, f2, f3and f4 are Zone factor, Ratio of Steel Part, Normal coe fficient of shear force and Value needed for calculation of Rt. G eneral format to provide Japanese Seismic load in any load case:
{X/Y/Z}
(f)
Where, i and f are load case number and factor to multiply horizontal seismic load respectively.
Section 5
5-199
Example DEFINE AIJ LOAD ZONE 0.8 I 0.0 CO 0.2 TC 0.6 JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 101 106 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 151 156 193 200 WEIGHT 720 LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X) AIJ LOAD X
5-200
Section 5
5.31.2.5 Definition of Lateral Seismic Load per Indian IS:1893 (Part 1) 2002 Code
Purpose
This feature enables one to generate seismic loads per the IS:189 3 specificati ons using a static equivalent approach.
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 14
Description
The seism ic load generator can be used to generate lateral loads in the X and Z directions only. Y i s the direction of gravity loads . This facility has not been developed for cases where the Z axis is set to be the vertical direction using the SET Z UP command.
Methodology
The design base shear is computed by STAAD in accordance with the IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002 equation 7.5.3.
V= A h. W where, A h =
Z I Sa . . 2 R g
Note: A ll symbols and notations in the above equation are as per IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002
STAAD utilizes the following procedure to generate the lateral seismic loads. 1. User p rovides seismic zone co-efficient and desire d "1893(Part 1)-2002 specs" through the DEFINE 1893 LOAD comm and. 2 . Program calculates the structure period (T). 3. Program calculates S a /g utilizing T. 4. Program calculates V from the above equation. W is obtained from the weight data provided by the user through the DEFINE 1893 LOAD command. [See section 5.31.2.2 for
Section 5
5-201
SELFWEIGHT, JOINT WEIGHT(s), etc. The weig ht data must be in the order shown.] 5 . The total lateral seismic load (base shear) is then distributed by the program among different levels of the structure per t he IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002 p rocedures.
General format: DEF INE 1893 LOAD ZONE f 1 1893-spec
SEL FWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT joint-list WEIGHT w [See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition] 1893-Spec= {RF f2, I f3, SS f4, (ST f5), DM f6, (PX f7) , (PZ f8), (DT f9)}
where, Zone f 1 = Seismic zone coefficient. Refer Table 2 of IS:1893(Part 1)-2002. = Response reduction factor. Refer Table 7 of IS: 1893 RF f 2 (Part 1)-2002 . = Importance factor depending upon the functional use I f3 of the structures, characterized by hazardous consequences of its failure, post-e arthquake functional needs, historical value, or economic importance. Refer Table 6 of IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002. = Rock or soil sites factor (=1 for hard soil, 2 for SS f 4 medium soil, 3 for soft soil). Depending on type of soil, average response acceleration coefficient S a /g is calculated corresponding to 5% damping. Refer Clause 6.4.5 of IS: 1893 (Part 1)-2002. = Optional value for type of structure (=1 for RC ST f 5 frame building, 2 for Steel frame building, 3 for all other buildings). If this parameter is mentioned the
5-202
Section 5
DM f 6
PX f 7
PZ f 8
DT f 9
program will calculate natural period as per Clause 7.6 of IS:1893(Part 1)-2002. = Damping ratio to obtain multiplying factor for calculating S a /g for different damping. If no damping is speci fied 5% damping (default value 0.05) will be considered corresponding to which multiplying factor is 1.0. Refer Table 3 of IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002. = Optional period of structure (in sec) in X direction. If this is define d this value will be used to calculate S a /g for gene ration of seismic load along X direction. = Optional period o f structure (in sec) in Z direction. If this is defined th is value will be used to calculate S a /g for generation of seismic load along Z direction. = Depth of foundation below ground level. It should be defined in current unit. If the depth of foundat ion is 30 m or below, the value of A h is taken a s half the value obtained. If the foundation is placed between the ground level and 30 m depth, this value is linearly interpolated between A h and 0.5 A h .
Note s
B y de fault STAAD calculates n atural periods of the structure in both X and Z directions respectively which are used in calculation for base shear. If, however, PX and PZ are mentioned the program will consider these values for calculation of average response a ccel eration coefficient. If inste ad of PX and PZ values ST is mentioned the program will calculate natural period depending upon the empirical expression given in IS: 1893 (Part 1)-2002.
Example
Section 5
5-203
5.31.2.6
The specifications of the IBC 2000 and 2003 codes for seismic analy sis of a building using a static equivalent approach have b een im ple mented as described in this se ction. The seismic load generator can be used to generate lateral load s in the X and Z directions only. Y is the direction of gravity lo ads. This facility has not been developed for cases where the Z axis is set to be the vertical direction using the SET Z UP command. The i mplementation details of the respective codes are as follows :
IB C 2000
On a broad basis, the rules described in section 1617.4 of the IBC 2000 c ode document have been implemented. These are described in pag es 359 thru 362 of that document. The specific section numbe r s , those which are implemented , and those which are not implemented, are as follows:
Implemented sections of IBC 2000 Omitted sections of IBC 2000
5-204
Section 5
IBC 2003
On a broad basis, the rules d escribed in section 1617.4 of the IBC 2003 code document have been implemented. This section dire cts the engineer to S ection 9.5.5 of the ASCE 7 code. The specific section numbers of ASCE 7-2002, those which are implemented, and those which are not implem ented, are shown in the table below. The associated pages of the A SCE 7-2002 code are 146 thru 149.
Implemented sections of IBC 2003 (ASCE 7-02) Omitt ed sections of IBC 2003 (ASCE 7-02)
9.5.5.2 9.5.5.2.1 9.5.5.3 9.5.5.3.1 9.5.5.3.2 9.5.5.4 9.5.5.5 Some parts of 9.5.5.5.2
Methodology
The design base shear is computed in accordance with the equatio n sho wn below.
Section 5
5-205
The seismic response coefficient, C s , is determined in accordance with the following equation:
Cs =
Cs =
Cs =
For an explanation of the terms used in the above equations, please refer to the IBC 2000 and ASCE 7-02 codes.
5-206
Section 5
There are 2 stages of command specification for generating lateral loads. This is the first stage and is activated through the DEF INE IBC 2000 or 2003 LOAD command.
General Format DEFINE IBC (
2000 ) 2003
(ACCIDENTAL) LOAD
SDS f1 ubc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w [See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition] ubc-spec = { SD1 f2 S1 f3 IE f4 RX f5 RZ f6 SCLASS f7 (CT f8) (PX f9) (PZ f10) }
where, f1 = Design spectral response acceleration at short periods. See equation 16-18, Section 1615.1.3 of IBC 2000 and equation 9.4.1.2.5-1 of ASCE7-02 f2 = Design spec tral response acceleration at 1-second period. See equation 16-19, Section 1615.1.3. of IBC 2000 and equation 9.4.1.2.5-2 of ASCE7-02 f3 = Mapped spectral acceleration for a 1-second period. See equation 16-17 of IBC 2000, and 9.4.1.2.4-2 of ASCE 7-02 f4 = Occupancy importance factor determined in accordance with Section 1616.2 of IBC 2000 and 2003, and section 9.1.4 (page 96) of ASCE 7-02 f5 = The response modification factor for lateral load along the X direction. See Table 1617.6 of IBC 2000 (pages 365-368) and Table 1617.6.2 of IBC 2003 (page 334-3 37). It is used in equations 16-35, 16-36 & 16-38 of IBC 2000
Section 5
5-207
f6 = The response modification factor for lateral load along the Z direction. See Table 1617.6 of IBC 2000 (pages 365368) and Table 1617.6.2 of IBC 2003 (page 334-337). It is used in equations 16-3 5, 1 6-3 6 & 16-38 o f IBC 2000. f7 = Site class as defined in Section 1615.1.1 of IB C 2000 (page 350) & 2003 (page 322). Enter 1 through 6 in place of A through F, see table below). f8 = O ptional CT value to calculate time period. See section 1617.4.2.1, equation 16-39 of IBC 2000 and se ction 9.5.5.3.2, equation 9.5.5.3.2-1 of ASCE 7-02. f9 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in X-direction to be used as fundamental period of the structure instead of the value derived from sectio n 1617.4.2 of IBC 2000, and section 9.5.5.3 of ASCE 7-02. f10 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in Z-direction to be u sed as fundamental period of the structure instead of the value derived from section 1617.4.2 of IB C 2000, and section 9.5.5.3 of ASC E 7-02. The Soil Profile Type parameter SCLASS c an take on values from 1 to 6. T hese are re lated to the values shown in Table 1615.1.1, S ite Class Definitions of the IBC 2000/2003 code in the following manner :
STAAD Value 1 2 3 4 5 6 IBC code value A B C D E F
5-208
Section 5
Example DEFINE IBC 2003 LOAD SDS 0.6 SD1 .36 S1 .3 I 1.0 RX 3 RZ 4 SCL 4 CT 0.032 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 101 106 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 151 156 193 200 WEIGHT 720
Steps to calcula te base shea r are as follow s: 1. Time Period o f the struc ture is cal cula ted ba sed on section 1617.4.2 of IBC 2000, and section 9.5.5.3 of ASCE 7-02. This is reported in the outpu t as Ta. 2. The period is also calcu lated in accordance with the Rayleigh method. Th is is reported in the o utput as T. 3. The user m ay override the Rayleigh based period by specifying a val ue for PX or PZ (Items f7 and f8) depending on the direction of the IBC load. 4. The governing Time Period of the structure is then chosen between the above-mentioned two periods, and the additi onal guidance provided in clause 1617.4.2 of IBC 2000, and se ction 9.5.5.3 of ASCE 7-02. The resulting value is reported as "Time Period used". 5. The Design Base Shear is calculated based on equation 16-34 of IBC 2000 and equation 9.5.5.2-1 of ASCE 7-02. It is then d istributed at each floor using the rules of clause 1617.4 .3, equations 16-41 and 16-42 of IBC 2000, and, clause 9.5.5.4, equations 9.5.5.4-1 & 9.5.5 .4-2 of ASCE 7-02. 6. If the ACCIDENTAL option is specified, the program c alculates the additional torsional moment. The lever arm for c alculating the torsional moment is obtained as 5% of the building dimension at each floor level perpendicular to the d irection of the IBC load (clause 1617.4.4.4 of IBC 2000 and , 9 .5.5.5.2 of ASCE 7-02). At each joint where a weight is located, the lateral seismic force acting at that joint is
Section 5
5-209
multiplied by this lever arm to obtain the torsional moment at that j oint. The following exam ple shows the co mmands required to enable the program to generate the lateral loads. Users may refer to Secti on 5.32.12 of the Technical Reference M anual for this information.
Example
LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) IBC LOAD X 0.75 LOAD 2 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN Z DIRECTION ) IBC LOAD Z 0.75
The Examples manual contains examples illustrating load generation involving IBC and U BC load types.
5-210
Section 5
The purpose of this command is to define and generate static equivalent seismic loads as per MANUAL DE DISEO POR SISMO - SEISMIC DESIGN HANDBOOK COMISION FEDERA L DE ELECTRICIDAD - ELECTRIC POWER FEDERAL COMISSION - October 1993 (Chapters 3.1, 3.2, 3.3 and 3.4) specifications. Depending on this definition, equivalen t lateral loads will be generated in X or Z direction(s).
Description
The STAAD s eismic load generator assumes that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions. Y will be the direction of gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, the Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward ( all Y coordina tes positive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. . Do not use the SET Z UP command.
Methodology :
Seismic zone coe fficient and parameter values are supplied by the user through the DEFINE CFE LOAD command. P rogram calculates the natural period of building T utilizing Ral eigh -Qu otient method. If time pe riod is provided in the input file, that is used in stead of calculated period. c = Seismic coefficient is extracted from table 3.1 a 0 , T a , T b , and r are obtained f or m table 3.1 The acceleration a is calculated according to the following: a= a 0 + (c-a 0 ) x T/T a a= c a= c (Tb/T) r if if if T<T a Ta T Tb T >T b
Section 5
5-211
The du ctili ty reduction factor Q is calculated according to section 3.2.5. Q= Q Q= 1 + (T/T a ) (Q-1) If not regular Q = Q x 0.8 If the period T s of the soil is known and the soil type II or I II T a and T b will be modified according to section 3.3.2. Lateral loads for each direction are calculated for: T Tb Eq. 4.5. Section 3.4.4.2 if if T Ta T < Ts
P =W h
n n
(W
n =1 n N n =1 n
) a
n
(W h )
Q'
T > Tb Eq. 4.6/7/8. Section 3.4.4.2 Pn = Wn a / Q (K1 hi+K2 hi) Being: K1 = q { 1 r (1-q)} Wi / (Wi/hi) K2 = 1.5 r q (1-q) Wi / (Wi/hi) q = (Tb/T) r The base shear are distributed proportionally to the height if T Tb or with the quadratic equation mentioned if T > Tb. The distributed base shears are subsequently applied as lateral loa ds on the structure.
5-212
Section 5
General Format
DEFINE CFE LOAD ZONE f1 cfe-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w
[See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition]
cfe-spec =
w here,
f1 = Zone number specified in number such as 1, 2, 3 or 4 f2 = seismic behavior factor of the structure along X direction as a parameter according 3.2.4. f3 = seismic behavior factor of the structure along Z direction as a parameter according 3.2.4. f4 = Group of structure entered as A or B f5 = Soil type entered as 1 or 2 or 3 REGULAR optional parameter is entered to consider the structure as a regular structure. By default, all structures are considered as irregular. f6 = site characteristic period f7 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in X-direction to be used as fundamental period of the structure instead of the value calculated by the program using Raleigh-Quotient method f8 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in Z-direction to be used as fundamental period of the structure instead of the value calculated by the program using Raleigh-Quotient method
Section 5
5-213
General format to provide RPA Seismic load in any load case: LOAD i CFE LOAD {X/Y/Z } (f)
where i and f are the load case number and factor to multiply horizo ntal seismic load respectiv ely.
Exam ples UNIT KGS METER DEFINE CFE LOAD ZONE 2 QX .5 QZ 0.9 STYP 2 GROUP B TS 0.2 SELFWEIGHT MEMBER WEIGHT 1 TO 36 41 TO 50 UNI 30 0 JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 101 106 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 FLOOR WEIGHT YRA 11.8 12.2 FLOAD 400 XRA -1 11 ZRA -1 21 LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) CFE LOAD X 1.0 LOAD 2 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN -Z DIRECTION ) CFE LOAD Z -1.0
5-214
Section 5
The purpose of this command is to define and generate static equivalent seismic loads as per Code of the Mxico Federal Distric t (Reglam ento de Construcciones del Distrito Federal de Mxico ) and Complementary Technic al Standards for Seismic Design (y Normas Tcnicas Complementarias (NTC) para Diseo por Sismo -Nov. 1987) (Chapters 8.1 8.2 8.6 and 8.8) specifications. Depending on this definition, equivalent lateral loads will be generated in X or Z direction(s).
Description
T he STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral loads will be exerted in X and Z directions. Y will be the direction of gr avity loads. Thus, for a building mode l, the Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward ( all Y coordinates positive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. . D o not use the SET Z UP command.
Methodology :
T he design base shear is computed in accordance wit h Sections 8.1 or 8.2 of the NTC as de cided by the user.
A.
Base Shear is given as Vo / Wo = c / Q c: obtained by the program from the following table
SeismicCoeficient c Z-I Z-II not shadowed ZIII y Z_II shadowed GROUP A 0.24 0.48 0.60 GROUP B 0.16 0.32 0.40
Section 5
5-215
B.
Time Period T of the structure is: calculated by the program based on using Raleigh quotient technique. The user may override the period that the program calculates by specifying the se in the input a and Q are calculated according to the sections 3 and 4 of the NTC, that is to say: a = (1+3T/Ta)c/4 a=c a=q*c where, q= (Tb/T) r Q= Q Q= 1 + (T/Ta) (Q-1) If not regular Q = Q x 0.8 Ta, Tb and r are taken from table 3.1. if if T Ta T < Ta if if if T<Ta Ta T Tb T>Tb
5-216
Section 5
Table 3.1 Values of Ta, Tb and r ZONE Ta Tb I 0.2 0.6 II not shaded 0.3 1.5 III y II shaded 0.6 3.9
a shall not be less than c/4 Vo for each direction is calculated V o = Wo a/Q if T Tb T > Tb
K2 = 1.5 r q (1-q) Wi/( Wi/hi) Wi and hi the weight and the height of the i th mass over the soil or e mbedment level. The base shear are distributed proportionally to the height if T Tb or with the cuadratic equation m entioned if T > Tb. The distributed base shears are subsequently applied as lateral loads on the structure.
Section 5
5-217
General Format
DEFINE NTC LOAD ZONE f1 ntc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w
[See Section 5.31.2.2 for complete weight input definition]
ntc-spec =
where,
f1 = Zone number specified in number such as 1, 2, 3 or 4 f2 = seismic behavior factor of the structure along X direction as a parameter according 3.2.4. f3 = seismic behavior factor of the structure along Z direction as a parameter according 3.2.4. f4 = Group of structure entered as A or B REGULAR optional parameter is entered to consider the structure as a regular structure. By default, all structures are considered as irregular. SHADOWED optional parameter is used to define the shaded zone II as the site of the structure. By default regular zone II is used. REDUCE optional parameter allows to reduce the seismic factors as described above. Otherwise the following formula is used to calculate base shear,
V=
c N Q ' n =1 W n
5-218
Section 5
f6 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in X-direction to be used as fundamental period of the structure instead of the value calculated by the p rogram using Raleigh-Quotient method f7 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in Z-direct ion to be used as fundamental period of the s tructure instead of the value calculated by the program using R aleigh-Quotient method General format to provide NTC Seism ic load in any load case: LOAD i NTC LOAD {X/Y/Z} (f)
where i and f are the load case number and factor to multiply h orizontal seismic load respectively.
E xamples UNIT KGS METER DEFINE NTC LOAD ZONE 2 QX .5 QZ 0.9 GROUP B SELFWEIGHT ELEMENT WEIGHT 1577 TO 1619 PRESSURE 275 LOAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) NTC LOAD X 1.0 LOAD 2 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN Z DIRECTION ) NTC LOAD Z 1.0
Section 5
5-219
The purpose of this command is to define and generate static equivalent seismic loads as per RPA specifications using a static equivalent approach similar to those outlined by RPA. Depending on this definition, equivalent lateral loads will be generated in X or Z direction( s).
Description
The STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral lo ads will be exerted in X and Z directions. Y will be the direction of gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, the Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and poin t upward (all Y coordinates p ositive). The user is advised to set up the model accordingly. Do not use the SET Z UP command.
Methodology
T he design base shear is computed in accordance with section 4.2.3 of the RPA 99 code. The prim ary equation, namely 4-1, as shown b elow , is chec ked.
V=
where W = tota l weight on the structure A = zone coefficient D = average dynamic amplification factor R = lateral R factor Q = structural quality factor Sei smic zon e coefficient and parameter values are supplied by the user through the DEFINE RPA LOAD command.
5-220
Section 5
Program calculates the natural period of building T utilizing clause 4.2. 4 of RPA 99. D esign spectral coefficient (D) is calculated utilizing T as,
D = 2.5 when, 0 T T2 = 2.5 . (T2 /T) 2/3 when, T2 < T 3.0 sec = 2.5 . (T2 /3) 2/3 . (3/T) 5/3 when, T > 3.0 sec
whe re
= factor of damping adjustment .. Eq. 4.3
T 2 = sp ecific period .Table 4.7 Total l ateral seismic load, V is distributed by the program among differe nt levels. Th ere are 2 stages of command specification for generating lateral loads. This is the first stage and is activated through the DEFINE RPA L OAD command.
General Format DEFINE RPA LOAD A f1 rpa-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT Joint-list WEIGHT w
Section 5
5-221
rpa-spec =
where f1 = Seismic zone coefficient. Instead of using an integer value like 1, 2, 3 or 4 , use the fractional value like 0.08, 0.15, 0.2, 0.3, 0.05, etc. f2 = Importance factor f3 = Coefficient R for lateral load in X direction table 4.3 f4 = Coefficient R for lateral load in Z direction table 4.3 f5 = Soil Profile Type f6 = Coefficien t from table 4.6 of RPA 99 f7 = Damping factor f8 = Optional Period of structure (in sec) in X direction f9 = Optional P eriod of structu re (in sec) in Z direction General format to provide RPA Se ismic load in any load case: LOAD i RPA LOAD
{X/Y/Z} (f)
w here, I and f a re the l oad case num ber and factor to multiply horizontal seismic load res pectively .
5-222
Section 5
Example DEFINE RPA LOAD A 0.15 Q 1.36 STYP 2 RX 3 RZ 4 CT 0.0032 CRDAMP 30 PX .027 PZ 0.025 JOINT WEIGHT 51 56 93 100 WEIGHT 1440 1 01 1 0 6 143 150 WEIGHT 1000 151 156 193 200 WEIGHT 720 L OAD 1 ( SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIRECTION ) RPA LOAD X 1.0
Section 5
5-223
This set of command s may be used to define the parameters for generation of equivalent static lateral loads for seism ic analysis p er National Building Code(NRC/CNRC) of Canad a- 1995 edition.
Description
The STAAD seismic load generator assumes that the lateral loa ds will be exerted in X and Z directions and Y will be the direction o f the gravity loads. Thus, for a building model, Y axis will be perpendicular to the floors and point upward (all Y coordinates positive). The user is a dvised to set up the model accordingly. Do not use the SET Z UP command. The minimum lateral seismic force or base shear (V) is automatic ally calculated by STAAD using the appropriate equation(s).
See Sections 1.17.2, 5.32.12 and Example Problem Examp14_NRC.std
V=
Where V e , the equivalent lateral seismic force representing elastic response is given by
Ve =
Where, v = Zonal velocity ratio per appendix C S = Seismic Response Factor per table 4.9.1.A I = Seismic importance factor per sentence 10 sectio n 4.1.9.1 F = Foundation factor conforming to Table 4.9.1.C and senten ce 11 section 4.1.9.1 W = To tal load lumped as weight per sentence 2 section 4.1.9.1
5-224
Section 5
R = For ce modification factor conforming to Table 4.9.1.B that re flects the capability of a structure to dissipate energy through inelastic behaviour. STAAD utilizes the following procedure to generate the lateral seismic loads. 1. Use r provides seismic zone co-efficient and desired "nrc-spec" (19 95) through the DEFINE NRC LOAD command. 2. Pro gram calculates the fundamental period(T) of the structure by (a) finding out whether the structure being analysed is a moment resisting frame made primarily of steel or of concrete or it is a structure of any other type. Alternatively, the software uses the optional param eter CT if provided. The calculation is done per sentence 7(a) & 7(b) of section 4.1.9.1. (b) using the Rayleigh method or using the optional parameters PX , PZ if prov ided. The stipulations of sentence 7(c) of section 4.1.9.1 are also considered while calculating. (c) taking the conservative value of T between those calculated by methods (a) and (b) above. 3. Program finds out th e value of Seismic Response Factor(S) per table 4.9.1.A utilizing the values of T as calculated above and the valu es of ZA & ZV input by the user. 4. Program calculate s V per sentence 4 section 4.1.9.1. W is obtained from the we ight data (SELFWEIGHT, JOINT WEIGHT(s), e tc.) provided by the user through the DEFINE NRC LOAD com mand. The weight data must be in the order shown. 5. The total lateral seismic load (base shear) is then distributed by the program among different levels of the structure per applicable NRC guidelines like sentence 13(a) section 4.1.9.1. There are 2 stages of command specification for generating lateral loads. This is the first stage and is activated through the DEFINE NRC LOAD command.
Section 5
5-225
General format: DEFINE NRC LOAD *nrc-spec SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT joint-list WEIGHT w MEMBER WEIGHT UNI v1 v2 v3 mem- list CON v 4 v 5 E LE MENT WEIGHT plate-list FLOOR WEIGHT YR ANGE ( see Section 5.32.4 for input description) where *nrc-spec = |v f1 | ZA f2 ZV f3 RX f4 * RZ f5 I f6 f7 F f8) (CT f9) (P X f 10 ) (PZ PRESS p 1
5-226
Section 5
where, f1 f2 f3 f4 = Zonal velocity ratio per Appendix C = Factor fo r acceleration related seismic zone per Appendix C = Factor for velocity related seismic zone per Appendix C = Force modification factor along X-d irection that reflects the capability of a structure to dissipate energy through inelast ic behaviour. Please refer Table 4.1.9.1B f5 = Force mod ification factor along Z-direction that reflects the capability of a structure to dissipate energy through inelastic behavi our. Please refer Table 4.1.9.1B f6 = Seismic importance factor per sentence 10 section 4.1.9.1 f7 = Foundati on factor conforming to Table 4.1.9.1C and sentence 1 1 section 4.1.9.1 f8 = Factor to be use d to calculate the fundamental period of structure .This is an optional parameter. f 10 = Period of structure (in seconds) in the X- direction. This is an optional parameter. f 11 = Period of st ructure (in seconds) in the Z- direction. This is an optional parameter. w = joint weight associated with list
UNI = specifies a u niformly distributed load with a value of v 1 starting at a distance of v 2 (from the s tart of the member) and ending at a distance of v 3 (from the start of the member). If v 2 and v 3 are omitted, the load is assumed to cover the entire length of the member. CON = specifie s a concentrated force with a value of v 4 applied at a distan ce of v 5 (from the start of the member). If v 5 is omitted, the load is assumed to act at the center of the member. p = weight per unit area for t he plates selected. Assumed to be uniform o ver the entire plate. E lement Weight is used if plate elements are part of the model, and uniform pressures on the plates a re to be considered in weight calculation.
Section 5
5-227
Floor Weight is used if the pressure is on a region bounded by beams, but th e entity which constitutes the region, such as a slab, is not defined as part of the structural model. It is used in the same sort of situation in which o ne uses FLOOR LOADS (see section 5.32.4 of STAAD T echnical Reference Manual for details of the Floor Load inpuut). T he weights have to be input in the order shown.
G eneration of NRC Load
The load so defined as above is applied on the st ructure in the NRC loadcases. These loadcases have to be the first loadcases in the input file. Built-in a lgorithms will automatically distribute the base shear among app ro priate levels and the roof per the relevant code specification s. The following general format should be used to generate loads in a particular directio n.
LOAD i NRC LOAD {Dir}(f1)
Where Dir = The direc tion in which the NRC load is generated X,Y or Z. i = load case num ber f1 = factor to be use d to multiply the NRC Load (default = 1.0). May be negative.
Notes
1) By providing either PX or PZ or both, y ou may override the period calculate d by STAAD using Rayleigh method. If you do not define PX or PZ, the period for Method 2(b) above will be calculated by the program using Rayleigh method and the stipulations of sent ence 7(c) of section 4.1.9.1 2) Some of the items in the output for the NRC analysis are explained below. T a = Time period calculated per sentence 7(a) or 7(b) of section 4.1.9.1
5-228
Section 5
The CALC PERIOD is the period calcula ted using the Rayleigh method. For NRC in the x-direction, the USED PERIOD is PX. For the NRC in the z-direction, the USE D PERIOD is PZ. If PX and PZ are not provided, then the used period is the same as the calculated period for that direction. The used period is the one utilized to find out the value of S. 3) In the analysis for NRC loads, all the supports of the structure have to be at the same level and have to be at the lowest elevation level of the structure.
Example DEFINE NRC LOAD V 0.2 ZA 4 ZV 4 RX 4 RZ 4 I 1.3 F 1.3 CT 0.35 PX 2 PZ 2 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 17 TO 48 WEIGHT 7 49 TO 64 WEIGHT 3.5 LOAD 1 NRC LOAD X 0.75 SELFWEIGHT Y -1.0 JOINT LOADS 17 TO 48 FY -2.5
Section 5
5-229
Input: STAAD SPACE EXAMPLE PROBLEM FOR CANADIAN NRC LOADING UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0 4 10.5 0 0 REPEAT 3 0 0 3.5 REPEAT ALL 3 0 3.5 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 101 17 18 103 104 21 22 106 107 25 26 109 110 29 30 112 REPEAT ALL 2 12 16 201 17 21 204 205 21 25 208 209 25 29 212 REPEAT ALL 2 12 16 301 1 17 348 MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 101 TO 136 201 TO 236 PRIS YD 0.4 ZD 0.3 301 TO 348 TABLE ST W460X52 DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC CONCRETE E 2.17184e+007 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 23.5615 ALPHA 5.5e-006 DAMP 0.05 ISOTROPIC STEEL E 1.99947e+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8191 ALPHA 6.5e-006
5-230
Section 5
DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL CONCRETE MEMB 101 TO 136 201 TO 236 MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 301 TO 348 SUPPORTS 1 TO 16 FIXED DEFINE NRC LOAD V 0.2 ZA 4 ZV 4 RX 4 RZ 4 I 1.3 F 1.3 CT 0.35 PX 2 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 17 TO 48 WEIGHT 7 49 TO 64 WEIGHT 3.5 LOAD 1 EARTHQUAKE ALONG X NRC LOAD X 1.0 PDELTA ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA CHANGE LOAD 2 EARTHQUAKE ALONG Z NRC LOAD Z 1.0 PDELTA ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA CHANGE LOAD 3 VERTICAL LOADS SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 17 TO 48 FY -7 49 TO 64 FY -3.5 LOAD 4 EQ IN X + GRAVITY REPEAT LOAD 1 1.0 3 1.0 LOAD 5 EQ IN Z + GRAVITY REPEAT LOAD
Section 5
5-231
2 1.0 3 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST ALL PRINT SUPPORT REACTION FINISH Output: -
1. STAAD SPACE EXAMPLE PROBLEM FOR CANADIAN NRC LOADING 3. UNIT METER KN 4. JOINT COORDINATES 5. 1 0 0 0 4 10.5 0 0 6. REPEAT 3 0 0 3.5 7. REPEAT ALL 3 0 3.5 0 9. MEMBER INCIDENCES 10. 101 17 18 103 11. 104 21 22 106 12. 107 25 26 109 13. 110 29 30 112 14. REPEAT ALL 2 12 16 15. 201 17 21 204 16. 205 21 25 208 17. 209 25 29 212 18. REPEAT ALL 2 12 16 19. 301 1 17 348 21. MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 22. 101 TO 136 201 TO 236 PRIS YD 0.4 ZD 0.3 23. 301 TO 348 TABLE ST W460X52 25. DEFINE MATERIAL START 26. ISOTROPIC CONCRETE 27. E 2.17184E+007 28. POISSON 0.17 29. DENSITY 23.5615 30. ALPHA 5.5E-006 31. DAMP 0.05 32. ISOTROPIC STEEL 33. E 1.99947E+008 34. POISSON 0.3 35. DENSITY 76.8191 36. ALPHA 6.5E-006 37. DAMP 0.03 38. END DEFINE MATERIAL 40. CONSTANTS 41. MATERIAL CONCRETE MEMB 101 TO 136 201 TO 236 42. MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 301 TO 348 44. SUPPORTS 45. 1 TO 16 FIXED 47. DEFINE NRC LOAD 48. V 0.2 ZA 4 ZV 4 RX 4 RZ 4 I 1.3 F 1.3 CT 0.35 PX 2 49. SELFWEIGHT 50. JOINT WEIGHT 51. 17 TO 48 WEIGHT 7 52. 49 TO 64 WEIGHT 3.5 54. LOAD 1 EARTHQUAKE ALONG X 55. NRC LOAD X 1.0 56. PDELTA ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA
5-232
Section 5
P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 64/ 120/ ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 16/ 14/ 78 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 23 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.4/ 38909.8 MB 16 288
LOADING 1 EARTHQUAKE ALONG X ----------***************************************************************************** * * * EQUIV. SEISMIC LOADS AS PER NATIONAL BUILDING CODE OF CANADA 1995 ALONG X * * CT = 0.350 Ta = 2.042 SEC. Tc = 2.000 SEC. * * T USED = 2.000 SEC. SEISMIC RESPONSE FACTOR = 1.060660 * * EQUIVALENT LATERIAL SEISMIC FORCE (ELASTIC RESPONSE) * * = 0.36 X 1078.260 = 386.559 KN * * DESIGN BASE SHEAR = 1.000 ( 386.559 / 4.000) x 0.6 * * = 57.984 KN * * * ***************************************************************************** JOINT ----17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 LATERAL LOAD (KN ------0.453 0.573 0.573 0.453 0.573 0.693 0.693 0.573 0.573 0.693 0.693 0.573 0.453 0.573 0.573 0.453 ----------= 9.163 0.906 1.145 1.145 0.906 1.145 1.385 1.385 1.145 1.145 1.385 1.385 1.145 0.906 1.145 1.145 0.906 TORSIONAL LOAD 1 MOMENT (KN -METE) FACTOR 1.000 --------0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL 3.500 METE 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL
) MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX TOTAL
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX
MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
----------TOTAL = 18.326
7.000 METE
Section 5
5-233
49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
1.416 1.906 1.906 1.416 1.906 2.396 2.396 1.906 1.906 2.396 2.396 1.906 1.416 1.906 1.906 1.416 ----------TOTAL = 30.496
FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX FX
MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL
10.500 METE
************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 57. CHANGE 59. LOAD 2 EARTHQUAKE ALONG Z 60. NRC LOAD Z 1.0 61. PDELTA ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA LOADING 2 ----------EARTHQUAKE ALONG Z
***************************************************************************** * * * EQUIV. SEISMIC LOADS AS PER NATIONAL BUILDING CODE OF CANADA 1995 ALONG Z * * CT = 0.350 Ta = 2.042 SEC. Tc = 1.124 SEC. * * T USED = 1.124 SEC. SEISMIC RESPONSE FACTOR = 1.414889 * * EQUIVALENT LATERIAL SEISMIC FORCE (ELASTIC RESPONSE) * * = 0.48 X 1078.260 = 515.659 KN * * DESIGN BASE SHEAR = 1.000 ( 515.659 / 4.000) x 0.6 * * = 77.349 KN * * * ***************************************************************************** JOINT LATERAL LOAD (KN 0.647 0.818 0.818 0.647 0.818 0.990 0.990 0.818 0.818 0.990 0.990 0.818 0.647 0.818 0.818 0.647 ----------TOTAL = 13.094 FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ 1.294 1.637 1.637 1.294 1.637 1.980 1.980 1.637 FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ TORSIONAL MOMENT (KN LOAD -METE) FACTOR 2 1.000
) MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000
3.500 METE
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
5-234
Section 5
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 1.637 1.980 1.980 1.637 1.294 1.637 1.637 1.294 ----------TOTAL = 26.189 1.767 2.379 2.379 1.767 2.379 2.991 2.991 2.379 2.379 2.991 2.991 2.379 1.767 2.379 2.379 1.767 ----------TOTAL = 38.065 FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ FZ MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 ----------0.000 AT LEVEL
7.000 METE
49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY MY
10.500 METE
************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 62. 64. 65. 66. 67. 68. 70. 71. 72. 74. 75. 76. 78. 79. 80. CHANGE LOAD 3 VERTICAL LOADS SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 17 TO 48 FY -7 49 TO 64 FY -3.5 LOAD 4 EQ IN X + GRAVITY REPEAT LOAD 1 1.0 3 1.0 LOAD 5 EQ IN Z + GRAVITY REPEAT LOAD 2 1.0 3 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST ALL PRINT SUPPORT REACTION METE STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE
SUPPORT REACTIONS -UNIT KN ----------------JOINT 1 LOAD 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 FORCE-X -3.13 0.00 0.45 -2.68 0.45 -4.01 0.00 0.01 -4.00 0.01 -4.01 0.00 -0.01 -4.03 -0.01 -3.13 0.00 -0.45 -3.58 -0.45
FORCE-Y -8.55 -13.75 50.23 41.67 36.47 0.76 -13.78 64.94 65.69 51.16 -0.76 -13.78 64.94 64.18 51.16 8.55 -13.75 50.23 58.78 36.47
FORCE-Z 0.00 -4.80 0.06 0.06 -4.69 0.00 -4.81 0.06 0.06 -4.70 0.00 -4.81 0.06 0.06 -4.70 0.00 -4.80 0.06 0.06 -4.69
MOM-X 0.00 -8.44 0.07 0.07 -8.37 0.00 -8.46 0.07 0.07 -8.39 0.00 -8.46 0.07 0.07 -8.39 0.00 -8.44 0.07 0.07 -8.37
MOM-Y 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
MOM Z 7.30 0.00 -0.49 6.81 -0.49 8.25 0.00 -0.02 8.23 -0.02 8.25 0.00 0.02 8.27 0.02 7.30 0.00 0.49 7.79 0.49
Section 5
5-235
1 2 3 4 5
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5 1 2 3 4 5
-4.13 0.00 0.01 -4.12 0.01 -4.13 0.00 -0.01 -4.14 -0.01 -3.22 0.00 -0.45 -3.68 -0.45 -3.23 0.00 0.45 -2.77 0.45 -4.13 0.00 0.01 -4.12 0.01 -4.13 0.00 -0.01 -4.14 -0.01 -3.22 0.00 -0.45 -3.68 -0.45 -3.13 0.00 0.45 -2.68 0.45 -4.01 0.00 0.01 -4.00 0.01 -4.01 0.00 -0.01 -4.03 -0.01 -3.13 0.00 -0.45 -3.58 -0.45
0.77 6.15 84.55 85.33 90.71 -0.77 6.15 84.55 83.78 90.71 8.83 6.14 69.85 78.68 75.99 -8.83 -6.14 69.85 61.02 63.70 0.77 -6.15 84.55 85.33 78.40 -0.77 -6.15 84.55 83.78 78.40 8.83 -6.14 69.85 78.68 63.70 -8.55 13.75 50.23 41.67 63.98 0.76 13.78 64.94 65.69 78.72 -0.76 13.78 64.94 64.18 78.72 8.55 13.75 50.23 58.78 63.98
0.00 -4.90 -0.01 -0.01 -4.93 0.00 -4.90 -0.01 -0.01 -4.93 0.00 -4.89 -0.01 -0.01 -4.92 0.00 -4.94 0.01 0.01 -4.90 0.00 -4.95 0.01 0.01 -4.91 0.00 -4.95 0.01 0.01 -4.91 0.00 -4.94 0.01 0.01 -4.90 0.00 -4.69 -0.06 -0.06 -4.81 0.00 -4.70 -0.06 -0.06 -4.82 0.00 -4.70 -0.06 -0.06 -4.82 0.00 -4.69 -0.06 -0.06 -4.81
0.00 -8.65 -0.01 -0.01 -8.66 0.00 -8.65 -0.01 -0.01 -8.66 0.00 -8.63 -0.01 -0.01 -8.64 0.00 -8.63 0.01 0.01 -8.62 0.00 -8.65 0.01 0.01 -8.64 0.00 -8.65 0.01 0.01 -8.64 0.00 -8.63 0.01 0.01 -8.62 0.00 -8.44 -0.07 -0.07 -8.51 0.00 -8.46 -0.07 -0.07 -8.52 0.00 -8.46 -0.07 -0.07 -8.52 0.00 -8.44 -0.07 -0.07 -8.51
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
8.49 0.00 -0.02 8.47 -0.02 8.49 0.00 0.02 8.51 0.02 7.52 0.00 0.49 8.01 0.49 7.52 0.00 -0.49 7.03 -0.49 8.49 0.00 -0.02 8.47 -0.02 8.49 0.00 0.02 8.51 0.02 7.52 0.00 0.49 8.01 0.49 7.30 0.00 -0.49 6.81 -0.49 8.25 0.00 -0.02 8.23 -0.02 8.25 0.00 0.02 8.27 0.02 7.30 0.00 0.49 7.79 0.49
81. FINISH
5-236
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to define some of the parameters for generation of wind loads on the structure. See section 5.32.12, Generation of Wind Loads, for the definition of wind direction and the possible surfaces to be loaded. Section 1.17.3 of this manual describes the two types of structures on which t his load generation can be performed.
See Section 1.17.3, 5.32.12 and Examples manual problem no. 15
The wind load generator can be used to generate lateral loads in the X a nd Z directions only. Y mu st be the vertical direction. Th is facility has not been developed for cases where the Z axis is set to be the vertical direction using the SET Z UP command.
Genera l Format: DEF INE WIND LOAD T YP E j INTENSITY p 1 p 2 p 3 ... p n HEIGHT h 1 h 2 h 3 ... h n EXPOSURE
where, j= wind load system type number (integer) p 1 ,p 2 ,p 3 ...p n wind intensit ies (pressures) in force/area. Up to 100 differ ent in ten sities can be defined in the input file per ty pe. h 1 ,h 2 ,h 3 ...h n corresponding heights in global vertical direction up to which the above intensities occur.
Section 5
5-237
e 1 ,e 2 ,e 3 ...e m exposure factors. A value of 1.0 means that the w ind force may be applied on the full influence ar ea as sociated with the joint(s) if they are also exposed to the wind load direction. Limit: 9 9 factors. joint-list Jo int list associated with Exposure Factor (joint n umbers or TO or BY) or enter only a group n ame. g lobal coordinate values to specify Y vertical rang e f 1 and f 2 fo r Exposure Factor. If the command EXPOSURE is not specified or if a joint is no t listed in an Exposure, the exposure factor for those joints is chosen as 1.0.
Description
All loads and heights are in current unit system. In the list of intensities, the first value of intensity acts from the ground level up to the first h eight. The second intensity (p 2 ) acts in the Globa l vertical directio n between the first two heights (h 1 and h 2 ) and so on. The program assumes that the ground level has the lowest global vertical c oordinate of any joint entered for the structure.
See Section 1.17.3 and 5.32.12
Only exposed surfaces bounded by members (not by plates or solids) will be used. The joint influence areas are computed based on surface mem ber selection data entered in section 5.32.12 and based on the wi nd direction for a load case. Only joints actually exposed to the w ind and connected to members will be loaded. The individual bounded areas must be planar surfaces, to a close tolerance, or the y will not be loaded. Exposure factor (e) is the fraction of the influence area associat ed with the joint(s ) on which the load may act if it is also exposed to the wind load. T otal load on a particular joint is calculated as follows. Joint load = (Exposure Factor) X (Influence Area) X (Wind Intensity) The exposure fa ctor may be specified by a joint-list or by giving a vertical range w ithin which all joints will have the same exposur e. If an exposure f actor is not entered or not specified for a joint,
5-238
Section 5
then it defaults to 1.0 for those joints; in which case the entire influence area a ssociated with the jo int(s) will be considered. For load genera tion on a closed type structure defined as a PL ANE FRAME, influe nce area for each joint is calculated considering unit width perp endicular to the plane of the structure. The user can accommoda te the actual width by incorporating it in the Exposure Facto r as follows. Exposure Factor (User Specified) = (Fraction of influence area) X (influence width for joint)
Notes
All intensities, heights and ranges must be provided in the current unit system. If necessary, th e INTENSITY, EXPOSURE, command lines can be continued on to additional lines by ending all but last line with a space a nd hyph en (-). Use up to 11 lines for a command.
Example
UNIT FEET DEFINE WIND LOAD TYPE 1 INTENSITY 0.1 0.15 HEIGHT 12 24 EXPOSURE 0.90 YRANGE 11 13 EXPOSURE 0.85 JOINT 17 20 22 LOAD 1 WIND LOAD IN X-DIRECTION WIND LOAD X 1.2 TYPE 1
For additional examples, see section 5.32.12 and example 15 in the Examples manual.
Section 5
5-239
The Int ensity line can be continued in up to 12 lines. So the follow ing
INT 0.00 8 0.009 0.009 0.009 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.011 0.011 0.012 0.012 0.012 HEIG 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 120
could b e split as
INT 0.00 8 0.009 0.009 0.009 0.01 0.01 0.01 0.011 0.011 0.012 0.012 0.012 HEIG 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 120
or
INT 0.00 8 0.009 0.009 0.009 0.01 0.010.01 0.0 11 0.011 0.012 0.012 0.012 HEIG 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 120
etc.
5-240
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to define parameters for Time H istory loading on the structu re.
G eneral format: DEF INE TIME HISTORY (DT x)
TYPE i
(SCALE f7 ) (SAVE)
SINE COSINE
Section 5
5-241
Sc ale f 7 =
Sa ve
t1 p1 t2 p2
solution time step used in the step-b y-step integration o f the uncoupled equations. Values smaller than 0.00001 will be reset to the default DT value of 0 .0013888 seconds. type number of time varying load (integer). Up to 136 ty pes may be provided. ACCELERATION indicates that the time varying load type is a grou nd motion. FORCE or MOMENT indicates that it is a time varying force or moment. This number should be sequential. The s cale factor option multiplies all forces, accele rations, and amplitudes entered, read or generated within this Type. Primarily u sed to conv ert acceleration in gs to current un its (9.80665, 386.0 8858, etc.). Default is 1.0. The save option results in the creation of two files (input file name with "Tim" and Frc extensions) containing the history of the displacements of every node (on Tim) and the history of the 12 end forces of every member and the history of the support reactions (on Frc) of the structure at every time step . Syntax: TYPE 1 FORCE SAVE ...= values of time(sec.) and corresponding forc e (current force unit) or acceleration (current lengt h unit/sec 2 ) depending on whethe r the time varying load is a forcing function or a ground motion. If the data is specified through the input file, u p to 499 pairs can be provided for each type in the ascending va lue of time. More than one line may be used if necessary. However, if the data is provided through an external file, an unlimited number of time-force pairs may be specified. If the first point is not at zero time, then the forces before the first time (but after the arrival time) wil l be determined by extrapolation using the first two points entered. If the first point has a nonzero force, there will be a sudden applicat ion of that force over a single integration step (DT) at that
5-242
Section 5
time. Zero force will be assumed for all times after the last data point. a 1 a 2 a 3 ... a n = Values of the variou s possible arrival times (seconds) of the various dynamic load types. Arrival time is the time at which a load type begins to act at a joint (forcing function) or at the base of the structure (ground motion). The same l oad type may have different arrival times for different j oints and hence all those values must be specified here. The arrival times and the times from the tim e-force pairs will be added to get the times for a particular set o f joints in the TIME LOAD data (see section 5.10.32.2). The arrival tim es and the time-force pairs fo r the load types are used to create the load vector needed for each time step of the analysis. Refer to Section 5.32.10.2 for i nformation on input specification for application of the forcing function and/or ground motion loads. Up to 999 arrival time values may be specified. d = Modal damping ratio (i.e. [Percen t of critical damping]/100). Default value is 0.05 (5% of critical damping). To enter different dam ping for each mod e, enter a Define Damp command elsewhere and MDAMP here; or for composite damping, enter CDAMP here and C DAMP ratios for all of the members / ele ments/ springs in the Constants and Set commands. T he "function-spec" option may be used to specify harmonic loads. Both "sine" and "cosine" harmonic functions may be specified. The program will automatically calculate the harmonic load time history based on the following specifications f 0 - Max. Amplitude of the forcing function in current units. f 2 - If FREQUENCY, then cyclic frequency (cycles / sec.) If RPM, then revolutions per minute. f 3 - Phase Angle in degrees, default = 0 f 4 - No. of cycles of loading.
Section 5
5-243
f 5 - time step of loading, default = one twelfth of the period corresponding to the frequ ency of the harmonic loading. It is best to use the default; o r f 6 - subdivide a cycle into this many integer time steps. Default = 3. f 5 or f 6 is used only to digitize the forcing function. It is not the DT used to integrate for the responses. More subdivisions or smaller step size will m ake the digitized force curve more closely match a sine wave. The default is usually adequate. Please be aware that if a Cosine function or Sine with nonzero phas e angle is entered, the force at the arrival time will be nonzero; there will be a sudden application of force over a single integration step (DT) at that time.
Exa mple UNIT . . . DEFINE TIME HISTORY TYPE 1 FORCE 0.0 1.0 1.0 1.2 2.0 1.8 3.0 2.2 4.0 2.6 5.0 2.8 TYPE 2 ACCELERATION 0.0 2.5 0.5 2.7 1.0 3.2 1.5 3.8 2.0 4.2 2.5 4.5 3.0 4.5 3.5 2.8 ARRIVAL TIME 0.0 1.0 1.8 2.2 3.5 4.4 DAMPING 0.075 Notes
The 'READ fn' command is to be provided only if the history of the time varying load is to be read from an external file. fn is the file name and may be up to 72 characters long. If the data on the file consists only of amplitudes, then enter f8 as the delta time spacing.
5-244
Section 5
The data in the external file must be provided as one or more timeforce pairs per line as shown in the following example.
Data in Input file UNIT . . . DEFINE TIME HISTORY TYPE 1 FORCE READ THFILE ARRIVAL TIME 0.0 DAMPING 0.075 Data in the External file THFILE 0.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 1.0 1.8 2.2 2.6 1.0 1.2
Example for Harmonic Loading Generator UNIT . . . DEFINE TIME HISTORY TYPE 1 FORCE *Following lines for Harmonic Loading Generator FUNCTION SINE AMPLITUDE 6.2831 FREQUENCY 60 CYCLES 100 STEP 0.02 ARRIVAL TIME 0.0 DAMPING 0.075
Section 5
5-245
To define more than one sinusoidal load, the input specification is as follows :
DEFINE TIME HISTORY TYPE 1 FORCE FUNCTION SINE AMPLITUDE 1.925 RPM 10794.0 CYCLES 1000 TYPE 2 FORCE FUNCTION SINE AMPLITUDE 1.511 RPM 9794.0 CYCLES 1000 TYPE 3 FORCE FUNCTION SINE AMPLITUDE 1.488 RPM 1785.0 CYCLES 1000 ARRIVAL TIME 0.0 0.0013897 0.0084034 DAMPING 0.04 Notes
1) By default the response (displacements, forces etc.) will contain the contribution of only those modes whose frequency is less than or equal to 108 cps. Use the CUT OF F FREQUENCY command to change this limit. Con tributions of modes with frequency greater than the Cut Off Frequency are not considered. 2) Results ar e the individual maximums over the time period. Thus, derived quantities such as sec tion forces and stresses, p late surface stresses and principal stresses should not be used. 3) Results from harmonic input are the maximum over the time period including the start-up transient period. These results are not the steady-state results. 4) By default, the results do not include the time period afte r the time loads end . Use the CUT OFF TIME command to lengthen (or shorten) the time period. If an intense shor tterm loading is used, the loading should be continued unti l after the expecte d peak response is reached.
5-246
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to define some of the parameters for generation of snow loads on the structure. See section 5.32.13, Ge neration of Snow Loads, for the definition of additional parameters and the surfaces to be loaded.
G e neral Format: DEFINE SNOW LOAD TYPE f1 PG f2 CE f3 CT f4 IM f5
Where f1 Snow Load Ty pe num be r (limit of 100). f2 Ground snow l o ad pa r am eter (force per unit area). This is the snow load i ntensity a nd should be negative. Default = 0.0. f3 Exposure factor. Default = 1.0. Thermal factor. Default = 0.0. f4 f5 Importance factor. Default = 1.0. Include as many types as needed.
Section 5
5-247
This section describes the various loading options available in STAAD. The following command may be u sed to initiate a new load c ase.
LOA DING i 1 (LOADTYPE LIVE REDUCIBLE) (any load title)
i 1 = any unique integer number (up to five digits) to identify t he load case. T his number need not be sequential with the previous loa d number. LOADTYPE Live Reducible = this option enables a user to reduce a floor live load according to the provisions of UBC 1997, IBC 2000 a nd IBC 2003 codes. For details, see section 5.32.4 of this manu al. The LOADING command initiates a new load case. Under this heading, all diffe rent loads related to this loading number ca n be input. These diff erent kinds of loads are described in the rem aining sub-sections belo w.
Note: For Mass Model L oading in Dynamics please read Mass Modeling in Secti on
1.18.3 carefully. For the p urpose of entering the mass distribution for the first dy namic load case, use the following sections, 5.32.1 through 5.32.4 plus 5.32.9. The purpose of the mass m odeling step is to create l umped masses at the joints that the eigensolution can use. The member/element loading is only a convenience in generating the joint masses. Analytically the masses are not in the elements but are lumped at the joints. The absolute value of joint loads or loads distributed to joints from member/element load ings will be treated as weights. The moments ap plied to member/elements or com puted at joints as a result of m ember/element loadings will be ignored. Only moments (actually weight moment of inertia, force-length 2 units) applied in the Joint
5-248
Section 5
Load command will be used in defini ng the weight moment of inertias at joints. For slave joint directions, the associated joint weight or weight moment of inertia will be moved to the master. In addition, the translational weights at slave joint directions will be multiplied by the square of the distance to the master to get the additional weight mom ent of inertia at the master. Cross product weight moment of inertias at the mast er will be ignored.
Section 5
5-249
This set of commands may be used to specify JOINT loads on the structure. For dynamic mass modeling see sections 5.32 and 1.18.3.
General format: JOINT LOAD * FX FY FZ MX MY MZ f1 f2 f3 f4 f5 f6
joint-list
FX, FY and FZ specify a force in the corresponding global direction (even at inclined support joints). MX, MY and MZ specify a moment in the corresponding global direction. f 1 , f 2 ... f 6 are the values of the loads.
See Section 1.16.1
Joint numbers may be repeated where loads are meant to be additive in the joint. UNIT command may be on lines in between joint-list lines. If moments are for dynamic mass, then the units are assumed to be force-length 2 .
5-250
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to specify MEMBER loads on frame members.
General format: MEMBER LOAD
member-list
f1, f2, f3, f4, f14 f5, f6, f4, f14 f 7, f 8, f 9 f10, f11, f12, f13
direction-spec =
UNI or UMOM specifies a uniformly distributed load or mo ment with a value of f 1 , at a distance of f 2 from th e start of the member to the start o f the load, and a distance of f 3 from the start of the member to the end of the load. The load is assumed to cover th e full member length if f 2 and f 3 are omitted. UMOM is not available for tapered members. CON or CMOM specifies a concentrated force or moment with a value of f 5 a pplied at a distance of f 6 from the start of the member. f 6 will default to half the member length if omitted. Perpendicular distance from the member shear f4 = center to the local plane of loading. The value is positive in the general direction of the parallel (or
Section 5
5-251
f4 =
f 14 = LIN
TRAP
close to parallel) local axis. The local x component of force is not offset. If global or projected load is selected, then the local Y component of load is offset the f 4 distance; the local Z component is offset the f 4 distance; and the local X component is not offset. -ORIf f 14 is not blank, then f 4 is the perpendicular local y distance from the member shear center to the local z-plane of loading. Perpendicular local z distance from the member shear center to the local y-plane of loading. specifies a linearly decreasing or increasing, or a triangular load. If the load is linearly increasing or decreasing then f 7 is the value at the start of the member and f 8 is the value at the end. If the load is triangular, then f 7 and f 8 are input as zero and f 9 is the value of the load in the middle of the member. specifies a trapezoidal linearly varying load t hat may act over the full or partial length of a member and in a local, global or projected direction. The starting load value is given by f 10 and the ending load value by f 11 . The loading loc ation is give n by f 12 , the loading starting point, and f 13 , the stopping point. Both are measured from the start of the member. If f 12 and f 13 are not given, the load is assum ed to cover the full member le ngth.
X, Y, & Z in the direction-spec and local-spec specify the direction of the load in the loca l (member) x, y and z-axes. G X, GY, & GZ in the direction-spec specify the direction of the load in the global X, Y, and Z-axes. PX, PY and PZ may be used if the load is to be along the projected length of the member in the corresponding global direction. Load
5-252
Section 5
start and end distances are measured along the member length and not the projecte d length.
Notes
See Section 1.16.2
In e arlier versio ns of STAAD, the LINear t ype of member load could be applied only along the local axis of the member. It has b e en modified to allow for global and projected axes directions also. If the member being loaded has offset distances (se e MEMBER O FFSET specification), the location of the load is measured not from the coordinates of the starting node but from the offset d istance. T rapezoidal loads are converted into a uniform load and 8 or more concentrated loads. A UN IT command may be on lines in betw een member-list lines. If a lo ad location is less than zero, it is reset to 0.0. If a load location is greater than the length, it is reset to the length.
Example MEMBER LOAD 619 CON GY -2.35 5.827 68 TO 72 UNI GX -0.088 3.17 10.0 186 TRAP GY -0.24 -0.35 0.0 7.96 3212 LIN X -5.431 -3.335 41016 UNI PZ -0.075 3724 LIN GY -6.2 -7.8
Section 5
5-253
5-254
Section 5
This command may be used to specify various types of ELEMENT LOADS for plates.
General format: ELEMENT LOAD ( PLATE )
ele ment-list
p 1 (x 1 y 1 x 2 y 2 )
f1 f2 f1 f2 f1 f2 f3 f4
Description
The PRESSURE option should be used when a UNIFORM pressure needs to be specified. The uniform PRE SSURE may be provided on the entire element or a user specified portion of the e lement (defined by x 1 , y 1 and x 2 , y 2 - see description below). If x 1 , y 1 and x 2 , y 2 are not provided, the pressure is applied on the entire element. If only x 1 , y 1 is provided, the load is assumed as a concentrated lo ad applied at the specified point. The PRESSURE may be provided either in GLOBAL (GX, GY, GZ) directions or in local Z dire ction (normal to the element). If the GLOBAL direction is omitted, the applied loading is assume d to be in the local Z direction. The loads are proportional to the area, not the projected area.
Section 5
5-255
GX,GY,GZ
X2 Y2 Local X
Figure 5.23
p1
x 1 ,y 1 & x 2 ,y 2
Uniformly Varying Press. (Trap Y)
Element pressure (force/square of length) or concentrated load (force). p 1 is assumed as a concentrated load if x 2 and y 2 are omitted. Co-ordinate values in the local co-ordinate system (center node is considered as the origin) defining the rectangular area on which the pressure is applied. The TRAP option should be used when a linearly varying pressure needs to be specified. The variation must be provided over the entire element.
Local Y
Local X
Figure 5.24
5-256
Section 5
X or Y
f1 f2
Direction of variation of element pressure. The TRAP X/Y option indicates that the variation of the Trapezoid is in the local X or in the local Y direction. The load acts in the global direction if selected, otherwise in the local Z axis. Pressure intensity at start. Pressure intensity at end.
Alternatively the TRAP and JT options may be selected together in order to specify the actual pressures at the joints. f1 f2 f3 f4
Notes
1. 2.
3. 4.
Start and end defined above are based on positive directions of the local X or Y axis. While the X or Y indicates the direction of variation of the trapezoidal load, the load i tsel f ac ts in the glob a l o r local Z direction as specified. Pressure intensities at th e joints allows linear variation of pressure in both the X and Y local directions simultaneously . The TRAP load with global directions may be used to apply a volumetri c type of pressure. For example, consider a grain silo with a sloping wall. In the event of modelling it using non-uniform elements, by which we mean elements whose 3 or 4 nodes are all at different elevations, the grain height at each node will depend on the elevation of the node. One can apply the pressure by specifying the intensity at each node of each element.
Section 5
5-257
Example LOAD 4 ELEMENT LOAD 1 7 TO 10 PR 2.5 11 12 PR 2.5 1.5 2.5 5.5 4.5 15 TO 25 TRAP X 1.5 4.5 15 TO 20 TRAP GY JT 1.5 4.5 2.5 5.5 34 PR 5.0 2.5 2.5 35 TO 45 PR -2.5 15 25 TRAP GX Y 1.5 4.5
5-258
Section 5
Two types of loads can be assigned on the individual faces of solid elements: 1. 2. A uniform pressure A volu metric type of pressure on a face where the intensity at one node of the face can be different from that at another node on the same face. An example of such a load is the weight of water on the sloping face of a dam. If the dam is modelled using solids, for the individual elements, the water height at the lower elevation nodes will be larger than those at the higher elevation nodes.
element-list
FACE
i1
PRESSURE
GX GY f 1 f 2 f 3 f 4 GZ
Description
The first option above loads the solid by specifying one or more of the 6 faces to receive pressure. The PRESSURE may be provided either in GLOBAL (GX, GY, GZ) directions or in local Z direction (normal to the element). If the GLOBAL direction is omitted, the applied loading is assumed to be normal to the face and a positive pressure is into the solid. The loads are proportional to the area, not the projected area.
Section 5
5-259
f 1 f 2 f 3 f 4 Pressure values at the joints for each 3 or 4 joint face defined. Only f 1 needs to be specified for uniform pressure. In any case the pressure is provided over the entire face. i 1 is one of six face numbers to receive the pressure for the solids selected. See figure 1.15 in section 1.6.2 for the following face d efinitions. Enter a pressure on all 4 joints even if the face is collapsed to 3 poin ts. FAC E NUM BER 1 front 2 bot tom 3 left 4 top 5 right 6 back Example LOAD 4 ELEMENT LOAD SOLIDS 11 12 FACE 3 PR 2.5 1.5 2.5 5.5 SURFACE JOINTS f2 f3 Jt 4 Jt 3 Jt 2 Jt 6 Jt 5 Jt 8 Jt 8 Jt 7 Jt 3 Jt 7 Jt 6 Jt 7
f1 Jt 1 Jt 1 Jt 1 Jt 4 Jt 2 Jt 5
f4 Jt 2 Jt 5 Jt 4 Jt 3 Jt 6 Jt 8
5-260
Section 5
This command may be used to specify various types of element like loads for joints. Three or four joints are specified tha t form a plane area; pressure is specified for that area; then STAAD computes the equivalent joint load s. This command may be used as an alternative or supplement for the Area Load, Floor Load, and the other Element L oad commands.
General format: ELE MENT LOAD JOINTS i 1 (by i 2 ) i 3 (by i 4 ) i 5 (by i 6 ) i 7 (by i 8 ) FAC ETS f1 f2 f3 f4
GX j 1 PR ESSURE GY GZ
If this data is on more than one line, the hyphens must be within the joint data.
Description f 1 f 2 f 3 f 4 Pressure values at the joints for each 3 or 4 joint facet defined. Only f 1 needs to be specified for uniform pr essure. In any case the pressure is provide d over the entire element.
The PRESSU RE may be provided either in GLOBAL (GX, GY, G Z) directions or in local Z direction (normal to the element). If th e GLOBAL direction is omitted, the applied load ing is assumed to be in the local Z direction as if the joints defined a plate. The loads are proportional to the area, not the projected area. There will be j 1 facets loaded. The first facet is defined by j oints i 1 i 3 i 5 i 7 then each joint number is incremented by the BY value (1 if omitted).
Section 5
5-261
GY GY GY GY GY
10 10 10 10 10
10 10 10 10 10
15 15 15 15 15
15 15 15 15 15
So, the value following the word FACETS is like a counter for generation, indicating how many element faces the load command must be created for. Thus a value of 5 for facets means, a total of 5 imaginary element faces have been loaded.
BY is the value by which the individual corner node number is being incremented during the generation. In this example, the value is 1, which is same as the default. Instead, if it had been say, 1 by 2 2 by 3 32 by 1 31 by 1 FACETS 5 PRESSURE GY 10 10 15 15
5-262
Section 5
Notes:
If a pressure or volumetric load is acting on a region or surface, and the entity whi ch makes up the surface, like a slab, is not part of the structural model, one can apply the pressure load using this facility. T he load is defined in terms of the pressure intensity at the 3 or 4 nodes which can be treated as the corners of the triangular or quadrilateral plane area which makes up the region. This command may be used as an alternative or supplem ent for the Area Load, Floor Load, Wind Load, and other pressure load situations. In other words, the element pressure load can be applied along a global direction on any surface, without actually having elements to model that surface. Thus, for a sloping face of a building, if one wants to apply a wind pressure on the sloping face, one can do so by specify ing the joints which m ake up the boundary of that face. T hree or four joints are specified that form a plane area; pressure is specified for that area; then STAAD comp utes the equivalent jo int loads.
Section 5
5-263
GX GY GZ
GX, GY and GZ : Global X, Y and Z directions. If the direction is omitted, the load will act along the local Z axis of the surface w = Value of pressure. Negative value indicates load acts opposite to the direction of the axis specified.
Pressure Load on partial area of the surface General Format
LOAD n SURFACE LOAD GX surface-list PRESSURE GY w x1 y1 x2 y2 GZ
w = Value of pressure. Negative value indicates load acts opposite to the direction of the axis specified. GX, GY and GZ : Global X, Y and Z directions. If the direction is omitted, the load will act along the local Z axis of the surface
5-264
Section 5
x1, y1 = Local X and Y coordinates of the corner nearest to the s urface origin of the loaded region. Measured from the origin of the surface, in the local coordinate system of the surface. x2, y2 = Local X and Y coordinates of the corner farthest fro m the surface origin of the loaded region. Measured from the origin of the surface, in the local coordinate system of the surface.
Concen trated force on Surface Genera l Format LO A D n SU R FACE LOAD
GX surface-list PRESSURE GY p x y GZ GX, GY and GZ : Global X, Y and Z directions. If the direction is omitted, the load will act along the local Z axis of the surface p = Val ue of the concentrated force. Negative sign indicate s load acts opp osite to the direction of the axis specified. x, y = L ocal X and Y coordinates of the point of action of the force. Measured from the origin of the surface, in the local coordinate system of the surface.
Examp les LOAD 1 uniform pressure on full surface SURFACE LOAD 1 2 PRESS GX 0.002 3 GX -0.0025 LOAD 2 concentrated force SURFACE LOAD 10 12 PRE GZ 400 3.5 4.5
Section 5
5-265
LOAD 3 Partial Area Load SURFACE LOAD 23 25 PRE GY -250 4 4.3 8 9.5
The attributes associated with surfaces, and the sections of this man ual where the information may be obtained, are listed below:
Attributes
Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output prin ting Shear Wall Design -
Related Sections
5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21 .2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
5-266
Section 5
These commands may be used to specify AREA LOAD s, O NEWAY LOADs or FLOOR LOADs on a structure based on m embers only. They are used mostly when the entity transmitting th e load, such as a slab, is not part of the structural model. The A REA LOAD or ONEWAY LOAD may be used for modeling onew ay distribution and the FLOOR LOAD may be used for modeling two-way distribution.
General format for AREA LOAD: ARE A LOAD ALOAD
member-list
GX f 1 ( GY ) GZ
f 1 = The value of the area load (units of weight over square length unit). If Global directio n is omitted , then this load acts along the positive local y-axis [for the members of a floor analysis, the local y direction will coincide with global vertical axis in most cases]. If Global direction is included, then the load acts in that direction. The magnitude of the loads calculated is the same as if the positive local y axis option was selected. (For detailed description, refer to Section 1.)
Example AREA LOAD 2 4 TO 8 ALOAD -.250 12 16 ALOAD -.500
Section 5
5-267
Note
A rea load should not b e specified on members declared as MEMBER CABLE, MEMBER TRUSS or MEMBER TENSION.
General Format for ONEWAY LOAD: ONEWAY LOAD
YRA
XRA
ZRA
GX GY GZ GX GY GZ GX GY GZ
YRA
XRA
ZRA
5-268
Section 5
where: Global coordinate values to specify Y, X, or Z range. The flo or/oneway load will be calculated for all members lying in that global plane within the first specified global coordinate range. The va lue of the floor/oneway load (unit weight over f3 square length unit). If Global direction is omitted, then this load acts parallel to the positive global Y if com mand begins wit h YRA and based on the area projected on a X-Z plane . Similarly, for commands beginning with XRA, the load a cts parallel to the positive global X and based on the area projecte d on a Y-Z plane. Similarly, for commands beginning with ZRA, the load acts parallel to the positive global Z and based on the area projected on a X-Y plane. f 4 - f 7 Globa l coordinate values to define the corner points of the area on which the specified floor load (f 3 ) acts. If not specified, the floor load will be calculated for all members in all floors within the first specified global coordinate range. GX,GY,GZ: If a Global direction is included, then the load is redirected to act in the specified direction(s) with a magnitude of the loads which is based on the area projected on a plane as if the Global direction was omitted. The Global direction option is especially useful in mass definition. FLOORGROUP NAME: Please see section 5.16 of this manual for the procedure for creating FLOORGROUP names. The member-list contained in this name will be the candidates that will receive the load generated from the floor pressure. f1 f2
Section 5
5-269
Notes
1) The structure has to be modeled in such a way that the specified global axis remains perpendicular to the floor plane(s). 2) For the FLOOR LOAD specification, a two-way distribution of the load is considered. For the ONEWAY and AREA LOAD specification, a one-way action is considered. For ONE WAY loads, the program attempts to find the shorter direction within panels for load generation purposes. So, if any of the panels are square in s hape, no load will be generated for those panels. For such panels, use the FLOOR LOA D type. 3 ) FLOOR LOAD from a slab is distributed on the adjoining members as trapezoidal and triangular loads depending on t he length of the sides as shown in the diagram. Internally, thes e loads are converted to multiple point loads.
20' 9 5 10 10' 2 45
o
1 45
o
11
45o 4 13 3
45o 14
Members 1 and 2 get full trapezoidal and triangular loads respectively. Members 3 and 4 get partial trapezoidal loads and 5 and 6 get partial triangular load.
Figure 5.25
4) The load per unit area may not vary for a particular panel and it is assumed to be continuous and without holes. 3) The FLOOR/ONEWAY LOAD facility is not available if the SET Z UP command is used (See Section 5.5.) 4) If the floor has a shape consisting of a mixture of convex and concave edges, then break up the floor load command into several parts, each for a certain region of the floor. This will force the program to localize the search for panels and the solution will be better. See illustrative example at the end of this section. 5) At least one quadrilateral panel bounded on at least 3 sides by "complete" members has to be present within the bounds of the user-defined range of coordinates (XRANGE, YRANGE and ZRANGE) in order for t he program to successfully generate
5-270
Section 5
member loads from the FLOOR/ONEWAY LOAD specification. A "complete" member is defined as one who se entire length between its start and end coordinates borders th e specified panel. The load distribution pattern depends upon the shape of the panel. If th e panel is Rectangular, the distribution will be Trapezoidal and triangular as explained in the following diagram.
X 6
6
Figure 5.26
Section 5
5-271
For a panel that is not rectangular, the distribution is described in following diagram. F irst, th e CG of the polygon is calculated. Then, each corner is connected to the CG to form triangles as shown. For each triangle, a vertical line is drawn from the CG to the opposite side. If the point of intersection of the vertical line and th e side f alls outside the triangle, the area of that triangle will be calculated and an equivalent uniform distributed load will be applied on that side. O therw ise a triangular load will be applie d on the side.
Triangular
2 Triangular UDL
Example The input for FLOOR LOAD is explained through an example. Let us consider the following floor plan at y = 12.
5-272
Section 5
11' 1 10' 2 2 7 B 4 3 6 A 10 9 C 6 4 7 Z 5 8 10' 5 8 6' 3 X
Figure 5.28
If the entire floor has a load of 0.25 (force/unit area), then the input will be as follows: ... LOAD 2 FLOOR LOAD YRA 12.0 12.0 FLOAD -0.25 ... If in the above example, panel A has a load of 0.25 and panels B and C have a load of 0.5, then the input will be as follows: Note the usage of XRANGE, YRANGE and ZRANGE specifications. LOAD 2 FLOOR LOAD YRA 11.9 12.1 FLOAD -0.25 XRA 0.0 11.0 ZRA 0.0 16.0 YRA 11.9 12.1 FLOAD -0.5 XRA 11.0 21.0 ZRA 0.0 16.0 LOAD 3 The program internally identifies the panels (shown as A, B and C in the figure). The floor loads are distributed as trapezoidal and triangular loads as shown by dotted lines in the figure. The negative sign for the load signifies that it is applied in the downward global Y direction.
Section 5
5-273
T he attached example illustrates a case where the floor has to be sub-divided i nto smaller regions for the f loor load generation to yield proper results. The internal angle at node 6 between the sides 108 and 111 exceeds 180 degrees. A similar situation exists at node 7 also. As a result, the fo llowing co mmand
LOAD 1 FLOOR LOAD YRANGE 11.9 12.1 FLOAD 0.35
will not yield acceptable results. Instead, the region should be subdivided as shown in the following exa mple
LOAD 1 FLOOR LOAD Y RANGE 11 .9 12 .1 FLOAD 0.35 XRA 0. 1 15.1 ZRA 0.1 8.1 YRANGE 11.9 12.1 FLOAD 0.35 XRA 4.9 10.1 ZRA 7.9 16.1
Figure 5.29
5-274
Section 5
6) The global horizontal direction options (GX and GZ) enables one to consider AREA LOADs, ONEWAY LOADSs and FLOOR LOADs for mass matrix for freq uency calculations. 7) For ONE WAY loads, the program attempts to find the shorter direction within panels for load generation purposes. So, if any of the panels are square in shape, no load will be generated on the m embers circumscribing those panels. In such cases, one ought to use the FLOOR LOAD type.
Figure 5.30
Section 5
5-275
b ) After the load is specified, if the user decides to change the geometry of the structure (X, Y or Z coordinates of th e nodes of the regions over which the floor load is applied), she/he has to go back to the load and modify its data too, such as the XRANGE, YRANG E and ZRANGE values. In other words, the 2 sets of data are n ot automatically linked. T he above limitations may be overcome using a FLOOR GROUP. A GROUP name is a facility which enables us to cluster a set of e ntities nodes, members, plates, solids, etc. into a single moniker th rough which one can address them. Details of this are available in section 5.16 of this manual. The syntax of this command, as explained earlier in this section is:
FLO OR LOAD Floor-group-name FLOAD f3
GX GY GZ
5-276
Section 5
2.
The following figures show the load generated on members for the two situ ations.
Figure 5.31
Section 5
5-277
Figure 5.32
UBC 1997
IB C 2000
IBC 2003
5-278
Section 5
In the above equations, A = area of floor supported by the member R = reduction in percentage R = rate of reduction equal to 0.08 for floors.
Notes:
1. Only the rules for live load on Floors have been implemented. The rules for live load on Roofs have not been implemented. 2. Since the medium of application of this method is the FLOOR LOAD or ONEWAY LOAD feature, and since STAAD performs load generation on beams only, the rules of the above-mentioned sections of the code for vertical members (columns) has not been implemented. The distributed load on those members found to satisfy the requirements explained in the code would have a lowered value after the reduction is applied. 3. Equation (7-2) of UBC 97, (16-3) of IBC 2000 and (16-23) of IBC 2003 have not been implemented. 4. In the IBC 2000 and 2003 codes, the first note says A reduction shall not be permitted in Group A occupancies. In STAAD, there is no direct method for conveying to the program that the occupancy type is Group A. So, it is the users responsibility to ensure that when he/she decides to utilize the live load reduction feature, the structure satisfies this requirement. If it does not, then the reduction should not be applied. STAAD does not check this condition by itself. 5. In the UBC 97 code, the last paragraph of section 1607.5 states that The live load reduction shall not exceed 40 percent in garages for the storage of private pleasure cars having a capacity of not more than nine passengers per vehicle. Again, there is no method to convey to STAAD that the structure is a garage for storing private pleasure cars. Hence, it is the users responsibility to ensure that the
Section 5
5-279
structure satisfies this requirement. If it does not, then the reduction should not be applied. STAAD does not check this condition by itself. 6. Because all the three codes follow the same rules for reduction, no provision is made available in the command syntax for specifying the code name according to which the reduction is to be done.
5-280
Section 5
This command may be used to specify PRESTRESS loads on members of the structure.
General Format:
MEMBER
PRESTRESS POSTSTRESS
FORCE f1 * ES EM EE
(LOAD) f2 f3 f4
member-list
f1
= Prestressing force. This value is positive in the direction of the local x-axis. ES = specifies eccentricity of the prestress force at the start of the member at a distance f 2 from the centroid. EM = specifies eccentricity of the prestress force at the midpoint of the member at a distance f 3 from the centroid. EE = specifies eccentricity of the prestress force at the end of the member at a distance f 4 from the centroid.
Description
The first option, (MEMBER PRESTRESS LOAD), considers the effect of the prestressing force during its application. Thus, transverse shear generated at the ends of the member(s) subject to the prestressing force is transferred to the adjacent members. The second option, (MEMBER POSTSTRESS LOAD), considers the effect of the existing prestress load after the prestressing operation. Thus, transverse shear at the ends of the member(s) subject to the prestressing force is not transferred to the adjacent members.
Section 5
5-281
Example MEMBER PRESTRESS 2 TO 7 11 FORCE 50.0 MEMBER POSTSTRESS 8 FORCE 30.0 ES 3.0 EM -6.0 EE 3.0
In the first example, a prestressing force of 50 force units is applied through the centroid (i.e. no eccentricity) of members 2 to 7 and 11. In the second example, a poststressing force of 30 force units is applied with an eccentricity of 3 length units at the start, 6.0 at the middle, and 3.0 at the end of member 8. One of the limitations in using this command is that under any one load case, on any given member, a prestress or poststress load may be applied only once. If the given member carries multiple stressed cables or has a PRESTRESS and POSTSTRESS load condition, such a situation will have to be specified through multiple load cases for that member. See example below.
Incorrect input LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 6 7 FORCE 100 ES 2 EM -3 EE 2 6 FORCE 150 ES 3 EM -6 EE 3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
5-282
Section 5
Correct Input LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 6 7 FORCE 100 ES 2 EM -3 EE 2 LOAD 2 MEMBER PRESTRESS 6 FORCE 150 ES 3 EM -6 EE 3 LOAD COMBINATION 3 1 1.0 2 1.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS
3 3
10ft
Figure 5.33
JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 10 0 MEMB INCI 112 . .. UNIT . . . LOAD 1 MEMBER POSTSTRESS 1 FORCE 100 ES 3 EM -3 EE 3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
Section 5
5-283
Example 2
20 ft
Figure 5.34
JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 20 0 MEMB INCI 112 . . . UNIT . . . LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 1 FORCE 100 ES -3 EM -3 EE -3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
5-284
Section 5
Example 3
3 3
5 ft
10 ft
5 ft
Figure 5.35
JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 5 0 ; 3 15 0 0 ; 4 20 0 MEMB INCI 112;223;334 . . . UNIT . . . LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 1 FORCE 100 ES 3 EM 0 EE -3 2 FORCE 100 ES -3 EM -3 EE -3 3 FORCE 100 ES -3 EM 0 EE 3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
Section 5
5-285
Example 4
3 3
20 ft
Figure 5.36
JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 10 0 ; 3 20 0 0 MEMB INCI 112;223 . . . UNIT . . . LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 1 FORCE 100 ES 3 EM 0 EE -3 2 FORCE 100 ES -3 EM 0 EE 3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
5-286
Section 5
Example 5
3 3 3 3 3
10 ft
10 ft
Figure 5.37
JOINT COORD 1 0 0 ; 2 10 0 ; 3 20 0 0 MEMB INCI 112;223 . . . UNIT . . . LOAD 1 MEMBER PRESTRESS 1 FORCE 100 ES 3 EM -3 EE 3 2 FORCE 100 ES 3 EM -3 EE 3 PERFORM ANALYSIS
Section 5
5-287
This command may be used to specify TEMPERATURE loads or strain loads on members, plates, and solids; or strain loads on members.
General format: TEMPERATURE LOAD
f 1 = The average change in temperature (from ambient stressfree temperature) in the member/element which will cause axial elongation in the members or uniform volume expansion in plates and solids. The temperature unit is the same as the unit chosen for the coefficient of thermal expansion ALPHA under the CONSTANT command. (Members/Plates/Solids) f 2 = The temperature differential from the top to the bottom of the member or plate (T top surface -T bottom surface ). If f 2 is omitted, no bending will be considered. (Local Y axis Members/ Local Z axis Plates). Section depth must be entered for prismatic. f 4 = The temperature differential from side to side of the member. (Local Z axis) (Members only). Section or flange width must be entered for prismatic. f 3 = Initial axial elongation (+)/ shrinkage (-) in member due to misfit, etc. in length unit (Members only). f 5 = Initial axial elongation (+)/ shrinkage (-) per unit length, of members only.
5-288
Section 5
Example UNIT MMS TEMP LOAD 1 TO 9 15 17 TEMP 70.0 18 TO 23 TEMP 90.0 66.0 8 TO 13 STRAIN 3.0 15 27 STRAINRATE 0.4E -4 Note
It is not necessary or possible to specify the units for temperature or for ALPHA. The user must ensure that the value provided for ALPHA is consistent in terms of units with the value provided for the temperature load. (see Section 5.26). If ALPHA was provided by a material name (STEEL, CONCRETE, ALUMINUM) then the temperature here must be in degree Fahrenheit units (if English length units were in effect when Alpha was defined) or degree Celsius units (if metric length units were in effect when Alpha was defined).
Section 5
5-289
This command may be used to specify FIXED-END loads on members (beams only) of the structure.
General format: FIXED ( END ) LOAD Member_list FXLOAD f 1 , f 2 , ..... f 12
member_list = normal Staad member list rules (TO and BY for generation; and - to continue list to next line).
See Section 1.16.4
f 1 ... f 6 = Force-x, shear-y, shear-z, torsion, moment-y, moment-z (all in local coordinates) at the start of the member. f 7 ... f 12 = Same as above except at the end of the member. If less than 12 load values are entered, zero values will be added to the end. The loads may be extended to one additional line by ending the first load line with a - (hyphen). These loads are given in the member local coordinate system and the directions are opposite to the actual load on the member Old input format:
Member_number f 1 , f 2 , ..... f 12
Member_number = enter only one member number per line for this format. [If you want to define the same load for many members, then use the member list form of this command shown at the beginning of this section.]
5-290
Section 5
This command may be used to specify DISPLACEMENTs (or generate loads to induce specified displacements) in supported directions (pinned, fixed, enforced, or spring).
General format: SUPPORT DISPLACEMENT
support joint-list
FX FY FZ MX MY MZ
f1
FX, FY, FZ specify translational displacements in X, Y, and Z directions respectively. MX, MY, MZ specify rotational displacements in X, Y, and Z directions. f1 = Value of the corresponding displacement. For translational displacements, the unit is in the currently specified length unit, while for rotational displacements the unit is always in degrees.
Description
There are two distinct modes of usage for this command. If any Enforced specifications were used in the Support command then the Displacement mode is used; otherwise the Load mode is used. Despite the name of this command, if displacements are specified in spring directions, the displacement is at the joint not at the grounded end of the support spring. Displacement cannot be specified in a direction that does not have a support or a spring.
Section 5
5-291
DISPLACEMENT MODE
With this mode, the support joint displacement is modeled as an imposed joint displacement. The joint directions where displacement may be specified must be defined (same for all cases) in the SUPPORT command, see section 5.27.1. Any beam members, springs or finite elements will be considered in the analysis. Other loading, inclined supports, and master/slave are all considered. Any number of cases may have displacements entered. However, all cases will have zero displacements at the enforced directions if no displacement values are entered for that case. At inclined supports the displacement specification is assumed to be in the inclined direction. Displacements may not be specified at slave directions. If some cases are to have spring supports and others enforced displacements at the same joint directions, then two PERFORM ANALYSES must be used with the CHANGE command in between. The first perform analysis could have the SUPPORTS with springs, no enforced directions, and with the load cases without displacements. The second perform analysis would then have SUPPORTS without springs but with enforced directions and the cases with displacements.
LOAD MODE
With this mode, the support joint displacement is modeled as a load. Only beam members (not springs or finite elements) are considered in computing the joint load distribution necessary to cause the displacement. Other loading, inclined supports, and master/slave are also not considered. These unconsidered factors, if entered, will result in displacements other than those entered
5-292
Section 5
(results are superimposed). Only those cases with displacements entered will be affected.
In t his example, the joints of the first support list will be displace d by 0 .25 units in the negative global Y direction. The joints of the second support list will be rotated by 15 degrees about the global X-a xis.
Section 5
5-293
This command may be used to calculate and apply the SELFWEIGHT of the structure for analysis.
General format: SELFWEIGHT
X Y Z
f1
This command is used if the self-weight of the structure is to be considered. The self-weight of every active member is calculated and applied as a uniformly distributed member load. X, Y, & Z represent the global direction in which the selfweight acts. f 1 = The factor to be used to multiply the selfweight. This command may also be used without any direction and factor specification. Thus, if specified as "SELFWEIGHT", loads will be applied in the negative global Y direction with a factor of unity.
Notes
Density must be provided for calculation of the self weight. The selfweight of finite elements is converted to joint loads at the connected nodes and is not used as an element pressure load. The selfweight of a plate is placed at the joints, regardless of plate releases.
5-294
Section 5
The command specification needed to perform response spectrum analysis and time-history analysis is explained in the following sections. Related topics can be found in the following sections: CUT OFF MODE CUT OFF FREQUENCY CUT OFF TIME MODE SELECTION 5.30.1 5.30.1 5.30.1 5.30.2
Section 5
5-295
This command may be used to specify and apply the RESPONSE SPECTRUM loading for dynamic analysis.
General Format: SRSS * X f1 ACC SPECTRUM ABS Y f2 (SCALE f4) CQC Z f3 DIS ASCE TEN DAMP f5 LIN CDAMP ( ) (MIS f6) MDAMP LOG
(ZPA f7) (FF1 f8) (FF2 f9) (SAVE)
The data in the first line above must be on the first line of the command, the remaining data can be on the first or subsequent lines with all but last ending with a hyphen (limit of 3 lines ).
Starting on the next line, enter Spectra in one of these two input forms:
SRSS , ABS , CQC, ASCE4-98 & TEN Percent are methods of combining the responses from each mode into a total response. The CQC&ASCE4 methods require damping, ABS, SRSS, and TEN do not use damping unless Spectra-Period curves are made a function of damping (see File option below). CQC, ASCE and TEN include the effect of response magnification due to closely spaced modal frequencies. ASCE includes more algebraic summation of higher modes. ASCE & CQC are more sophisticated and realistic methods and are recommended. X Y Z f1, f2, f3 are the factors for the input spectrum to be applied in X, Y, & Z directions. Any one or all directions can be input. Directions not provided will default to zero.
5-296
Section 5
ACC or DIS indicates whether Acceleration or Displacement spectra will be entered. SCALE f4 = Scale factor by which the spectra data will be multiplied. Usually to factor gs to length/sec 2 units. DAMP , CDAMP , MDAMP. Select source of damping input.
f5 = Damping ratio for all modes. Default value is 0.05 (5% damping if 0 or blank entered). DAMP indicates to use the f5 value for all modes. CDAMP indicates to use Composite modal damping if entered, otherwise same as MDAMP. MDAMP indicates to use the damping entered or computed with the DEFINE DAMP command if entered, otherwise default value of 0.05 will be used.
LIN or LOG. Select linear or logarithmic interpolation of the input Spectra versus Period curves for determining the spectra value for a mode given its period. LIN is default. Since Spectra versus Period curves are often linear only on Log-Log scales, the logarithmic interpolation is recommended in such cases; especially if only a few points are entered in the spectra curve. For LIN or LOG , when FILE fn is entered, the interpolation along the damping axis will be linear. The last LIN-LOG parameter entered on all of the spectrum cases will be used for all spectrum cases. MIS f6 = Use Missing Mass method to include the static effect of the masses not represented in the modes. The spectral acceleration for this missing mass mode is the f6 value entered in length/sec 2 (this value is not multiplied by SCALE). If f6 is zero, then the spectral acceleration at the ZPA f7 frequency is used. If f7 is zero or not entered, then the spectral acceleration at 33Hz is used. The results of this calculation are SRSSed with the modal combination results. If the MIS parameter is entered on any spectrum case it will be used for all spectrum cases.
Section 5
5-297
ZPA f7 = For use with MIS option only. Defaults to 33 Hz if not entered. Value is printed but not used if MIS f6 is entered. FF1 f8 = The f1 parameter defined in the ASCE 4-98 standard in Hz units. For ASCE option only. Defaults to 2 Hz if not entered. FF2 f9 = The f2 parameter defined in the ASCE 4-98 standard in Hz units. For ASCE option only. Defaults to 33 Hz if not entered. Save = The save option results in the creation of a file (file name with "Acc" extension) containing the joint accelerations in gs and radians/sec 2 ______________________________________________________ SPECTRA data. Choose one of these two input forms. 1. P1, V1; P2, V2; . ; Pn, Vn . Data is part of input, immediately following SPECTRUM command. Period Value pairs (separated by semi colons) are entered to describe the Spectrum curve. Period is in seconds and the corresponding Value is either acceleration (current length unit/sec 2 ) or displacement (current length unit) depending on the ACC or DIS chosen. Continue the curve data onto as many lines as needed (up to 500 spectrum pairs). Spectrum pairs must be in ascending (or descending) order of period. Note, if data is in g acceleration units, then set SCALE to a conversion factor to the current length unit (9.807, 386.1, etc.). Also note, do not end these lines with a hyphen (-). Each SPECTRUM command must be followed by Spectra data if this input form is used.
2. FILE fn
Spectra Curves on FILE fn: When the File fn command has been provided, then you must have the spectra curve data on a file named fn prior to starting the analysis. The format of the FILE spectra data allows spectra as a function of damping as well as period. If the FILE fn command is entered, it must be with the first spectrum case and will be used for all spectrum cases. No FILE fn command needs to be entered with the
5-298
Section 5
remaining spectrum cases. The format is shown below. fn may not be more than 72 characters in length.
Square Root of Summation of Squares method. Complete Quadratic Combination method. Default. ASCE4-98 method. Absolute sum. (Very conservative worst case) Ten Percent Method of combining closely spaced modes. NRC Reg. Guide 1.92 (1976).
Description
See Sections 1.18.3, 5.30, and 5.34
This command should appear as part of a loading specification. If it is the first occurrence, it should be accompanied by the load data to be used for frequency and mode shape calculations. Additional occurrences need no additional information. Maximum response spectrum load cases allowed in one run is 4. Results of frequency and mode shape calculations may vary significantly depending upon the mass modeling. All masses that are capable of moving should be modeled as loads, applied in all possible directions of movement. For dynamic mass modeling, see sections 5.32 and 1.18.3. An illustration of mass modeling is available, with explanatory comments, in Example Problem No.11.
Section 5
5-299
Example LOAD 2 SPECTRUM IN X-DIRECTION SELFWEIGHT X 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Y 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Z 1.0 JOINT LOAD 10 FX 17.5 10 FY 17.5 10 FZ 17.5 SPECTRUM SRSS X 1.0 ACC SCALE 32.2 0.20 0.2 ; 0.40 0.25 ; 0.60 0.35 ; 0.80 0.43 ; 1.0 0.47 1.2 0.5 ; 1.4 0.65 ; 1.6 0.67 ; 1.8 0.55 ; 2.0 0.43
5-300
Section 5
The format of the FILE spectra data allows spectra as a function of damping as well as period. The format is: Data set 1 Data set 2 Data set 3a 3b MDAMPCV Periods Spectra NPOINTCV (no of values = 2) (no of values = Npointcv) (no of values = Npointcv) Damping Values in ascending order (no of values = Mdampcv)
Repeat Data set 3 Mdampcv times (3a,3b , 3a,3b , 3a,3b , etc.) (i.e. for each damping value). Data sets 3a and 3b must have exactly Npointcv values each. Blanks or commas separate the values. The data may extend to several lines. Do not end lines with a hyphen (-). No comment lines (*) or semicolons. Multiple values may be entered per line. MDAMPCV = Number of damping values for which there will be separate Spectra vs. Period curves. NPOINTCV = Number of points in each Spectra vs. Period curve. If NPOINTCV is negative, then the period-spectra values are entered as pairs.
Section 5
5-301
5.32.10.1.1 Response Spectrum Specification in Conjunction with the Indian IS: 1893 (Part 1)-2002 Code for Dynamic Analysis
Methodology
The design lateral shear force at each floor in each mode is computed by STAAD in accordance with the Indian IS: 1893 (Part 1)-2002 equations 7.8.4.5c and 7.8.4.5d.
Q ik = A k * ik *P k *W k and V ik =
i =i +1
Q ik
Note: All symbols and notations in the above equation are as per IS: 1893(Part 1)-2002. STAAD utilizes the following procedure to generate the lateral seismic loads. 1. User provides the value for
2. Program calculates time periods for first six modes or as specified by the user. 3. Program calculates S a /g for each mode utilizing time period and damping for each mode. 4. The program calculates design horizontal acceleration spectrum A k for different modes. 5. The program then calculates mode participation factor for different modes. 6. The peak lateral seismic force at each floor in each mode is calculated. 7. All response quantities for each mode are calculated. 8. The peak response quantities are then combined as per method (CQC or SRSS or ABS or TEN or CSM) as defined by the user to get the final results.
5-302
Section 5
General Format:
SPECTRUM {Method} 1893 (TOR) X f1 Y f2 Z f3 ACC (SCALE f4) (DAMP f5 or MDAMP or CDAMP) (MIS f6) (ZPA f7) SOIL TYPE f8
The data in the first line above must be on the first line of the command, the second line of data can be on the first or subsequent lines with all but last ending with a hyphen (limit of 3 lines ). The last line (Soil Type parameter) must be in a separate line. where,
Method = SRSS or CQC or ABS or CSM or TEN SRSS , CQC, ABS, CSM and TEN are methods of combining the responses from each mode into a total response. SRSS stands for square root of summation of squares, CQC for complete quadratic combination and ABS for Absolute method. CSM is a closelyspaced modes grouping method where the peak response quantities for closely spaced modes (considered to be within 10 percent of each other) are combined by Absolute method. This peak response quantity for closely spaced modes is then combined with those of widely spaced modes by SRSS method. TEN PERCENT method combines modal responses as published in US Nuclear Regulatory Guide 1.92 Revision 1 of February 1976. Note : CQC, SRSS and CSM Grouping methods are recommended by IS:1893 (Part 1) 2002. If SRSS is given, the program will internally check whether there are any closely spaced modes or not. If it finds any such modes, it will switch over to the CSM method. In the CSM method, the program will check whether all modes are closely spaced or not. If all modes are closely spaced, it will switch over to the CQC method. 1893 indicates procedures.
the
analysis
as
per
IS:1893(Part
1)-2002
Section 5
5-303
TOR indicates that the torsional moment (in the horizontal plane) arising due to eccentricity between the centre of mass and centre of rigidity needs to be considered. If TOR is entered on any one spectrum case it will be used for all spectrum cases. X Y Z f1, f2, f3 are the factors for the input spectrum to be applied in X, Y, & Z directions. These must be entered as the
product of
f5 = Damping ratio for all modes. Default value is 0.05 (5% damping if 0 or blank entered). DAMP indicates to use the f5 value for all modes. MDAMP indicates to use the damping entered or computed with the DEFINE DAMP command if entered, otherwise default value of 0.05 will be used. CDAMP is the composite damping of the structure calculated for each mode. One must specify damping for different materials under CONSTANT specification.
MIS f6 = Use Missing Mass method. The static effect of the masses not represented in the modes is included. The spectral acceleration for this missing mass mode is the f6 value entered in length/sec 2 (this value is not multiplied by SCALE). If f6 is zero, then the spectral acceleration at the ZPA f7 frequency is used. If f7 is zero or not entered, the spectral acceleration at 33Hz (Zero Period Acceleration, ZPA ) is used. The results of this calculation are SRSSed with the modal combination results. If the MIS
5-304
Section 5
parameter is entered on any spectrum case it will be used for all spectrum cases.
ZPA f7 = For use with MIS option only. Defaults to 33 Hz if not entered. Value is printed but not used if MIS f6 is entered. SOIL TYPE f8 = the types of soil. f8 is 1 for rocky or hard soil, 2 for medium soil and 3 for soft soil sites. Depending upon time period, types of soil and damping, average response acceleration coefficient, Sa/g is calculated. Notes:
1.
The design base shear V B (calculated from the Response Spectrum method) is compared with the base shear V b (calculated by empirical formula for the fundamental time period). If V B is less than V b , all of the response quantities are multiplied by V b /V B as per Clause 7.8.2. To have STAAD compute the empirical base shear V b , please enter the data described in Section 5.31.2.5 and place that data before the first load case in the STAAD input. STAAD does not calculate the fundamental frequency of the structure needed for the empirical base shear V b calculation; so you must enter either the ST parameter or the PX and PZ parameters in the Section 5.31.2.5 DEFINE 1893 LOAD data. The following interpolation formula is adopted for interpolation between damping values as given in Table 3. Interpolation and/or extrapolation of ground response acceleration for a particular mode has been made for determining the spectrum ordinates corresponding to the modal damping value for use in Response Spectrum analysis. The relationship that shall be used for this purpose is defined by :
2.
Sa =
Ae +
Section 5
5-305
A, B = Constants The constants A and B are determined using two known spectrum ordinates Sa 1 & Sa 2 corresponding to damping ratios 1 and 2 respectively for a particular time period and are as follows : A =
Sa 1 1 Sa 2 2
1e 2 e
1
B =
1 2 (Sa 2 e Sa 1e
1
1e
2e
where, 1 < < 2 3. The storey drift in any storey shall not exceed 0.004 times the storey height as per Clause 7.11.1. To check this, the following command should be given after the analysis command.
PRINT STOREY DRIFT
A warning message will be printed if storey drift exceeds this limitation. If any soft storey (as per definition in Table 5 of IS:1893-2002) is detected, a warning message will be printed in the output.
5-306
Section 5
This command may be used to specify and apply the RESPONSE SPECTRUM loading as per Eurocode 8 for dynamic analysis.
General Format: SRSS SPECTRUM ABS CQC ASCE TEN DAMP f4 CDAMP MDAMP * ELASTIC X f1 EURO Y f2 DESIGN Z f3 LIN ( ) (MIS f5) (ZPA f6) LOG
ACC
(SAVE)
The data in the first line above must be on the first line of the command, the remaining data can be on the first or subsequent lines with all but last ending with a hyphen (limit of 3 lines ).
Starting on the next line, the response spectra is input using following standard input parameters:
SOIL TYPE A
B C That is, unlike the custom defined response spectra the EC 8 response spectra is not input using frequency-acceleration pairs. Based on the type of Response Spectra(Elastic/Design), Soil Type, Alpha and Q the software generates the applicable response spectra curve using the guidelines of section 4.2.2 or 4.2.4 of Eurocode 8 as applicable.
SRSS , ABS , CQC, ASCE4-98 & TEN Percent are methods of combining the responses from each mode into a total response. CQC, ASCE and TEN include the effect of response magnification due to closely spaced modal frequencies. ASCE includes more
ALPHA f7 Q f8
Section 5
5-307
algebraic summation of higher modes. ASCE & CQC are more sophisticated and realistic methods and are recommended. The specifier EURO is mandatory to denote that the applied loading is as per the guidelines of Eurocode 8. The response spectrum loading can be based on either ELASTIC or DESIGN response spectra. Within the scope of Eurocode 8 the earthquake motion at a given point of the surface is generally represented by an elastic ground acceleration response spectrum termed as Elastic Response Spectrum. STAAD generates the Elastic Response Spectra using the guidelines of section 4.2.2 and Table 4.1 of Eurocode 8. The capacity of structural systems to resist seismic actions in the nonlinear range generally permits their design for forces smaller than those corresponding to a linear elastic response. To avoid explicit nonlinear structural analysis in design, the energy dissipation capacity of the structure through mainly ductile behaviour of its elements and/or other mechanisms, is taken into account by performing a linear analysis based on a response spectrum which is a reduced form of the corresponding elastic response spectrum. This reduction is accomplished by introducing the behaviour factor Q and the reduced response spectrum is termed as Design Response Spectrum. STAAD generates the Elastic Response Spectra using the guidelines of section 4.2.4 and Table 4.2 of Eurocode 8. So, if the structure is supposed to resist seismic actions in the nonlinear range the Design Response Spectra is to be used.
X Y Z f1, f2, f3 are the factors for the input spectrum to be applied in X, Y, & Z directions. Any one or all directions can be input. Directions not provided will default to zero. ACC indicates that the Acceleration spectra will be entered.Eurocode 8 does not provide displacement response spectra.
5-308
Section 5
DAMP , CDAMP , MDAMP . Select source of damping input. f4 = Damping ratio for all modes. Default value is 0.05 (5% damping if 0 or blank entered). DAMP indicates to use the f4 value for all modes. CDAMP indicates to use Composite modal damping if entered, otherwise same as MDAMP. MDAMP indicates to use the damping entered or computed with the DEFINE DAMP command if entered, otherwise default value of 0.05 will be used. LIN or LOG . Select linear or logarithmic interpolation of the input Spectra versus Period curves for determining the spectra value for a mode given its period. LIN is default. Since Spectra versus Period curves are often linear only on Log-Log scales, the logarithmic interpolation is recommended in such cases; especially if only a few points are entered in the spectra curve. For LIN or LOG , when FILE fn is entered, the interpolation along the damping axis will be linear. The last LIN-LOG parameter entered on all of the spectrum cases will be used for all spectrum cases. MIS f5 = Use Missing Mass method to include the static effect of the masses not represented in the modes. The spectral acceleration length/sec 2 for this missing mass mode is the f5 value entered in length per second squared units (this value is not multiplied by SCALE). If f5 is zero, then the spectral acceleration at the ZPA f6 frequency is used. If f6 is zero or not entered, then the spectral acceleration at 33Hz is used. The results of this calculation are SRSSed with the modal combination results. If the MIS parameter is entered on any spectrum case it will be used for all spectrum cases. ZPA f6 = For use with MIS option only. Defaults to 33 Hz if not entered. Value is printed but not used if MIS f5 is entered. Save = The save option results in the creation of a file (file name with "Acc" extension) containing the joint accelerations in gs and radians/sec 2
Section 5
5-309
Soil Type parameter is used to define the subsoil conditions based on which the response spectra will be generated. Based on the subsoil conditions the soil types may be of three kinds Type A : for Rock or stiff deposits of sand Type B :- for deep deposits of medium dense sand,gravel or medium stiff clays. Type C:- Loose cohesionless soil deposits or deposits with soft to medium stiff cohesive soil.
Please refer section 3.2 of Eurocode 8 for detailed guidelines regarding the choice of soil type.
ALPHA f7 :- Alpha is defined to be design ground acceleration expressed in terms of acceleration due to gravity(g).For most of the application of Eurocode 8 the hazard is described in terms of a single parameter,i.e., the value of effective peak ground acceleration in rock or firm soil ; this acceleration is termed as the design ground acceleration. Q f8 :- Q is the behaviour factor used to reduce the elastic reponse spectra to the design response spectra. The behaviour factor is an approximation of the ratio of the seismic forces, that the structure would experience, if its response was completely elastic with 5% viscous damping, to the minimum seismic forces that may be used in design- with a conventional linear model still ensuring a satisfactory response of the structure. Modal Combination Description
SRSS Square Root of Summation of Squares method. CQC Complete Quadratic Combination method. Default. ASCE ASCE4-98 method. ABS Absolute sum. (Very conservative worst case) TEN Ten Percent Method of combining closely spaced modes. NRC Reg. Guide 1.92 (1976).
5-310
Section 5
Description
See Sections 1.18.3, 5.30, and 5.34 of STAAD Technical Reference Manual
This command should appear as part of a loading specification. If it is the first occurrence, it should be accompanied by the load data to be used for frequency and mode shape calculations. Additional occurrences need no additional information. Maximum response spectrum load cases allowed in one run is 4. Results of frequency and mode shape calculations may vary significantly depending upon the mass modeling. All masses that are capable of moving should be modeled as loads, applied in all possible directions of movement. For dynamic mass modeling, see sections 5.32 and 1.18.3 of STAAD Technical Reference Manual. An illustration of mass modeling is available, with explanatory comments, in Example Problem No.11_EC8.
Example
LOAD 2 SPECTRUM IN X-DIRECTION SELFWEIGHT X 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Y 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Z 1.0 JOINT LOAD 10 FX 17.5 10 FY 17.5 10 FZ 17.5 MEMBER LOADS 5 CON GX 5.0 6.0 5 CON GY 5.0 6.0 5 CON GX 7.5 10.0 5 CON GY 7.5 10.0 5 CON GX 5.0 14.0 5 CON GY 5.0 14.0 SPECTRUM SRSS EURO ELASTIC X 1 ACC DAMP 0.05 LIN MIS 0 ZPA 40 SOIL TYPE A ALPHA 2 Q 1.5
Section 5
5-311
For special conditions more than one spectrum may be needed to adequately represent the seismic hazard over an area.This happens when the earthquake affecting the area are generated by sources varying widely in location and other parameters. In those cases different values of ALPHA as well as Q may be required to indicate the different shapes of response spectrum for each type of earthquake.
5-312
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to model Time History loading on the structure for Response Time History analysis. Nodal time histories and ground motion time histories may both be provided under one load case.
General format: TIME LOAD joint list
FX FY FZ MX MY MZ
X Y Z
It Ia f1
GROUND MOTION
It Ia f1
Where
I t = sequential position in the input data of type number of time varying load. To refer to first type number entered, use a 1 here regardless of actual type number entered. Ground Motion must have an Acceleration Type; Time Load forces must have a Force type; and Time Load moments must have a Moment Type (see Section 5.31.4). I a = arrival time number (see Section 5.31.4) (integer). This is the sequential number of the arrival time in the list explained in section 5.31.4. Thus the arrival time number of a 3 is 3 and of a n is n. f 1 = The Force, Moment, or Acceleration Amplitude at this joint and direction will be multiplied by this factor (default = 1.0). [ For accelerations, if the amplitude-time curve was in gs, please use the Scale Factor in the Define Time History
Section 5
5-313
command to convert gs to the acceleration units used in that command. This is recommended due to possible unit changes between that command and this command.]
Multiple loads at a joint-direction pair for a particular ( I t I a ) pair will be summed. However there can only be one ( I t I a ) pair associated with a particular joint-direction pair, the first such entry will be used. Loads at slave joint directions will be moved to the master without moment generation.
Either TIME LOAD or GROUND MOTION or both may be specified under one load case. More than one load case for time history analysis is not permitted. For TIME LOAD data, multiple direction specifiers can be in one entry as follows (the direction specifiers must be on one line and missing values are assumed to be 1):
TIME LOAD 2 3 FX 1 FZ 1 4 -2.1 MX 2 2 6 7 FX FY FZ Example LOAD 1 SELFWEIGHT X 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Y 1.0 SELFWEIGHT Z 1.0 MEMBER LOADS 5 CON GX 7.5 10.0 5 CON GY 7.5 10.0 5 CON GZ 7.5 10.0 TIME LOAD 2 3 FX 1 3 5 7 FX 1 6 GROUND MOTION X 2 1
5-314
Section 5
In the above example, the permanent masses in the structure are provided in the form of "selfweight" and "member loads" (see sections 5.32 and 1.18.3) for obtaining the mode shapes and frequencies. The rest of the data is the input for application of the time varying loads on the structure. Forcing function type 1 is applied at joints 2 and 3 starting at arrival time number 3. (Arrival time number 3 is 1.8 seconds in example shown in section 5.31.4). Similarly, forcing function type 1 is applied at joints 5 and 7 starting at arrival time number 6 (4.4 seconds). A ground motion (type 2) acts on the structure in the x-direction starting at arrival time number 1 (0.0 seconds).
Section 5
5-315
This command is used to create a primary load case using combinations of previously defined primary load cases.
General format: REPEAT LOAD i 1 , f 1 , i 2 , f 2 ... i n , f n
where, i 1 , i 2 ... i n = primary load case numbers f 1 , f 2 ... f n = corresponding factors This command can be continued to additional lines by ending all but last with a hyphen. Limit of 550 prior cases may be factored. Prior cases to be factored may also contain the REPEAT LOAD command.
Description
This command may be used to create a primary load case using combinations of previously defined primary load case(s). The REPEAT load differs from the load COMBINATION command (Section 5.35) in two ways: 1) A REPEAT LOAD is treated as a new primary load. Therefore, a P-Delta analysis will reflect correct secondary effects. (LOAD COMBINATIONS, on the other hand, algebraically combine the results such as displacements, member forces, reactions and stresses of previously defined primary load cases which were evaluated independently). 2) In addition to previously defined primary loads, the user can also add new loading conditions within a load case in which
5-316
Section 5
the REPEAT LOAD is used. 3) The REPEAT LOAD option is available with load cases with JOINT LOADS and MEMBER LOADS. It can also be used on load cases with ELEMENT PRESSURE loads and FIXED END LOADS. Modal dynamic analysis load cases (Response Spectrum, Time History, Steady State) should not be used in REPEAT LOAD. It is also not available for loads generated using some of the programs load generation facilities such as MOVING LOAD Generation. However load cases with WIND LOAD may be used in Repeat Load. UBC cases may only be used in REPEAT LOAD if there is a PERFORM ANALYSIS and CHANGE command after each UBC case. See notes with UBC LOAD command. Prestress on a given member from 2 or more load cases cannot be combined.
Section 5
5-317
Example LOAD 1 DL + LL SELFWEIGHT Y -1.4 MEMBER LOAD 1 TO 7 UNIFORM Y -3.5 LOAD 2 DL + LL + WL REPEAT LOAD 1 1.10
4) For a load case that is defined using the REPEAT LOAD attribute, the constituent load cases themselves can also be REPEAT LOAD cases. See load case 4 below.
LOAD 1 SELFWEIGHT Y 1.0 LOAD 2 MEMBER LOAD 2 UNI GY 1.5 LOAD 3 REPEAT LOAD 1 1.5 LOAD 4 REPEAT LOAD 2 1.2 3 1.25
5-318
Section 5
This command is used to generate Moving Loads, UBC Seismic loads and Wind Loads using previously specified load definitions. Primary load cases may be generated using previously defined load systems. The following sections describe generation of moving loads, UBC seismic loads and Wind Loads.
Pre-defined moving load system types may be used to generate the desired number of primary load cases, each representing a particular position of the moving load system on the structure. This procedure will simulate the movement of a vehicle in a specified direction on a specified plane on the structure.
General format: LOAD GENERATION n TYPE * XINC j x 1 y1 z 1 YINC ZINC (ADD LOAD f1 f2 f3 ( i)
YRANGE r) ZRANGE
= total no. of primary load cases to be generated. = load case no. for the previously defined load case to be added to the generated loads. j = type no. of previously defined load system. x 1 , y 1 , z 1 = x, y and z coordinates (global) of the initial position of the reference load. f 1 , f 2 f 3 = x, y or z (global) increments of position of load system to be used for generation of subsequent load cases. r = (Optional) defines section of the structure along global vertical direction to carry moving load. This r value is added and subtracted to the reference vertical
where, n i
Section 5
5-319
coordinate (y 1 or z 1 )in the global vertical direction to form a range. The moving load will be externally distributed among all members within the vertical range thus generated. r always should be a positive number. In other words, the program always looks for members lying in the range Y 1 and Y 1 +ABS(r) or Z 1 and Z 1 +ABS(r). The default r value is very small, so entering r is recommended. The ADD LOAD specification may be used to add a previously defined load case to all the load cases generated by the LOAD GENERATION command. In the example below, the SELFWEIGHT specified in load case 1 is added to all the generated load cases. Sequential load case numbers will be assigned to the series of generated primary load cases. Numbering will begin at one plus the highest previous load case number. Allow for these when specifying load cases after load case generation.
Notes
1.
Primary load cases can be generated from Moving Load systems for frame members only. This feature does not work on finite elements. This facility works best when the roadway, as well as the movement of the vehicle are along one of the global X or Z directions. For bridge decks which are skewed with respect to the global axes, the load generation may not yield the most satisfactory results. In such cases, the STAAD.Beava program, which is an add-on module to STAAD.Pro, is recommended. That program works on the influence line/influence surface method, and is considerably superior to the moving load generator described in this section. It also has the advantage of being able to calculate the critical load positions on decks modelled using plate elements, something which this facility cannot at present.
2.
5-320
Section 5
3.
The x 1 , y 1 , z 1 values of the starting position of the reference wheel must be provided bearing in mind that the reference wheel has to be at the elevation of the deck. An improper set of values of these parameters may result in the wheels being positioned incorrectly, and consequently, no load may be generated at all.
Example LOAD 1 DL ONLY SELFWEIGHT LOAD GENERATION 20 ADD LOAD 1 TYPE 1 0. 5. 10. XI 10. TYPE 2 0. 10. 10. ZI 15. LOAD 22 LIVE LOAD ON PAVEMENT MEMB LOAD 10 TO 20 30 TO 40 UNI GY -5.0 LOAD COMBINATION 31 10 0.75 22 0.75 PERFORM ANALYSIS
Built-in algorithms will automatically distribute the base shear among appropriate levels and the roof per the relevant code specifications. The following general format should be used to generate loads in a particular direction.
General Format: LOAD i UBC LOAD
X Y Z
(f1)
(ACC
f2)
Where UBC may be replaced by: IBC , 1893 , AIJ , COL, CFE, NTC or RPA
Section 5
5-321
where i f1 f2
= load case number = factor to be used to multiply the UBC Load (default = 1.0). May be negative. = factor to be used to multiply the UBC, IBC, 1893, etc. Accidental torsion load (default = 1.0). May be negative.
Example DEFINE UBC LOAD ZONE 0.2 K 1.0 I 1.5 TS 0.5 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 1 TO 100 WEIGHT 5.0 101 TO 200 WEIGHT 7.5 LOAD 1 UBC IN X-DIRECTION UBC LOAD X JOINT LOAD 5 25 30 FY -17.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 2 UBC IN Z-DIRECTION UBC LOAD Z PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 3 DEAD LOAD SELFWEIGHT LOAD COMBINATION 4 1 0.75 2 0.75 3 1.0
In the above example, notice that the first two load cases are UBC load cases. They are specified before any other load cases.
Notes
1) The UBC load cases should be provided as the first set of load cases. Non-UBC primary load case specified before a UBC load case is not acceptable. Additional loads such as
5-322
Section 5
MEMBER LOADS and JOINT LOADS may be specified along with the UBC load under the same load case. 2) If the UBC cases are to be factored later in a Repeat Load command; or if the UBC case is to be used in a tension/compression analysis; or if Re-analysis (2 analysis commands without a CHANGE or new load case in between); then each UBC case should be followed by PERFORM ANALYSIS then CHANGE commands as shown in the example above. Otherwise the PERFORM ANALYSIS then CHANGE can be omitted. Using the CHANGE command will require the SET NL command to define the maximum number of load cases being entered in the analysis. Also LOAD LIST ALL should be entered after the last PERFORM ANALYSIS command. 3) Up to 8 UBC cases may be entered.
Incorrect usage LOAD 1 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 LOAD 2 JOINT LOAD 3 FX 45 LOAD 3 UBC LOAD X 1.2 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 LOAD 4 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 MEMBER LOAD 3 UNI GY -4.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS
Section 5
5-323
Correct usage SET NL 10 LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 1.2 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 2 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 MEMBER LOAD 3 UNI GY -4.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 3 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 LOAD 4 JOINT LOAD 3 FX 45 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST ALL
5-324
Section 5
Incorrect usage LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 PDELTA ANALYSIS LOAD 2 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 PDELTA ANALYSIS Correct usage LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 PDELTA ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 2 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y 1 JOINT LOAD 3 FY -4.5 PDELTA ANALYSIS CHANGE
Section 5
5-325
4)
REPEAT LOAD specification cannot be used for load cases involving UBC load generation unless each UBC case is followed by an analysis command then CHANGE. For example,
Correct usage LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 1.0 PDELTA ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 PDELTA ANALYSIS CHANGE LOAD 3 REPEAT LOAD 1 1.4 2 1.2 PDELTA ANALYSIS
5)
If UBC load generation is performed for the X and the Z(or Y if Z up) directions, the command for the X direction must precede the command for the Z(or Y if Z up) direction.
Incorrect usage LOAD 1 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y- 1 LOAD 2 UBC LOAD X 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 PDELTA ANALYSIS
5-326
Section 5
Correct usage LOAD 1 UBC LOAD X 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 LOAD 2 UBC LOAD Z 1.2 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 PDELTA ANALYSIS
The following general format should be used to generate the IS 1893 load in a particular direction.
General Format: LOAD i
1893 LOAD
X Y Z
(f)
where i = load case number f = factor to be used to multiply the 1893 Load (default = 1.0)
Section 5
5-327
Example DEFINE 1893 LOAD ZONE 0.05 RF 1.0 I 1.5 SS 1.0 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT 7 TO 12 WEIGHT 17.5 13 TO 30 WEIGHT 18.0 MEMBER WEIGHT 1 TO 20 UNI 2.0 LOAD 1 1893 LOAD IN X-DIRECTION 1893 LOAD X JOINT LOAD 5 25 30 FY -17.5 LOAD 2 1893 LOAD IN Z-DIRECTION 1893 LOAD Z LOAD 3 DEAD LOAD SELFWEIGHT LOAD COMBINATION 4 1 0.75 2 0.75 3 1.0
In the above example, the first two load cases are the 1893 load cases. They are specified before any other load case.
5-328
Section 5
General Format:
LOAD WIND LOAD i X Z (f) TYPE j (OPEN) XR YR ZR f1, f2 f1, f2 f1, f2
Where i Load case number X, -X, Z or -Z Direction of wind in global axis system. j Type number of previously defined systems f The factor to be used to multiply the wind loads. Negative signs may be used to indicate opposite direction of resulting load (default=1.0) global coordinate values to specify X or Y or Z f 1 and f 2 range for member selection. OPEN optional word to be used if loading is to be generated on open-type of structures. If this not specified, load will be generated assuming the panels are closed. X, -X, Z or Z [A minus sign indicates that suction occurs on the other side of the selected structure.] and the f factor. If all of the members are selected and X (or Z) is used and the factor is positive, then the exposed surfaces facing in the x (or z) direction will be loaded in the positive x (or z) direction (normal wind in positive direction). See diagrams that follow. If X and a negative factor is used, then the exposed surfaces facing in the +x direction will be loaded in the negative x direction (normal wind in negative direction). [If X is entered and a negative factor, then the exposed surfaces facing in the -x direction will be loaded in the negative x direction (suction). If X is entered and a positive factor, then the exposed surfaces facing in the +x direction will be loaded in the positive x direction (suction).]
Section 5
Y Y
5-329
X or Z
X or Z
X or Z
Y
+f
Y
-X or -Z
+f
X or Z
X or Z
X or Z
-f
-X or -Z
-f
Figure 5.38
A member list or a range of coordinate values (in global system) may be used. All members which have both end coordinates within the range are assumed to be candidates (for closed type structures) for defining a surface which may be loaded if the surface is exposed to the wind. The loading will be in the form of joint loads (not member loads). 1, 2 or 3 ranges can be entered to form a layer, tube or box for selecting members in the combined ranges. Use ranges to speed up the calculations on larger models.
Example DEFINE WIND LOAD TYPE 1 INTENSITY 0.1 0.12 HEIGHT 100 200 EXP 0.6 JOI 1 TO 25 BY 7 29 TO 37 BY 4 22 23 TYPE 2 INT 0.1 0.12 HEIGHT 100 900 EXP 0.3 YR 0 500 LOAD 1 SELF Y -1.0 LOAD 2
5-330
Section 5
WIND LOAD Z 1.2 TYPE 2 ZR 10 11 LOAD 3 WIND LOAD X TYPE 1 XR 7 8 ZR 14 16 LOAD 4 SUCTION ON LEEWARD SIDE WIND LOAD -X 1.2 LIST 21 22 42 Example for open structures LOAD 1 WIND LOAD IN Z DIRECTION WIND LOAD 2 -1.2 TYPE 1 OPEN Notes
Please do not use a SET Z UP command in a model with wind load. 1. For closed type structures, panels or closed surfaces are generated by the program based on the members in the ranges specified and their end joints. The area within each closed surface is determined and the share of this area (influence area) for each node in the list is then calculated. The individual bounded areas must be planar surfaces, to a close tolerance, or they will not be loaded. Hence, one should make sure that the members/joints that are exposed to the wind make up a closed surface (ground may form an edge of the closed surface). Without a proper closed surface, the area calculated for the region may be indeterminate and the joint force values may be erroneous. Consequently, the number of exposed joints should be at least three.
Section 5
5-331
2. Plates and solids are not considered for wind load generation. On such entities, wind must be applied using pressure loading facilities for plates and solids.
5-332
Section 5
This command is used to generate Snow Loads using previously specified Snow load definitions. This input should be a part of a load case.
where, _flr_grp = The members that form the roof and that are to be loaded by snow load must be listed in a floor group. See section 5.16. j = type no. of previously defined snow load system. = CS value. Default = 0.0 f1 BALA or UNBA = Balanced or unbalanced snow load. Default is balanced. OBST or UNOB = Obstructed or unobstructed. Default is unobstructed. MONO or HIP or GABLE= Roof type. Default is MONO. Use as many floor groups and types as necessary in each load case.
Section 5
5-333
This command may be used to calculate the Rayleigh method approximate frequency of the structure for vibration corresponding to the general direction of deflection generated by the load case that precedes this command. Thus, this command typically follows a load case.
General format: CALCULATE RAYLEIGH (FREQUENCY)
Description
This command is specified after all other load specifications of any primary load case for which the Rayleigh frequency is calculated. This Rayleigh frequency calculation is based on the Rayleigh iteration method using 1 iteration. If a more accurate, full-scale eigensolution is required, the MODAL CALCULATION command (see next section) may be used. A full eigensolution is automatically performed if a RESPONSE SPECTRUM or TIME HISTORY is specified in any load case.
Example LOADING 1 DEAD AND LIVE LOAD AREA LOAD 1 TO 23 ALOAD -200.0 CALCULATE RAYLEIGH FREQ LOADING 2 WIND LOAD
5-334
Section 5
In this example, the Rayleigh frequency for load case 1 will be calculated. The output will produce the value of the frequency in cycles per second (cps), the maximum deflection along with the global direction and the joint number where it occurs. Since the AREA LOAD is in the global Y direction, the displaced shape to be used as the mode will be in the Y direction. If you want a mode or frequency to be for lateral motion (X or Z), then enter the loads in the X or Z directions. Entering loads in the vertical direction when the first mode is in the lateral direction is a common mistake.
Notes
This command is based on the Rayleigh method of iteration using 1 iteration. The frequency calculated estimates the frequency as if the structure were constrained to vibrate in the static deflected shape generated by the loads in the load case.
Section 5
5-335
This command may be used to obtain a full scale eigensolution to calculate relevant frequencies and mode shapes. It should not be entered if this case or any other case is a TIME LOAD or RESPONSE SPECTRUM case.
General Format: MODAL (CALCULATION REQUESTED)
This command is typically used in a load case after all loads are specified. The loads will be treated as weights and weight moment of inertias for eigensolutions (see sections 1.18.3 and 5.32). The user is advised to specify the loads keeping this in mind. This case will be independently solved statically and dynamically. Static results using the loads will include joint displacements, member forces, support reactions, and other outputs computed from a normal static analysis without any dynamic effects included. In addition, the Dynamic results (using loads as masses) will include Mode Shapes and Frequencies.
Notes
The MODAL CALCULATION command can be included in any of the primary load cases, but only in one of them.
5-336
Section 5
This command may be used to combine the results of the analysis. The combination may be algebraic, SRSS, a combination of both, or ABSolute.
General format: LOAD COMBINATION
SRSS ABS i a 1
i 1 , f 1 , i 2 , f 2 ...
(f srss )
= Load combination number ( any integer smaller than 100000 that is not the same as any previously defined primary load case number.) = Any title for the load combination. a1 i 1 , i 2 ... represents the load case numbers which are to be combined. f 1 , f 2 ... represents corresponding factors to be applied to loadings. A value of 0.0 is also allowed. f SRSS = optional factor to be applied as a multiplying factor on the combined result of the SRSS load combination (see examples below). If the last character on a line is a hyphen, then the command is continued on the next line. A limit of 550 prior cases may be factored in one command.
Notes
1)
In the LOAD COMBINATION SRSS option, if the minus sign precedes any load case no., then that load case will be combined algebraically with the SRSS combination of the rest.
Section 5
5-337
2)
3)
The total number of primary and combination load cases combined cannot exceed the limit described in section 5.2 of this manual. A value of zero (0) as a load factor is permitted. See Notes item (3) later in this section for more details..
Description
LOAD COMBINATION ABS Absolute value of results from the analyses will be combined.
LOAD COMBINATION ABS 7 DL+LL+WL 1 0.85 2 0.65 3 2.12
LOAD COMBINATION SRSS Results from analyses may be combined both algebraically and using the SRSS (Square Root of Summation of Squares) method. The combination scheme may be mixed if required. For example, in the same load combination case, results from load cases may be combined in the SRSS manner and then combined algebraically with other load cases. Note that the case factor is not squared. If some of the factors are negative, then the sum of the factored squares may become negative. If negative, the SQRT will be of the absolute value and the result of the SQRT will be set negative. Refer to the following examples for illustration Example
Several combination examples are provided to illustrate the possible combination schemes -
5-338
Section 5
This (LOAD COMBINATION SRSS 8) illustrates a pure SRSS load combination with a default SRSS factor of 1. The following combination scheme will be used v= 1.0 1 x L1 2 - 0.4 x L2 2 + 0.4 x L3 2
where v = the combined value and L1 - L3 = values from load cases 1,2 and 3. Since an SRSS factor is not provided, the default value of 1.0 is being used.
Algebraic & SRSS Combination in the Same Load Combination Case
where v = combined value L2 & L3 = values from load cases 2 & 3. In the above specification, a minus sign precedes load case 1. Thus, Load 1 is combined algebraically with the result obtained from combining load cases 2 and 3 in the SRSS manner. The SRSS factor of 0.75 is applied on the SRSS combination of 2 and 3.
Section 5
5-339
Here, both load cases 1 and 2 are combined algebraically with the SRSS combination of load cases 3 and 4. Note the SRSS factor of 0.63. The combination formula will be as follows. v = 0.75 x L1 + 0.572 x L2 + 0.63
Notes
1.2 x L3 2 + 1.7 x L4 2
1) This option combines the results of the analysis in the specified manner. It does not analyze the structure for the combined loading. 2) If the secondary effects of combined load cases are to be obtained through a PDELTA , Member/Spring Tension/Compression, Multi-linear Spring, or Nonlinear Analysis, then the LOAD COMBINATION command is inappropriate for the purpose. See the REPEAT LOAD command (section 5.32.11) for details. 3) In a load combination specification, a value of 0 (zero) as a load factor is permitted. In other words, a specification such as
LOAD COMB 7 1 1.35 2 0.0 3 1.2 4 0.0 5 1.7
5-340
Section 5
4) All combination load cases must be provided immediately after the last primary load case. 5) The maximum number of load cases that can be combined using a LOAD COMBINATION command is 550.
Section 5
5-341
5-342
Section 5
STAAD analysis options include linear static analysis, P-Delta (or second order analysis), and several types of Dynamic analysis. This command is used to specify the analysis request. In addition, this command may be used to request that various analysis related data, like load info, statics check info, etc. be printed.
General format:
LOAD DATA PERFORM STATICS CHECK ANALYSIS (PRINT STATICS LOAD PERFORM CABLE PERform IMPerfection
BOTH ALL
This command directs the program to perform the analysis that includes: a) b) c) d) e) f) Checking whether all information is provided for the analysis; Forming the joint stiffness matrix; Checking the stability of the structure; Solving simultaneous equations, and Computing the member forces and displacements. If P-Delta analysis is specified, forces and displacements are recalculated, taking into consideration the P-Delta effect.
Section 5
5-343
g) If a RESPONSE SPECTRUM or TIME LOAD is specified within a load case or the MODAL CALCULATION command is used, a dynamic analysis is performed. h) In each of the "n" iterations of the PDELTA analysis, the load vector will be modified to include the secondary effect generated by the displacements caused by the previous analysis. There are two options to carry out P-Delta analysis. 1) When the CONVERGE command is not specified: The member end forces are evaluated by iterating n times. The default value of n is 1 (one). 2) When the CONVERGE command is included: The member end forces are evaluated by performing a convergence check on the joint displacements. In each step, the displacements are compared with those of the previous iteration in order to check whether convergence is attained. In case m is specified, the analysis will stop after that iteration even if convergence has not been achieved. If convergence is achieved in less than m iterations, the analysis is terminated. (DO NOT ENTER n when CONVERGE is provided) 3) To set convergence displacement tolerance, enter SET DISPLACEMENT f command. Default is maximum span of the structure divided by 120.
Example
Followings are some example on use of the command for P-Delta analysis.
PDELTA PDELTA PDELTA PDELTA ANALYSIS 5 ANALYSIS ANALYSIS CONVERGE ANALYSIS CONVERGE 5
5-344
Section 5
Without one of these analysis commands, no analysis will be performed. These ANALYSIS commands can be repeated if multiple analyses are needed at different phases. A PDELTA ANALYSIS will correctly reflect the secondary effects of a combination of load cases only if they are defined using the REPEAT LOAD specification (Section 5.32.11). Secondary effects will not be evaluated correctly for LOAD COMBINATIONS. An Imperfection analysis will reflect the secondary effects only if the camber and/or drift is specified in a DEFINE IMPERFECTIONS specification (Section 5.26.6). For combination of load cases, with imperfection, use the Repeat Load specification rather than the Load Combination. If the PRINT LOAD DATA command is specified, the program will print an interpretation of all the load data. PRINT STATICS CHECK will provide a summation of the applied loads and support reactions as well as a summation of moments of the loads and reactions taken around the origin. PRINT STATICS LOAD prints everything that PRINT STATICS CHECK does, plus it prints a summation of all internal and external forces at each joint (generates voluminous output). Use the PRINT MODE SHAPES command separately after this command if mode shapes are desired. PRINT BOTH is equivalent to PRINT LOAD DATA plus PRINT STATICS CHECK. PRINT ALL is equivalent to PRINT LOAD DATA plus PRINT STATICS LOAD. In addition to the above Print parameters, there are additional parameters that may be specified for Cable Analysis:
Section 5
5-345
f1 f2 f3 f4 f6 f7
This command may be continued to the next line by ending with a hyphen. Steps = Number of load steps. The applied loads will be applied gradually in this many steps. Each step will be iterated to convergence. Default is 145. The f1 value, if entered, should be in the range 5 to 145.
Eq-iterations = Maximum number of iterations permitted in each load step. Default is 300. Should be in the range of 10 to 500. Eq-tolerance = The convergence tolerance for the above iterations. Default is 0.0001. Sag minimum = Cables (not trusses) may sag when tension is low. This is accounted for by reducing the E value. Sag minimum may be between 1.0 (no sag E reduction) and 0.0 (full sag E reduction). Default is 0.0. As soon as SAGMIN becomes less than 0.95 the possibility exists that a converged solution will not be achieved without increasing the steps to 145 or the pretension loads. The Eq iterations may need to be 300 or more. The Eq tolerance may need to be greater or smaller. Stability stiffness = A stiffness matrix value, f5, that is added to the global matrix at each translational direction for joints connected to cables and nonlinear trusses for the first f6 load steps. The amount added linearly decreases with each of the f6 load steps (f6 is 1 if omitted). If f5 entered, use 0.0 to 1000.0. Default is 1.0.
5-346
Section 5
This parameter alters the stiffness of the structure. K small stiffness = A stiffness matrix value, f7, that is added to the global matrix at each translational direction for joints connected to cables and nonlinear trusses for every load step. If entered, use 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 . This parameter alters the stiffness of the structure.
Notes
STAAD allows multiple analyses in the same run. Multiple analyses may be used for the following purposes: 1) Successive analysis and design cycles in the same run result in optimized design. STAAD automatically updates changes in member cross-sectional sizes. Thus the entire process is automated. Refer to Example 1 in the Getting Started & Examples manual for detailed illustration. 2) Multiple analyses may be used for load-dependent structures. For example, structures with bracing members are analyzed in several steps. The bracing members are assumed to take Tension load only. Thus, they need to be activated and inactivated based on the direction of lateral loading. The entire process can be modeled in one STAAD run using multiple PERFORM ANALYSIS commands. STAAD is capable of performing a design based on the load combinations provided. Refer to Example 4 in the Getting Started & Examples manual for detailed illustration. 3) The user may also use Multiple Analyses to model change in other characteristics like SUPPORTS, RELEASES, SECTION PROPERTIES etc. 4) Multiple Analyses may require use of additional commands like the SET NL command and the CHANGE command.
Section 5
5-347
5) PDELTA effects are computed for frame members and plate elements only. They are not calculated for solid elements. 6) Analysis and CHANGE are required between primary cases for PERFORM CABLE ANALYSIS. 7) Analysis and CHANGE are required after UBC cases if the case is subsequently referred to in a Repeat Load command or if the UBC case will be re-solved after a Select command or after a Multiple analysis.
5-348
Section 5
This command is used to reset the stiffness matrix. Typically, this command is used when multiple analyses are required in the same run.
General format: CHANGE
This command indicates that input, which will change the stiffness matrix, will follow. This command should only be used when an analysis has already been performed. The CHANGE command does or requires the following: a) sets the stiffness matrix to zero, b) makes members active if they had been made inactive by a previous INACTIVE command, and c) allows the re-specification of the supports with another SUPPORT command that causes the old supports to be ignored. The SUPPORT specification must be such that the number of joint directions that are free to move (DOF or "releases") before the CHANGE must be greater than or equal to the number of "releases" after the CHANGE. d) Also, the supports must be specified in the same order before and after the CHANGE command. To accomplish this when some cases have more supports than others do, you can enter unrestrained joints into the SUPPORT command list using FIXED BUT FX FY FZ MX MY MZ. It is best to put every joint that will be supported in any case into every SUPPORT list. e) CHANGE, if used, should be after PERFORM ANALYSIS and before the next set of SUPPORT, LOADS. f) Only active cases are processed after the CHANGE command.
Section 5
5-349
g) Analysis and CHANGE are required between primary cases for PERFORM CABLE ANALYSIS. h) Analysis and CHANGE are required after UBC cases if the case is subsequently referred to in a Repeat Load command or if the UBC case will be re-solved after a Select command or after a Multiple analysis.
Example
Before CHANGE
1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ 3 FIXED BUT FX MX MY MZ
After CHANGE
1 PINNED 2 FIXED 3 FIXED BUT FX MZ
The CHANGE command is not necessary when only member properties are revised to perform a new analysis. This is typically the case in which the user has asked for a member selection and then uses the PERFORM ANALYSIS command to reanalyze the structure based on the new member properties.
Notes
1) If new load cases are specified after the CHANGE command such as in a structure where the INACTIVE MEMBER command is used, the user needs to define the total number of primary load cases using the SET NL option (see Section 5.5 and Example 4). 2) Multiple Analyses using the CHANGE command should not be performed if the input file contains load cases involving Response Spectrum Analysis, Time History Analysis, or Moving Load Generation.
5-350
Section 5
3) Section forces and moments, stress and other results for postprocessing will use the last entered data for supports and member properties regardless of what was used to compute the displacements, end forces and reactions. So beware of changing member properties and releases after a CHANGE command.
Section 5
5-351
This command allows specification of a set of active load cases. All load cases made active by this command remain active until a new load list is specified.
General format:
LOAD LIST
load-list ALL
Description
This command is used to activate the load cases listed in this command and, in a sense, deactivate all other load cases not listed in this command. In other words, the loads listed are used for printing output and in design for performing the specified calculations. When the PERFORM ANALYSIS command is used, the program internally uses all load cases, regardless of LOAD LIST command, except after a CHANGE command. In these two cases, the LOAD LIST command allows the program to perform analysis only on those loads in the list. If the LOAD LIST command is never used, the program will assume all load cases to be active.
Example LOAD LIST ALL PRINT MEMBER FORCES LOAD LIST 1 3 PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS CHECK CODE ALL
5-352
Section 5
In this example, member forces will be printed for all load cases, whereas loading 1 and 3 will be used for printing support reactions and code-checking of all members.
Notes
The LOAD LIST command may be used for multiple analyses situations when a re-analysis needs to be performed with a selected set of load cases only. All load cases are automatically active before a the first CHANGE command is used. After a CHANGE command has been used anywhere in the data, it is good practice to specify the LOAD LIST command after an ANALYSIS command and before the next command; otherwise only the last case analyzed may be used in the design. Do not enter this command within the loads data (from the first Load command in an analysis set down to the associated Analysis command).
Section 5
5-353
This command is used to specify intermediate sections along the length of frame member for which forces and moments are required.
General format:
Description
This command specifies the sections, in terms of fractional member lengths, at which the forces and moments are considered for further processing.
See Sections 1.19.2,and 1.19.4
f 1 , f 2 ... f 3 = Section (in terms of the fraction of the member length) provided for the members. Maximum number of sections is 3, and only values between 0.0 and 1.0 will be considered. In other words, no more than three intermediate sections are permissible per SECTION command.
Example SECTION 0.17 0.48 0.72 MEMB 1 2 SECTION 0.25 0.75 MEMB 3 TO 7 SECTION 0.6 MEMB 8
In the above example, first, section locations of 0.17, 0.48, and 0.72 are set for members 1 and 2. In the next SECTION command, sections 0.25 and 0.75 are set for members 3 to 7. In the third SECTION command, member 8 has its section specified at 0.6. The remainder of the members will have no sections provided for
5-354
Section 5
them. As mentioned earlier, no more than three intermediate sections are allowed per SECTION command. However, if more than three intermediate sections are desired, they can be examined by repeating the SECTION command after completing the required calculations. The following example will clarify.
Example SECTION 0.2 0.4 0.5 ALL PRINT SECTION FORCES SECTION 0.6 0.75 0.9 ALL PRINT SECTION FORCES
In this example, forces at 3 intermediate sections (namely 0.2, 0.4 and 0.5) are printed. Then forces at an additional 3 sections (namely 0.6, 0.75 and 0.9) are printed. This gives the user the ability to obtain section forces at more than three intermediate sections.
Notes
1) The SECTION command just specifies the sections. Use the PRINT SECTION FORCES command after this command to print out the forces and moments at the specified sections. 2) This is a secondary analysis command. The analysis must be performed before this command may be used. 3) To obtain values at member ends (START and END), use the PRINT MEMBER FORCES command. 4) If this command is specified before a steel design operation, and if the BEAM parameter is set to zero, the section locations specified by this command will also be designed for, in addition to the BEAM ends.
Section 5
5-355
This command is used to direct the program to print various modeling information and analysis results. STAAD offers a number of versatile print commands that can be used to customize the output.
General format for data related print commands:
JOINT COORDINATES MEMBER INFORMATION ELEMENT INFORMATION (SOLID) MEMBER PROPERTIES MATERIAL PROPERTIES SUPPORT INFORMATION or ALL
PRINT CG
( _group_name )
(JOINT) DISPLACEMENTS (MEMBER) FORCES ANALYSIS RESULTS (MEMBER) SECTION FORCES (MEMBER) STRESSES ELEMENT (JOINT) STRESSES (AT f1 f2) ELEMENT FORCES ELEMENT (JOINT) STRESSES SOLID MODE SHAPES
List spec
5-356
Section 5
General format to print support reactions: PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS General format to print story drifts: PRINT STORY DRIFT
Description
The list of items is not applicable for PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS and PRINT MODE SHAPES commands. The PRINT JOINT COORDINATES command prints all interpreted coordinates of joints. The PRINT MEMBER INFORMATION command prints all member information, including member length, member incidences, beta angles, whether or not a member is a truss member and the member release conditions at start and end of the member (1=released, 0 = not released). The PRINT ELEMENT INFORMATION command prints all incident joints, element thicknesses, and Poisson ratios for Plate/Shell elements. The PRINT ELEMENT INFORMATION SOLID command prints similar information for Solid elements. The PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES command prints all member properties including cross sectional area, moments of inertia, and section moduli in both axes. Units for the properties are always INCH or CM (depending on FPS or METRIC) regardless of the unit specified in UNIT command.
Section 5
5-357
The following designation is used for member property names: AX AY AZ IZ IY IX SY SZ Cross section area Area used to compute shear deformation in local Y-axis Area used to compute shear deformation in local Z-axis Moment of Inertia about the local Z-axis Moment of Inertia about the local Y-axis Torsional constant Smallest section modulus about the local Y-axis Smallest section modulus about the local Z-axis
The PRINT MATERIAL PROPERTIES command prints all material properties for the members, including E (modulus of elasticity), G (shear modulus), weight density and coefficient of thermal expansion (alpha) for frame members. This command is available for members only. G may be listed as zero if command is before load cases and Poisson ratio was entered but G was not entered. The PRINT SUPPORT INFORMATION command prints all support information regarding their fixity, releases and spring constant values, if any. The LIST option is not available for this command. The PRINT ALL command is equivalent to last five print commands combined. This command prints joint coordinates, member information, member properties, material properties and support information, in that order. The PRINT CG command prints out the coordinates of the center of gravity and the total weight of the structure or of a single group of member/elements. If the CG of a portion of the structure is desired, the members and elements of that portion must be assigned using a group name (see section 5.16 for details on using group-names). Only the selfweight of the structure is used to calculate the C.G. User defined joint loads, member loads etc. are not considered in the calculation of C.G.
5-358
Section 5
The PRINT (JOINT) DISPLACEMENTS command prints joint displacements in a tabulated form. The displacements for all six global directions will be printed for all specified load cases. The length unit for the displacements is always INCH or CM (depending on FPS or METRIC unit) regardless of the unit specified in UNIT command. The PRINT (MEMBER) FORCES command prints member forces (i.e. Axial force (AXIAL), Shear force in local Y and Z axes (SHEAR-Y and SHEAR-Z), Torsional Moment (TORSION), Moments about local Y and Z axes (MOM-Y and MOM-Z)) in a tabulated form for the listed members, for all specified load cases. The PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS command prints global support reactions in a tabulated form, by support, for all specified load cases. Use LIST option for selected joints. PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS command is equivalent to the above three commands combined. With this command, the joint displacements, support reactions and member forces, in that order, are printed. The PRINT (MEMBER) SECTION FORCES command prints shears & bending moments at the intermediate sections specified with a previously input SECTION command. The printing is done in a tabulated form for all specified cases for the first requested member, then for the next member, etc. The PRINT (MEMBER) STRESSES command tabulates member stresses at the start joint, end joint and all specified intermediate sections. These stresses include axial (i.e. axial force over the area), bending-y (i.e. moment-y over section modulus in local yaxis), bending-z (i.e. moment-z over section modulus in local zaxis), shear stresses in both local y and z directions (FY/AY and FZ/AZ) and combined (absolute combination of axial, bending-y and bending-z) stresses.
Section 5
5-359
For PRISMATIC sections, if AY and/or AZ is not provided, the full cross-sectional area (AX) will be considered in shear stress calculations. For TAPERED sections, the values of AY and AZ are those for the location where the stress is printed. Hence if the stress is printed at the location 0.0, the AY at AZ are based on the dimensions of the member at the start node. AY = Total depth * Thickness of web. AZ = 2/3 area of both flanges put together. The PRINT ELEMENT STRESSES command must be used to print plate stresses (SX, SY, SXY, SQX, SQY), moments per unit width (MX, MY, MXY) and principal stresses (SMAX, SMIN, TMAX) for plate/shell elements. Typically, the stresses and moments per unit width at the centroid will be printed. The Von Mises stresses (VONT, VONB) as well as the angle (ANGLE) defining the orientation of the principal planes are also printed. The variables that appear in the output are the following. See Figure 1.13 in Section 1 of this Reference Manual for more information regarding these variables. SQX SQY MX MY MXY SX SY SXY VONT VONB TrescaT TrescaB SMAX SMIN TMAX = = = = = = = = = = = = = = = Shear stress on the local X face in the Z direction Shear stress on the local Y face in the Z direction Moment per unit width about the local X face Moment per unit width about the local Y face Torsional Moment per unit width in the local X-Y plane Axial stress in the local X direction Axial stress in the local Y direction Shear stress in the local XY plane Von Mises stress on the top surface of the element Von Mises stress on the bottom surface of the element Tresca stress on the top surface of the element Tresca stress on the bottom surface of the element Maximum in-plane Principal stress Minimum in-plane Principal stress Maximum in-plane Shear stress
5-360
Section 5
ANGLE = Angle which determines direction of maximum principal stress with respect to local X axis If the JOINT option is used, forces and moments at the nodal points are also printed out in addition to the centroid of the element. The AT option may be used to print element forces at any specified point within the element. The AT option must be accompanied by f 1 and f 2 . f 1 and f 2 are local X and Y coordinates (in current units) of the point where the stresses and moments are required. For detailed description of the local coordinate system of the elements, refer to Section 1.6 of this manual. The PRINT ELEMENT FORCES command enables printing of plate corner forces [ F p = K p D p ] in global axis directions. The PRINT ELEMENT (JOINT) STRESS SOLID command enables printing of stresses at the center of the SOLID elements. The variables that appear in the output are the following. Normal Stresses Shear Stresses Principal Stresses Von Mises Stresses Direction cosines : SXX, SYY and SZZ : SXY, SYZ and SZX : S1, S2 and S3. : SE : 6 direction cosines are printed following the expression DC, corresponding to the first two principal stress directions.
The JOINT option will print out the stresses at the nodes of the solid elements. The PRINT MODE SHAPES command prints the relative joint motions of each of the modes that were calculated. The maximum motion is arbitrary and has no significance. Dynamic analysis will scale and combine the mode shapes to achieve the final dynamic results.
Section 5
5-361
The PRINT STORY DRIFT command may be used to obtain a print-out of the average lateral displacement of all joints at each horizontal level along the height of the structure.
Example PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT ELEMENT JOINT STRESS PRINT ELEMENT STRESS AT 0.5 0.5 LIST 1 TO 10 PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS PRINT JOINT DISPLACEMENTS LIST 1 TO 50 PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 101 TO 124 Notes
1) The output generated by these commands is based on the current unit system. The user may wish to verify the current unit system and change it if necessary. 2) Results may be printed for all joints/members/elements or based on a specified list.
Example for printing the CG PRINT CG PRINT CG _RAFTERBEAMS PRINT CG _RIDGEBEAMS
5-362
Section 5
where: xd - number of divisions along X axis, yd - number of divisions along Y axis. xd and yd represent default numbers of divisions for each edge of the surface where output is requested. The output is provided for sections located between division segments. For example, if the number of divisions = 2, then the output will be produced for only one section (at the center of the edge). Values of internal forces may be printed out for any user-defined section of a wall modelled using the Surface element.
General Format: PRINT SURFACE FORCE (ALONG ) (AT a) (BETWEEN d1, d2) LIST s1, ...,si
where:
- distance along the axis from start of the member to the full cross-section of the wall,
Section 5
5-363
d1, d2
- coordinates in the direction orthogonal to , delineating a fragment of the full crosssection for which the output is desired.
s1, ...,si - list of surfaces for output generation Note: If the keyword ALONG is omitted, direction Y (default) is assumed. If command AT is omitted, output is provided for all sections along the specified (or default) edge. Number of sections will be determined from the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. If the BETWEEN keyword is omitted, the output is generated based on full cross-section width. The attributes associated with surfaces, and the sections of this manual where the information may be obtained, are listed below:
Attributes Related Sections
Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output printing Shear Wall Design -
5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
5-364
Section 5
This command is used to calculate and print displacements at sections (intermediate points) of frame members. This provides the user with deflection data between the joints.
General format:
Description
Y Original Position
y-displ. x-displ.
Displaced position X
This command prints displacements at intermediate points between two joints of a member. These displacements are in global coordinate directions (see figure). If the MAX command is used, the program prints only the maximum local displacements among all load cases.
Figure 5.40
i = number of sections to be taken. Defaults to 12 if NSECT is not used and also if SAVE is used (max=24, min=2). a = File name where displacement values can be stored and used by the STAADPL graphics program. If the NOPRINT command is used in conjunction with the SAVE command, the program writes the data to file only and does not print them in the output. This option is not necessary in STAAD.Pro.
Section 5
5-365
SECTION DISPLACEMENTS are measured in GLOBAL COORDINATES. The values are measured from the original (undeflected) position to the deflected position. See figure above. The maximum local displacement is also printed. First, the location is determined and then the value is measured from this location to the line joining start and end joints of the deflected member.
Local Deflection
Figure 5.41
Notes
1) The section displacement values are available in Global Coordinates. The undeflected position is used as the datum for calculating the deflections. 2) This is a secondary analysis command. An analysis must be performed before this command may be used.
5-366
Section 5
This command is used to calculate and print force/moment envelopes for frame members. This command is not available for finite elements.
General format: PRINT
FORCE MAXFORCE
list-spec =
ENVELOPE (NSECTION i)
list-sp.
Description
Where i is the number of equally spaced sections to be considered in printing maximum and minimum force envelopes (where i is in the range 2 through 96). If the NSECTION i command is omitted, i will default to 12. MAXFORCE command produces maximum/minimum force values only of all sections, whereas the FORCE command prints maximum/minimum force values at every section as well as the max/min force values of all sections. The force components include FY, MZ, FZ, and MY. The SECTION command (as described in section 5.40) does not define the number of sections for force envelopes. For the sign convention of force values, refer to Section 2.19.
Section 5
5-367
Example PRINT FORCE ENV PRINT MAXF ENV NS 15 PRINT FORCE ENV NS 4 LIST 3 TO 15 Notes
This is a secondary analysis command and should be used after analysis specification.
5-368
Section 5
This command has been discontinued in STAAD.Pro. Please use the facilities of the Graphical User Interface (GUI) for screen and hard copy graphics.
Section 5
5-369
This command provides an estimate for required section properties for a frame member based on certain analysis results and user requirements.
General Format: * WIDTH DEFLECTION LENGTH SIZE BSTRESS SSTRESS f1 f2 f3 f4 f5
where, f 1 = Maxm. allowable width f 2 = Maxm. allowable (Length/Maxm. local deflection) ratio f 3 = Length for calculating the above ratio. Default = actual member length. f 4 = Maxm. allowable bending stress. f 5 = Maxm. allowable shear stress. The values must be provided in the current unit system.
Description
This command may be used to calculate required section properties for a member based on analysis results and user specified criteria. The user specified criteria may include Member width, Allowable (Length/Maxm. Deflection) Ratio, Maxm. allowable bending stress and Maximum allowable shear stress. Any number of these criteria may be used simultaneously. The output includes required Section Modulus (about major axis), required Shear Area (for shear parallel to minor axis), Maxm. moment capacity (about major axis), Maxm. shear capacity (for shear parallel to minor axis) and Maxm. (Length/local maxm. deflection) ratio.
5-370
Section 5
Example SIZE WID 12 DEFL 300 LEN 240 BSTR 36 ALL SIZE DEFL 450 BSTR 42 MEMB 16 TO 25
Note: It may be noted that sizing will be based on only the criteria specified by the user in the relevant SIZE command. In the first example above, sizing will be based on user specified member width of 12, Length/Deflection ratio of 300 (where Length= 240) and max. allowable bending stress of 36. In the second example, sizing will be based on Length/Deflection ratio of 450 (where Length= actual member length) and max. allowable bending stress of 42.
Notes
This is a post-analysis facility and must be used after the analysis specifications.
Section 5
5-371
Section 5.47.1 discusses specification of the parameters that may be used to control the design. Sections 5.47.2 and 5.47.3 describe the CODE CHECKING and MEMBER SELECTION options respectively. Member Selection by optimization is discussed in 5.47.4. STAAD also provides facilities for Weld Design per the American welding codes. Details may be found in sections 2.12 and 5.47.5 of this manual.
5-372
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to specify the parameters required for steel and aluminum design.
General format: PARAMETER
CODE
AASHTO AISC AISI ALUMINUM S136 AUSTRALIAN BRITISH CANADIAN FRENCH GERMAN INDIA JAPAN LRFD NORWAY
Other code names are: BS5400, RUSSIA, LRFD2, API, ALUMINUM, TIMBER, SPANISH, CHINA, EUROPE, ASCE, DUTCH, NPD,DANISH, BSK94, FINNISH, IS801, IS802, MEXICAN, BS5950 1990
Please see section 5.16 for the definition of member group names. Deck names are explained in section 5.20.7.
Section 5
5-373
Description
Parameter-name refers to the "PARAMETER NAME" (s) listed in the parameter table contained in the Steel and Aluminum Design section. f 1 = Value of the parameter. The details of the parameters available for specific codes may be found in the following places:
American AISC ASD & AISC LRFD AASHTO AISI (American Cold formed steel code) All other countries American Aluminum specifications ASCE72 Transmission Tower code API code Section 2 of this manual Section 2 of this manual Section 2 of this manual International International International International Codes Codes Codes Codes Manual Manual Manual Manual
The user can control the design through specification of proper parameter. The PROFILE parameter is available for only a limited number of codes like the AISC ASD and AISC LRFD. The user can specify up to three profiles (a 1 , a 2 and a 3 ). Profile is the first three letters of a section name from its steel table, like, W8X, W12, C10, L20 etc. The PROFILE parameter-name is used only for member selection where members are selected from each of those profile names. The PROFILE for a T-section is the corresponding Wshape. Also, the shape specified under PROFILE has to be the same as that specified initially under MEMBER PROPERTIES. CODE parameter lets you choose the type of steel or aluminum code to be checked for design. The default steel code depends on the country of distribution.
5-374
Section 5
Example PARAMETERS CODE AISC KY 1.5 MEMB 3 7 TO 11 NSF 0.75 ALL PROFILE W12 W14 MEMB 1 2 23 RATIO 0.9 ALL Notes
1) All unit sensitive values should be in the current unit system. 2) For default values of the parameters, refer to the appropriate parameter table.
Section 5
5-375
This command may be used to perform the CODE CHECKING operation for steel and aluminum members.
General format:
CHECK CODE
Description
This command checks the specified members against the specification of the desired code. Refer to Section 2 of this manual for detailed information.
See Section 2.5
Notes
The output of this command may be controlled using the TRACK parameter. Various codes support various levels of details. Refer to the appropriate section of the documentation, as explained in the table in 5.47.1 for more information on the TRACK parameter. Member group names and deck names are explained in section 5.16 and 5.20.7 respectively.
5-376
Section 5
SELECT
Description
This command instructs STAAD to select specified members based on the parameter value restrictions and specified code. The selection is done using the results from the most recent analysis and iterating on sections until a least weight size is obtained. Refer to Section 2 for more details. It is important that the keywords MEMBER or ALL be provided. Thus, the keyword SELECT by itself is not sufficient.
Examples
1) The output of this command may be controlled using the TRACK parameter. Various codes support various levels of details. Refer to the appropriate section of the documentation, as explained in the table in 5.47.1 for more information on the TRACK parameter.
Section 5
5-377
2) Member selection can be done only after an analysis has been performed. Consequently, the command to perform the analysis has to be specified before the SELECT MEMBER command can be specified. 3) This command does not cause the program to re-analyze for results based on the selected member sizes. However, to maintain compatibility of analysis results with the final member sizes, you should enter a subsequent PERFORM ANALYSIS command. Otherwise the post processor will display the prior results with the revised member sizes. 4) Member group names and deck names are explained in section 5.16 and 5.20.7 respectively.
5-378
Section 5
This command performs member selection using an optimization technique based on multiple analysis/design iterations.
General format: SELECT OPTIMIZED Description
The program selects all members based on an optimization technique. This method performs 2 analyses as well as iteration of sizes to reduce the overall structure weight. This command should be used with caution since it will require longer processing time.
Notes
1) The output of this command may be controlled using the TRACK parameter. Three levels of details are available. Refer to the appropriate Steel Design section for more information on the TRACK parameter. 2) This command will perform 1 additional analysis/design cycles and therefore may be time consuming. Steps taken are: CHECK CODE ALL; then modify ratios; then SELECT ALL; then PERFORM ANALYSIS; then SELECT ALL. See section 5.48 Group Specification for other options used with this command. You may want to repeat this command for further optimization. 3) See section 5.47.3 note 3).
Section 5
5-379
Description
By this command, the program selects the weld sizes of the specified members at start and end. The selections are tabulated with all the necessary information. If the TRUSS command is used, the program will design welds for angle and double angle members attached to gusset plates with the weld along the length of members.
Notes
Currently, this feature is available only with the American welding specifications. Regardless of the code name specified prior to this command, design will be performed according to US code specifications. Some information on the implementation of these specifications is available in Section 2.12 of this manual. The parameters available for controlling weld sizes are listed in Table 2.1 in Section 2 of this manual. It is important that the keywords MEMBER or ALL be provided. Thus, the keyword SELECT by itself is not sufficient.
Examples
5-380
Section 5
This command may be used to group members together for analysis and steel design.
General format: (FIXED GROUP) GROUP prop-spec MEMB memb-list (SAME AS i 1 )
AX prop-spec = SY SZ
Description
= Cross-section area = Section modulus in local y-axis = Section modulus in local z-axis
This command enables the program to group specified members together for analysis based on their largest property specification. However, if member number i 1 is provided in the SAME AS command, the program will group the members based on the properties of i 1 . When FIXED GROUP is omitted, the GROUP command is usually entered after the member selection command, and the selected members will be grouped immediately and the new member properties will be used in any further operations. After the GROUPing is completed, the GROUP commands are discarded and will not be used again. Further grouping will be done only if a new GROUP command is encountered later. If the FIXED GROUP option precedes the group data, the specified grouping will be retained in memory by the program and will be used in subsequent SELECT commands. No "GROUPing" will occur unless a "SELECT (MEMBER or ALL or OPTIMIZED)" command is performed. However, grouping will be performed with every subsequent SELECT command.
Section 5
5-381
In this example, the members 1, 3, 7 to 12, and 15 are assigned the same properties based on which of these members has the largest section modulus. Members 17 to 23 and 27 are assigned the same properties as member 30, regardless of whether member 30 has a smaller or larger cross-sectional area. AX is the default property upon which grouping is based.
Example 2 FIXED GROUP GROUP MEMB 1 TO 5 SELECT OPTIMIZED
In the above example, the usage of the FIXED GROUP command is illustrated. In this example, the SELECT OPTIMIZED command involves the 6 stage process of 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. CHECK CODE ALL followed by modification of RATIO SELECT ALL GROUPING MEMBERS 1 TO 5 PERFORM ANALYSIS SELECT ALL GROUPING MEMBERS 1 TO 5
The FIXED GROUP command (and the GROUP commands that follow it) is required for execution of steps 3 and 6 in the cycle. You may want to repeat this data for further optimization.
5-382
Section 5
Notes
The FIXED GROUP + GROUP commands are typically entered before the member selection for further analysis and design. This facility may be effectively utilized to develop a practically oriented design where several members need to be of the same size. All the members in a list for a specific GROUP command should have the same cross section type. Thus, if the command reads GROUP MEMB 1 TO 10 and member 3 is a W shape and member 7 is a Channel, grouping will not be done. The 10 members must be either all W shapes or all channels. Also see section 5.47.3 note 3.
Section 5
5-383
This command may be used to obtain a summary of all steel sections being used along with their lengths and weights.
General format:
LIST memb-list STEEL (MEMBER) TAKE ( OFF ) (
Description
This command provides a listing of the different steel table sections used in the members selected. The tabulated listing will include total length of each section name and its total weight. This can be helpful in estimating steel quantities. The MEMBER option list each member length and weight by number, profile-type, length and weight.
Notes
This facility may be effectively utilized to obtain a quick estimate of the structural steel quantity.
Example
5-384
Section 5
Section 5
5-385
This set of commands may be used for specification of parameters for timber design.
General Format: PARAMETER CODE TIMBER parameter-name f 1 Description
f 1 = the value of the parameter. The parameter-name refers to the parameters described in Section 4.
Notes
1) All values must be provided in the current unit system. 2) For default values of parameters, refer to Section 4.
5-386
Section 5
This command performs code checking operation on specified members based on the American Institute of Timber Construction (AITC) codes.
General Format: CHECK CODE
Description
This command checks the specified members against the requirements of the American Institute of Timber Construction (AITC) codes. The results of the code checking are summarized in a tabular format. Examples and detailed explanations of the tabular format are available in Section 4.
Notes
The output of this command may be controlled by the TRACK parameter. Two levels of details are available. Refer to Section 4 for detailed information on the TRACK parameter.
Section 5
5-387
This command performs member selection operation on specified members based on the American Institute of Timber Construction (AITC) codes.
General Format: SELECT
Description
This command may be used to perform member selection according to the AITC codes. The selection is based on the results of the latest analysis and iterations are performed until the least weight member satisfying all the applicable code requirements is obtained. Parameters may be used to control the design and the results are available in a tabular format. Detailed explanations of the selection process and the output are available in Section 4.
Notes
The output of this command may be controlled by the TRACK parameter. Two levels of details are available. Refer to Section 4 for detailed information on the TRACK parameter.
5-388
Section 5
5.51 Concrete Design Specifications for beams, columns and plate elements
This section describes the specifications for concrete design for beams, columns and individual plate elements. The concrete design procedure implemented in STAAD consists of the following steps: 1) 2) 3) 4) 5) Initiating the design. Specifying parameters. Specifying design requirements. Requesting quantity take-off. Terminating the design.
Section 5.51.1 describes the design initiation command. Section 5.51.2 discusses the specification of parameters. Design requirement specifications are described 5.51.3. The CONCRETE TAKE OFF command is described in 5.51.4. Finally, the design termination command is described in 5.51.5.
Section 5
5-389
This command is used to initiate concrete design for beams, columns and individual plate elements.
General format: START CONCRETE DESIGN Description
This command initiates the concrete design specification. With this, the design parameters are automatically set to the default values (as shown on Table 3.1). Without this command, none of the following concrete design commands will be recognized.
Notes
This command must be present before any concrete design command is used. Related topics can be found in the following sections:
Design of beams, columns and elements theoretical background per ACI 318 Design of footings per ACI 318 Design of shear walls per ACI 318 Design of slabs per ACI 318 using the Slab Designer 3.1 to 3.8.1 5.52 3.8.2, 5.53 3.8.3
5-390
Section 5
This set of commands may be used to specify parameters to control concrete design for beams, columns and individual plate elements.
General format:
CODE
ACI AUSTRALIA BRITISH CANADIAN CHINA EUROPE FRENCH GERMAN INDIA JAPAN MEXICO NORWAY MEMBER memb/elem list ( ALL )
parameter-name f 1
Description
Parameter-name refers to the concrete parameters described in Table 3.1. f 1 = is the value of the parameter. Wherever applicable, this value is input in the current units. The UNIT command is also accepted during any phase of concrete design.
Section 5
5-391
Notes
1) All parameter values are provided in the current unit system. 2) For default values of parameters, refer to Section 3 for the ACI code. For other codes, please see the International Codes manual.
5-392
Section 5
This command may be used to specify the type of design required. Members may be designed as BEAM, COLUMN or ELEMENT.
General format:
DESIGN
Description
Members to be designed must be specified as BEAM, COLUMN or ELEMENT. Members, once designed as a beam, cannot be redesigned as a column again, or vice versa.
Notes
Only plate elements may be designed as ELEMENT. Enter this command after the parameters needed for this command have been entered. The DESIGN ELEMENT command designs individual plate elements using the procedure explained in section 3.8.1 of the ACI code. For theoretical information on designing individual plate elements per other design codes, please see the International Codes manual. For designing shear walls and slabs, see sections 3.8.2, 3.8.3 and 5.53 of this manual.
Section 5
5-393
This command may be used to obtain an estimate of the total volume of the concrete, reinforcement bars used and their respective weights.
General Format: CONCRETE TAKE OFF Description
This command can be issued to print the total volume of concrete and the bar numbers and their respective weight for the members designed. SAMPLE OUTPUT:
************** CONCRETE TAKE OFF ************** (FOR BEAMS AND COLUMNS DESIGNED ABOVE) TOTAL VOLUME OF CONCRETE BAR SIZE NUMBER -------4 6 8 9 11 -----------*** TOTAL WEIGHT ( ) -------805.03 91.60 1137.60 653.84 818.67 = 3506.74 = 87.50
Notes
5-394
Section 5
This command terminates the concrete design, after which normal STAAD commands resume.
Example START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE ACI FYMAIN 40.0 ALL FC 3.0 ALL DESIGN BEAM 1 TO 4 7 DESIGN COLUMN 9 12 TO 16 DESIGN ELEMENT 20 TO 30 END Notes
Section 5
5-395
This set of commands may be used to specify footing design requirements. Sections 5.52.1 through 5.52.4 describe the process of design initiation, parameter specification, design command and design termination.
Description
This facility may be used to design isolated footings for user specified support joints. Once the support is specified, the program automatically identifies the support reaction(s) associated with the joint. All active load cases are checked and design is performed for the support reaction(s) that requires the maximum footing size. Parameters are available to control the design. Dowel bars and development lengths are also calculated and included in the design output.
Design Considerations
The STAAD isolated footing design is based on the following considerations. 1) The design reaction load may include concentrated load and biaxial moments. 2) The vertical reaction load is increased by 10% to account for the selfweight of the footing. 3) Footing slab size is rectangular. The user through a parameter may control the ratio between the length and the width of the slab. 4) Optional pedestal design is available. 5) Footings cannot be designed at supports where the reaction causes uplift on the footings. 6) This facility is currently available for the American code only.
5-396
Section 5
Design Procedure
The following sequential design procedure is followed: 1) Footing size is calculated on the basis of the load directly available from the analysis results (support reactions) and user specified Allowable Soil Pressure. No factor is used on the support reactions. 2) The footing size obtained from 1) and the FACTORED LOAD is utilized to calculate soil reactions. FACTORED LOAD = ACTUAL REACTION X Parameter FFAC The user may provide a desired value for the parameter FFAC. 3) Footing depth and reinforcement details are based on soil reactions calculated per 2) above. 4) Dowel bar requirements and development lengths are calculated and reported in the output. Following parameters are available for footing design.
Design Parameters
Parameter Name
FY FC CLEAR REINF FFAC BC RATIO
Default Value
60,000 pi 3,000 pi 3.0 in. Number 9 bar 1.0 3000 psf 1.0
Description
Yield strength for reinforcement steel. Compressive Strength of Concrete. Clear cover for slab reinforcement. Main reinforcement bar size for slab design. Load factor for concrete design. Soil bearing capacity. Ratio between slab sides.
Section 5
5-397
Default Value
1.0
Description
1.0 = only numerical output is provided 2.0 = numerical output and sketch provided The min. depth of the footing base slab. Program changes this value if required for design. Size of the footing base slab S1 and S2 correspond to column sides YD and ZD respectively. Either S1 or S2 or both can be specified. If one is provided, the other will be calculated based on RATIO. If both are provided, RATIO will be ignored The depth of the footing base from the support point of the column. 0.0 = no pedestal design 1.0 = pedestal design with program calculating pedestal dimensions. X1 X2 - pedestal design with user provided pedestal dimensions. X1 and X2 are pedestal dimensions corresponding to slab sides S1 and S2 respectively.
DEPTH
S1, S2
EMBEDME NT PEDESTAL
0.0
0.0
5-398
Section 5
This command initiates the footing design specifications. Without this command, no further footing design command will be recognized.
Notes
Section 5
5-399
This command is used to specify parameters that may be used to control the footing design.
General Format: CODE AMERICAN
parameter-name f 1
Description
Parameter-name refers to the parameters described in Section 5.52. f 1 is the value of the parameter. If applicable, this value should be in the current units. The UNIT command is also accepted during any phase of footing design.
Notes
1) All parameter values must be provided in the current unit system. 2) For default values of parameters, refer to the parameter table in Section 5.52. 3) This facility is currently available for the American code only.
5-400
Section 5
joint-list ( ALL )
Description
This command may be used to specify the joints for which the footing designs are required.
Notes
The output of this command may be controlled by the TRACK parameter (see Section 5.52). If TRACK is set to the default value of 1.0, only numerical output will be provided. If TRACK is set to 2.0, graphical output will be provided in addition.
Section 5
5-401
EXAMPLE START FOOTING DESIGN CODE AMERICAN UNIT . . . FY 45.0 JOINT 2 FY 60.0 JOINT 5 FC 3 ALL RATIO 0.8 ALL TRACK 2.0 ALL PEDESTAL 1.0 ALL UNIT . . . CLEAR 0.25 BC 5.20 JOINT 2 BC 5.00 JOINT 5 DESIGN FOOTING 1 2 3 5 END FOOTING DESIGN
5-402
Section 5
If the footing design is not terminated, no further STAAD command will be recognized.
Section 5
5-403
STAAD performs design of reinforced concrete shear walls per two codes currently: ACI 318-02 and BS 8110. In order to design a shear wall, it must first be modelled using the Surface element. The attributes associated with surfaces, and the sections of this manual where the information may be obtained, are listed below:
Attributes Related Sections
Surfaces incidences Openings in surfaces Local coordinate system for surfaces Specifying sections for stress/force output Property for surfaces Material constants Surface loading Stress/Force output printing Shear Wall Design -
5.13.3 5.13.3 1.6.3 5.13.3 5.21.2 5.26.3 5.32.3.4 5.42 3.8.2, 5.53
Scope of the design is dependent on whether panel definition, as explained in section 5.53.1, precedes the shear wall design input block which is explained in section 5.53.2. a. No panel definition. Design is performed for the specified horizontal full crosssection, located at a distance c from the origin of the local coordinates system.
5-404
Section 5
b.
Panels have been defined. Design is performed for all panels, for the cross-section located at a distance c from the start of the panel.
Shear Wall design is currently not available for dynamic load cases.
Section 5
5-405
where: I j ptype - ordinal surface number, - ordinal panel number, - panel type, one of: WALL, COLUMN, BEAM x1 y1 z1 (...) - coordinates of the corners of the panel
5-406
Section 5
where: a - code name ACI (for ACI 318), BRITISH (for BS 8110) parameters - these are listed in a tabular form in section 3.8.2 of this manual for the ACI code, and in the International Codes manual for BS 8110. cr - column reinforcing parameter, tr - output parameter. (see below for description) Reinforcement distribution within COLUMN panels is controlled by parameter CREINF, that may have one of three possible values: 0 - equal number of bars on all four faces of the column (default), 1 - equal number of bars on two faces perpendicular to the plane of the wall, 2 - equal number of bars on two faces parallel to the plane of the wall.
Section 5
5-407
Parameter TRACK specifies how detailed the design output should be: 0 - indicates a basic set of results data (default), 1 - full design output will be generated. Note: If the command AT is omitted, the design proceeds for all cross sections of the wall or panels, as applicable, defined by the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values.
5-408
Section 5
This command should be provided as the last input command. This terminates a STAAD run.
Section 5
5-409
5-410
Section 5
Index
B
Bandwidth Reduction, 1.18.1, 5.11 BASIC EQUATION, 1.18.1 BEAM ASSIGN, 1.7.5, 5.20.5 concrete DESIGN of, 3.6, 5.51.3 specification of, 1.7.2 BEAM parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 BENDING MOMENT/SHEAR FORCE, 1.19, 5.41 Bending stress (see AISC, AASHTO, & LRFD design) BETA angle, 1.5.3, 5.26 command, 5.26 description, 1.5.3, 1.12 Built-In Steel Section Library 1.7.2
Index
C
CABLE command of, 1.11, 5.23.2, description, 1.11 nonlinear, 1.18.2.5 CALCULATE RAYLEIGH (FREQUENCY), 5.33 CANADIAN SEISMIC, 5.31.2.10
CONCRETE DESIGN- 3.0 parameter 5.51.2, Table 3.1 specifications, 5.51 terminator, 5.51.5 CONCRETE TAKE OFF, 5.51.4 CONSTANTS, 5.26 COORDINATE systems, 1.5
Cartesian Coordinate System, 1.5.1 CASTELLATED BEAMS, 2.16 CB parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 Center of Gravity (CG)(See PRINT) CHANGE command of, 5.38 (see also Multiple Analysis, INACTIVE command) CHANNEL SECTION ASSIGN, 1.7.5, 5.20.5 double channels, 2.2.1 Specification, 2.2.1 user table property of, 1.7.3, 5.19 CHECK CODE, 5.47.2, 5.50.2 CMY parameter, Table 2.1 CMZ parameter, Table 2.1 CODE CHECKING specification, 5.47.2, Cold Formed Steel, 2.15, 5.20 COLOMBIAN (Seismic) COLUMN ASSIGN, 5.20.5 concrete DESIGN, 5.51 COMPOSITE BEAM, design per AISC-ASD, 2.9, AISC-LRFD, 2.14.13 COMPOSITE BEAMS AND COMPOSITE DECKS, 1.7.7, 5.20.7
joint, 5.11 CQC, Modal Combination, 5.32.10.1 CURVED MEMBERS, 1.7.8, 5.20.8 CUT-OFF FREQUENCY, 5.30.1 CUT-OFF MODE SHAPE, 5.30.1 CUT-OFF TIME, 5.30.1 CYLINDRICAL REVERSE, 5.11, 1.5.1
D
DAMPING, 5.26, 5.32.10.1 DAMPING Modeling, 1.18.3.3 DEFINE, 7.3 DEFINE IMPERFECTION, 5.26.6 DEFINE MESH, 5.14 DEFINE MOVING LOAD, 5.31.1 DEFINE SNOW LOAD, 5.31.5 DEFINE TIME HISTORY, 5.31.6 DEFINE WIND LOAD, 5.31.5 DELETE MEMBERS, 5.18 DELETE JOINTS, 5.18 DESIGN - CONCRETE, 3 DESIGN BEAM, 5.51.3 DESIGN COLUMN, 5.51.3 DESIGN ELEMENT, 5.51.3 DESIGN FOOTING, 5.52.3
Index DESIGN initiation, 5.51.1, 5.52.1 DESIGN OF I-SHAPED BEAMS PER ACI-318, 3.8.4 DFF parameter, Table 2.1 FINISH, 5.53 DJ1, DJ2 parameters, Table 2.1 FINITE ELEMENT DIAPHRAGM (see MASTER/SLAVE) DIRECTION, 5.27.3 DISPLACEMENTS PRINT command, 5.41, 5.42 DMAX parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 DMIN parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 DOUBLE ANGLE, 2.2.1, 5.19 FLOOR LOAD, 5.32.4 DOUBLE CHANNELS, 2.2.1 FLOOR WEIGHT, 5.31.2.1, 5.31.2.2 DRAW, 5.29 FOOTING Automatic Spring Support DYNAMIC ANALYSIS, 1.18.3 Generator, 5.27.3 FOOTING DESIGN, 1.22, 5.52 FOOTING DESIGN PARAMETER, 5.52.2 ELASTIC MAT Automatic Spring Support Generator, 5.27.3 ELEMENT FORCE, 1.6.1 FORCE ENVELOPES, 1.19.5, 5.43 ELEMENT INCIDENCE, 5.13 FORCES ELEMENT LOAD, 5.32.3, 1.6.1, 1.16.8 ELEMENT LOCAL AXIS, 1.6.1 ELEMENT NUMBERING, 1.6.1 ELEMENT PLANE STRESS, 5.24 ELEMENT PROPERTY, 5.21 ELEMENT RELEASE, 5.22.2 ELEMENT WEIGHT, 5.31.2.1, 5.31.2.2 END CONCRETE DESIGN, 5.51.5 END FOOTING DESIGN, 5.52.4 END RUN SPECIFICATION, 5.53 PRINT command, 5.41 FREQUENCY, 5.33, 5.34 FYLD parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 FOOTING DESIGN specifications, 5.52 Information, 1.6 Plate/shell, 1.6.1, 5.13, 5.21 Solid, 1.6.2, 5.13 FIREPROOFING ON MEMBERS, 5.20.9 FIXED END MEMBER LOAD, 1.16.4, 5.32.7 EXPOSURE FACTOR, WIND LOAD GENERATOR, 5.31.5
E
EIGENPROBLEM, Solution, 1.18.3.1
G
GENERAL SECTION User Table, 5.19 GENERATE ELEMENT, 5.14 GENERATION OF LOADS, 5.32.12 GENERATION OF MOVING LOADS, 5.32.12, 1.17.1 GEOMETRY MODELING CONSIDERATIONS, 1.6.1
Index GLOBAL COORDINATE, 1.5.1, 1.5.3 GROUND MOTION, 5.32.10.2 GROUP SPECIFICATION, 5.48 LOAD GENERATION, 1.17, 5.32.12 LOAD SYSTEMS Definition of, 5.31 LOADING, 1.16, 5.32 LOCAL COORDINATE, 1.5.2, 1.5.3 LX parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 LY parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 LZ parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2
H
Harmonic Time History Load, 5.31.6
I
IBC 2000/2003 LOAD, 5.31.2.6 IGNORE LIST, 5.9 IMPERFECTION Load, 1.18.2.2 INACTIVE MEMBERS, 1.20, 5.18 INCLINED SUPPORT, 5.27.2 INPUT GENERATION, 1.2, 6.2 INPUT NODESIGN, 5.10 INPUT WIDTH, 5.4 IS1893, 5.31.2, 5.32.12 ISECTION User Table, 5.19
M
MAIN parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 MASS MODELING, 1.18.3.2 MASTER/SLAVE, 1.15, 5.28 MAT Automatic Spring Support Generator, 5.27.3 MATERIAL CONSTANTS, 1.13 MEMBER CABLE, 5.23 MEMBER COMPRESSION - only, 5.23.3 MEMBER DISPLACEMENTS, 1.19.3 MEMBER END FORCES, 1.19
J
JAPANESE (Seismic) see AIJ
MEMBER FORCES, 1.19.2 JOINT COORDINATES, 5.11 MEMBER Imperfection Information, JOINT LOAD, 1.16.1, 5.32.1 JOINT NUMBERING, 5.11, 5.15 JOINT WEIGHT, 5.31.2 5.26.6 MEMBER INCIDENCES, 5.12 MEMBER PROPERTY- FROM TABLE, 5.20 MEMBER - PRISMATIC, 5.20 KX parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 MEMBER - TAPERED, 5.20 KY parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 MEMBER - from User Provided Table, KZ parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 5.20 MEMBER - ASSIGN, 5.20 MEMBER LOAD, 1.16.2, 5.32.2 MEMBER NUMBERING, 5.12, 5.15 MEMBER OFFSETS, 1.12, 5.25
L
LOAD COMBINATION, 5.35 LOAD COMBINATION, SRSS, 5.35
Index MEMBER POSTSTRESS, 5.32.5 MEMBER PRESTRESS, 5.32.5 MEMBER PROPERTIES, 1.7, 5.20 MEMBER RELEASE, 1.8, 5.22 MEMBER SELECTION SPECIFICATION, 5.47.3 MEMBER STRESSES (SPECIFIED SECTIONS), 1.19.4, 5.41 MEMBER Tension-Only 1.9, 5.23.3 MEMBER TRUSS, 1.9, 5.23 MEMBER WEIGHT, 5.31.2 MESH GENERATION, 5.14 MODAL CALCULATION, 5.34 MODE SELECTION, 5.30.2 MODE SHAPES (see PRINT) Moving Load, 1.17.1, 5.31.1, 5.32.12 MULTIPLE ANALYSES, 1.20, 5.37 MultiLinear Analysis, 1.18.2.3, 5.27.4 Multilinear Spring, 5.1.2, 5.27.4 PARAMETER specifications, 5.47.1, 5.52.2 STEEL DESIGN, Table 2.1 CONCRETE DESIGN, Table 3.1 TIMBER DESIGN, 5.50, 5.50.1 PARTIAL MOMENT RELEASE, 5.22.1 P-DELTA ANALYSIS, 1.18.2.1 PERFORM ANALYSIS, 5.37 PERFORM CABLE, 5.37 PERFORM IMPERFECTION, 5.37 PERFORM ROTATION, 5.17 PERFORM STEADY STATE, 5.37 PERIOD, 5.33, 5.34 PIPE, 1.7.2, 2.2.1,5.19, 5.20.1 PLATE/SHELL ELEMENT, 1.6.1, 5.13, 5.14, 5.21 PROPERTIES members, 1.7, 5.20 PRESTRESS LOAD, 1.16.5, 5.32.5 PRINT ALL, 5.37 BOTH, 5.37 CG, 5.41 ELEMENT FORCES, 5.41 ELEMENT INFORMATION, 5.41 ELEMENT STRESSES, 5.41 ENTIRE (TABLE), 5.41 FORCE ENVELOPE, 5.43 JOINT DISPLACEMENTS, 5.41 LOAD DATA, 5.37 MATERIAL PROPERTIES, 5.41 MAXFORCE ENVELOPE, 5.43 MEMBER INFORMATION, 5.41 MODE SHAPES, 5.37 SECTION DISPLACEMENT, 5.42 STATICS CHECK, 5.37 STATICS LOAD, 5.37 SUPPORT INFORMATION, 5.41 SUPPORT REACTIONS, 5.41
N
NATURAL FREQUENCY, 5.33, 5.34 NON-LINEAR ANALYSIS, 1.18.2.2, 5.37 NOREDUCE BAND, 5.11 NSF parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2
O
OUTPUT WIDTH, 5.4
P
PAGE EJECT, 5.8 PAGE LENGTH, 5.8 PAGE NEW, 5.7
Index PRISMATIC, 5.19 PRISMATIC PROPERTY, 1.7.1, 5.20.2 PROFILE, 5.47.1 PROPERTY SPEC, 5.20.2 SELECT OPTIMIZED, 5.47.4 SELECT WELD TRUSS, 5.47.3 SELFWEIGHT, 5.32.9 SEPARATOR, 5.6 SET NL, 5.5 SET DATA CHECK, 5.5 RATIO parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2 SET RUN, 5.5 RAYLEIGH FREQUENCY, 5.33 SET ECHO, 5.5 REACTIONS (SUPPORT) PRINT command, 5.41 REFERENCE LOAD, 5.31.1 REFERENCE POINT, 1.5.3 RELEASE members, 1.8, 5.22.1 elements, 5.22.2 SLAB DESIGN, 3.8 REPEAT, 511, 5.12, 5.13 SLAVE RIGID, 5.28 REPEAT ALL, 5.11, 5.12, 5.13 SNOW LOAD, 5.31.5, 5.32.13 REPEAT LOAD SPECIFICATION, 5.32.11 RESPONSE SPECTRUM, 1.18.3.4, 5.32.10 RESPONSE TIME HISTORY, 1.18.3.5, 5.31.6, 5.32.10.2 SOLID ELEMENT, 1.6.2, 5.13 SPECTRUM, 5.32.10.1 SRSS Modal Combination, 5.32.10.1 SRSS Static Load Combination, 5.35 SSY parameter, Table 2.1 SSZ parameter, Table 2.1 START CONCRETE DESIGN, 5.51.1 START FOOTING DESIGN, 5.52.1 START USER TABLE, 5.19 STEADY STATE, 5.37.1 STEEL DESIGN SPECIFICATIONS, 2.0, 5.47 SEISMIC (CFE), 5.31.2.7 STEEL JOIST AND JOIST GIRDERS, SEISMIC (NTC), 5.31.2.8 SEISMIC (RPA), 5.31.2.9 SELECT ALL, 5.47.3, 5.50.3 SELECT MEMBER, 5.47.3, 5.50.3 1.7.6 STEEL TABLE, 5.20.1 STEEL TAKE-OFF, 5.49 SIZE specification, 5.46 SET Z UP, 5.5 SHEAR WALL, 3.8.3 SINKING SUPPORT (see SUPPORT DISPLACEMENT)
S
SECONDARY ANALYSIS, 1.19.1 SECTION DISPLACEMENTS, 5.42 SECTION SPECIFICATION, 5.40 SEISMIC (see UBC, IBC) SEISMIC (See GROUND MOTION)
Index STIFF parameter, Table 2.1 STRUCTURE GEOMETRY, 1.5 STRUCTURES Type, 1.3, 5.2 SUBGRADE, 5.27.3 SUBSTITUTION - JOINT, 5.15 UBC SUBSTITUTION - MEMBER, 5.15 SUBSTITUTION - COLUMN, 5.15 SUPPORT DISPLACEMENT, 1.16.7, 5.32.8 SUPPORTS, 1.14, 5.27 SUPPORTS - Inclined, 5.27.2 SURFACE element, 1.6.3 SURFACE INCIDENCE, 5.13.3 Accidental Torsion, 5.31.2 UBC LOAD, 5.31.2 UBC SEISMIC LOAD, 1.17.2, 5.31.2.1, 5.32.12 UNB parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 UNIT, 5.3 UNIT SPECIFICATION, 5.3 UNIT SYSTEMS, 1.4 UNT parameter, Table 2.1 & 2.2 USER PROVIDED TABLE, 1.7.3, 5.19, 5.20.4 USER STEEL TABLE, 5.19 TRAPEZOIDAL LOAD, 5.32.3 TRUSS MEMBERS, 1.9, 5.23.1 TUBE, 1.7.2, 5.19
T
TABLE - Steel Table , 1.7.3, 5.20.1 TABLE - User Provided, 5.19 TAPERED MEMBER, 5.20.3 TAPERED SECTIONS, 2.7.2, 5.20.3 TEES, 1.7.2, 5.19 TEMPERATURE LOAD, 1.16.6, 5.32.6 TEMPERATURE/STRAIN, 1.16.6 TENSION-ONLY MEMBER, 1.10, 1.18.2.4, 5.23.3 TIMBER DESIGN PARAMETER SPECIFICATIONS, 4.0, 5.50.1 TIMBER DESIGN SPECIFICATIONS, 4.0, 5.50 TIME HISTORY ANALYSIS, 1.18.3, 5.31.6, 5.32.10.2 TIME HISTORY ANALYSIS, Harmonic Loading, 5.31.6 TORSION parameter, Table 2.1 TRACK parameter, Table 2.1& 2.2
W
WELD parameter, Table 2.1 WELDED PLATE GIRDERS, 1.7.2 WIDE FLANGE, 5.19 WIND LOAD, 1.17.3, 5.31.5, 5.32.12 WMIN parameter, Table 2.1 WSTR parameter, Table 2.1
Index